Add 2007 to copyright years.
[bpt/emacs.git] / man / gnus.texi
1 \input texinfo
2
3 @setfilename ../info/gnus
4 @settitle Gnus Manual
5 @syncodeindex fn cp
6 @syncodeindex vr cp
7 @syncodeindex pg cp
8
9 @copying
10 Copyright @copyright{} 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
11 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12
13 @quotation
14 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
15 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
16 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
17 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
18 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
19 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
20 License'' in the Emacs manual.
21
22 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
23 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
24 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
25
26 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
27 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
28 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
29 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
30 @end quotation
31 @end copying
32
33 @iftex
34 @iflatex
35 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
36 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
37 \usepackage{pagestyle}
38 \usepackage{epsfig}
39 \usepackage{pixidx}
40 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
41
42 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
43 \else
44 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
45 \usepackage{thumbpdf}
46 \pdfcompresslevel=9
47 \fi
48
49 \makeindex
50 \begin{document}
51
52 % Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
53 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.11}
54 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
55 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
56
57 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
58
59 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
60 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
61 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
62 \else
63 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
64 \fi
65 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
66 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
67
68 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
69 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
70
71 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
72 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73 \newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
74 \newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
75 \newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
76 \newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
77 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
78 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
79 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
80 \newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
81 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
82 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
83 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
84 \newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
85 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
86 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
87 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
88 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
89 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
90 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
91 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
92 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
93 \newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
94 \newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
95
96 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
97 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
98 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
99 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
100 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
101 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
102 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
103 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
104 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
105 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
106 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
107 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
108 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
109
110 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
111 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
112 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
113 }
114
115 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
116
117 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
118 {\mbox{}}
119 }
120
121 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
122 \gnusdimen 0pt
123
124 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
125 \gnuscleardoublepage
126 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
127 \chapter{#2}
128 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
129 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
130 \thispagestyle{empty}
131 \hspace*{-2cm}
132 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
133 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
134 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
135 \end{picture}
136 \clearpage
137 }
138
139 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
140 \begin{figure}
141 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
142 #3
143 \end{picture}
144 \caption{#1}
145 \end{figure}
146 }
147
148 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
149 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
150 }
151
152 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
153 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
154 }
155
156 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
157 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
158 }
159
160 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
161 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
162 }
163
164 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
165
166 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
167 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
168 \section{#1}
169 }
170
171 \newenvironment{codelist}%
172 {\begin{list}{}{
173 }
174 }{\end{list}}
175
176 \newenvironment{asislist}%
177 {\begin{list}{}{
178 }
179 }{\end{list}}
180
181 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
182 {\begin{list}{}{
183 \labelwidth=0cm
184 }
185 }{\end{list}}
186
187 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
188 {\begin{list}{}{
189 }
190 }{\end{list}}
191
192 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
193 {\begin{list}{}{
194 }
195 }{\end{list}}
196
197 \newenvironment{samplist}%
198 {\begin{list}{}{
199 }
200 }{\end{list}}
201
202 \newenvironment{varlist}%
203 {\begin{list}{}{
204 }
205 }{\end{list}}
206
207 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
208 {\begin{list}{}{
209 }
210 }{\end{list}}
211
212 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
213 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
214 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
215
216 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
217 {
218 {
219 \ifodd\count0
220 {
221 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
222 }
223 \else
224 {
225 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
226 }
227 }
228 \fi
229 }
230 }
231 {
232 \ifodd\count0
233 \mbox{} \hfill
234 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
235 \else
236 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
237 \hfill \mbox{}
238 \fi
239 }
240
241 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
242 {
243 {
244 \ifodd\count0
245 {
246 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
247 }
248 \else
249 {
250 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
251 }
252 \fi
253 }
254 }
255 {
256 \ifodd\count0
257 \mbox{} \hfill
258 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
259 \else
260 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
261 \hfill \mbox{}
262 \fi
263 }
264
265 \newpagestyle{gnus}%
266 {
267 {
268 \ifodd\count0
269 {
270 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
271 }
272 \else
273 {
274 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
275 }
276 \fi
277 }
278 }
279 {
280 \ifodd\count0
281 \mbox{} \hfill
282 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
283 \else
284 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
285 \hfill \mbox{}
286 \fi
287 }
288
289 \pagenumbering{roman}
290 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
291
292 @end iflatex
293 @end iftex
294
295 @iftex
296 @iflatex
297
298 \begin{titlepage}
299 {
300
301 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
302 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
303 \parindent=0cm
304 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
305
306 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
307 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
308 \vfill
309 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
310 \vfill
311 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
312 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
313 \newpage
314 }
315
316 \mbox{}
317 \vfill
318
319 \thispagestyle{empty}
320
321 @c @insertcopying
322 \newpage
323 \end{titlepage}
324 @end iflatex
325 @end iftex
326
327 @ifnottex
328 @insertcopying
329 @end ifnottex
330
331 @dircategory Emacs
332 @direntry
333 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
334 @end direntry
335 @iftex
336 @finalout
337 @end iftex
338 @setchapternewpage odd
339
340
341
342 @titlepage
343 @title Gnus Manual
344
345 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
346 @page
347 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
348 @insertcopying
349 @end titlepage
350
351
352 @node Top
353 @top The Gnus Newsreader
354
355 @ifinfo
356
357 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
358 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
359 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
360 luck.
361
362 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
363 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.11.
364
365 @end ifinfo
366
367 @iftex
368
369 @iflatex
370 \tableofcontents
371 \gnuscleardoublepage
372 @end iflatex
373
374 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
375 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
376
377 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
378 being accused of plagiarism:
379
380 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
381 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
382 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
383 can even read news with it!
384
385 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
386 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
387 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
388 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
389 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
390 the program.
391
392 @end iftex
393
394 @menu
395 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
396 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
397 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
398 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
399 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
400 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
401 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
402 * Various:: General purpose settings.
403 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
404 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
405 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
406 * Key Index:: Key Index.
407
408 Other related manuals
409
410 * Message:(message). Composing messages.
411 * Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
412 * Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
413 * PGG:(pgg). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
414
415 @detailmenu
416 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
417
418 Starting Gnus
419
420 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
421 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
422 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
423 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
424 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
425 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
426 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
427 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
428 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
429 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
430 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
431
432 New Groups
433
434 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
435 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
436 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
437
438 Group Buffer
439
440 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
441 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
442 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
443 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
444 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
445 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
446 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
447 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
448 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
449 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
450 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
451 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
452 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
453 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
454 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
455 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
456 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
457
458 Group Buffer Format
459
460 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
461 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
462 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
463
464 Group Topics
465
466 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
467 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
468 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
469 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
470 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
471
472 Misc Group Stuff
473
474 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
475 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
476 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
477 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
478 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
479
480 Summary Buffer
481
482 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
483 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
484 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
485 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
486 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
487 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
488 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
489 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
490 * Threading:: How threads are made.
491 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
492 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
493 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
494 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
495 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
496 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
497 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
498 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
499 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
500 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
501 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
502 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
503 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
504 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
505 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
506 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
507 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
508 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
509 or reselecting the current group.
510 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
511 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
512 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
513 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
514
515 Summary Buffer Format
516
517 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
518 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
519 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
520 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
521
522 Choosing Articles
523
524 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
525 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
526
527 Reply, Followup and Post
528
529 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
530 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
531 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
532 * Canceling and Superseding::
533
534 Marking Articles
535
536 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
537 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
538 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
539 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
540 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
541 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
542
543 Threading
544
545 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
546 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
547
548 Customizing Threading
549
550 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
551 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
552 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
553 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
554
555 Decoding Articles
556
557 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
558 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
559 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
560 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
561 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
562 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
563
564 Decoding Variables
565
566 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
567 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
568 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
569
570 Article Treatment
571
572 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
573 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
574 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
575 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
576 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
577 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
578 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
579 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
580 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
581 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
582 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
583
584 Alternative Approaches
585
586 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
587 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
588
589 Various Summary Stuff
590
591 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
592 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
593 * Summary Generation Commands::
594 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
595
596 Article Buffer
597
598 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
599 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
600 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
601 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
602 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
603
604 Composing Messages
605
606 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
607 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
608 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
609 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
610 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
611 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
612 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
613 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
614 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
615
616 Select Methods
617
618 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
619 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
620 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
621 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
622 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
623 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
624 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
625 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
626
627 Server Buffer
628
629 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
630 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
631 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
632 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
633 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
634 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
635 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
636
637 Getting News
638
639 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
640 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
641
642 @acronym{NNTP}
643
644 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
645 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
646 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
647
648 Getting Mail
649
650 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
651 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
652 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
653 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
654 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
655 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
656 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
657 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
658 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
659 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
660 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
661 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
662 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
663
664 Mail Sources
665
666 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
667 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
668 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
669
670 Choosing a Mail Back End
671
672 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
673 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
674 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
675 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
676 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
677 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
678 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
679
680 Browsing the Web
681
682 * Archiving Mail::
683 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
684 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
685 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
686 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
687 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
688 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
689
690 @acronym{IMAP}
691
692 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
693 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
694 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
695 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
696 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
697 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
698
699 Other Sources
700
701 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
702 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
703 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
704 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
705 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
706
707 Document Groups
708
709 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
710
711 SOUP
712
713 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
714 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
715 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
716
717 Combined Groups
718
719 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
720 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
721
722 Gnus Unplugged
723
724 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
725 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
726 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
727 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
728 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
729 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
730 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
731 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
732 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
733 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
734 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
735 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
736 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
737
738 Agent Categories
739
740 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
741 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
742 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
743
744 Agent Commands
745
746 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
747 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
748 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
749
750 Scoring
751
752 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
753 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
754 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
755 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
756 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
757 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
758 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
759 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
760 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
761 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
762 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
763 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
764 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
765 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
766 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
767 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
768 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
769
770 GroupLens
771
772 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
773 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
774 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
775 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
776
777 Advanced Scoring
778
779 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
780 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
781 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
782
783 Various
784
785 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
786 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
787 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
788 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
789 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
790 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
791 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
792 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
793 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
794 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
795 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
796 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
797 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
798 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
799 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
800 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
801 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
802 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
803 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
804 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
805 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
806
807 Formatting Variables
808
809 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
810 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
811 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
812 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
813 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
814 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
815 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
816 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
817
818 Image Enhancements
819
820 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
821 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
822 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were
823 meant to be shown.
824 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
825 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
826
827 Thwarting Email Spam
828
829 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
830 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
831 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
832 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
833
834 Spam Package
835
836 * Spam Package Introduction::
837 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
838 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
839 * Spam and Ham Processors::
840 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
841 * Spam Back Ends::
842 * Extending the Spam package::
843 * Spam Statistics Package::
844
845 Spam Statistics Package
846
847 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
848 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
849 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
850
851 Appendices
852
853 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
854 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
855 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
856 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
857 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
858 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
859 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
860 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
861 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
862
863 History
864
865 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
866 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
867 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
868 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
869 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
870 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
871 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
872 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
873 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
874
875 New Features
876
877 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
878 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
879 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
880 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
881 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
882 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
883
884 Customization
885
886 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
887 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
888 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
889 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
890
891 Gnus Reference Guide
892
893 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
894 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
895 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
896 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
897 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
898 * Group Info:: The group info format.
899 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
900 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
901 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
902
903 Back End Interface
904
905 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
906 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
907 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
908 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
909 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
910 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
911
912 Various File Formats
913
914 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
915 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
916
917 Emacs for Heathens
918
919 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
920 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
921
922 @end detailmenu
923 @end menu
924
925 @node Starting Up
926 @chapter Starting Gnus
927 @cindex starting up
928
929 If you are haven't used Emacs much before using Gnus, read @ref{Emacs
930 for Heathens} first.
931
932 @kindex M-x gnus
933 @findex gnus
934 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
935 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
936 your Emacs. If not, you should customize the variable
937 @code{gnus-select-method} as described in @ref{Finding the News}. For a
938 minimal setup for posting should also customize the variables
939 @code{user-full-name} and @code{user-mail-address}.
940
941 @findex gnus-other-frame
942 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
943 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
944 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
945
946 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
947 variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
948 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
949
950 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
951 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
952
953 @menu
954 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
955 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
956 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
957 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
958 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
959 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
960 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
961 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
962 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
963 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
964 @end menu
965
966
967 @node Finding the News
968 @section Finding the News
969 @cindex finding news
970
971 @vindex gnus-select-method
972 @c @head
973 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
974 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
975 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
976 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
977 foreign groups.
978
979 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
980 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
981
982 @lisp
983 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
984 @end lisp
985
986 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
987
988 @lisp
989 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
990 @end lisp
991
992 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
993 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
994 server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
995 server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
996
997 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
998 @cindex NNTPSERVER
999 @cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1000 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1001 @env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1002 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1003 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1004 If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1005 as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1006
1007 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1008 If @code{gnus-nntp-server} is set, this variable will override
1009 @code{gnus-select-method}. You should therefore set
1010 @code{gnus-nntp-server} to @code{nil}, which is what it is by default.
1011
1012 @vindex gnus-secondary-servers
1013 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1014 You can also make Gnus prompt you interactively for the name of an
1015 @acronym{NNTP} server. If you give a non-numerical prefix to @code{gnus}
1016 (i.e., @kbd{C-u M-x gnus}), Gnus will let you choose between the servers
1017 in the @code{gnus-secondary-servers} list (if any). You can also just
1018 type in the name of any server you feel like visiting. (Note that this
1019 will set @code{gnus-nntp-server}, which means that if you then @kbd{M-x
1020 gnus} later in the same Emacs session, Gnus will contact the same
1021 server.)
1022
1023 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1024 @kindex B (Group)
1025 However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1026 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1027 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1028 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1029 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1030 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1031
1032 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1033 @c @head
1034 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1035 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1036 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1037 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1038 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1039 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1040 groups are.
1041
1042 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1043 you would typically set this variable to
1044
1045 @lisp
1046 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1047 @end lisp
1048
1049
1050 @node The First Time
1051 @section The First Time
1052 @cindex first time usage
1053
1054 If no startup files exist (@pxref{Startup Files}), Gnus will try to
1055 determine what groups should be subscribed by default.
1056
1057 @vindex gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups
1058 If the variable @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is set, Gnus
1059 will subscribe you to just those groups in that list, leaving the rest
1060 killed. Your system administrator should have set this variable to
1061 something useful.
1062
1063 Since she hasn't, Gnus will just subscribe you to a few arbitrarily
1064 picked groups (i.e., @samp{*.newusers}). (@dfn{Arbitrary} is defined
1065 here as @dfn{whatever Lars thinks you should read}.)
1066
1067 You'll also be subscribed to the Gnus documentation group, which should
1068 help you with most common problems.
1069
1070 If @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is @code{t}, Gnus will just
1071 use the normal functions for handling new groups, and not do anything
1072 special.
1073
1074
1075 @node The Server is Down
1076 @section The Server is Down
1077 @cindex server errors
1078
1079 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1080 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1081 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1082
1083 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1084 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1085 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1086 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1087 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1088 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1089 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1090
1091 @findex gnus-no-server
1092 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1093 @c @head
1094 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1095 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1096 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1097 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1098 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1099 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1100 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1101
1102
1103 @node Slave Gnusae
1104 @section Slave Gnusae
1105 @cindex slave
1106
1107 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1108 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1109 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1110 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1111
1112 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1113 @file{.newsrc} file.
1114
1115 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1116 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1117 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1118 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1119 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1120 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1121 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1122
1123 @findex gnus-slave
1124 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1125 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1126 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1127 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1128 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1129 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1130 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1131 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1132
1133 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1134 information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1135
1136 If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1137 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1138 file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1139 incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1140 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1141
1142
1143
1144 @node New Groups
1145 @section New Groups
1146 @cindex new groups
1147 @cindex subscription
1148
1149 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1150 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1151 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1152 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1153 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1154 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1155 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1156 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1157 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1158
1159 @menu
1160 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1161 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1162 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1163 @end menu
1164
1165
1166 @node Checking New Groups
1167 @subsection Checking New Groups
1168
1169 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing the
1170 list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of subscribed and
1171 dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method. If
1172 @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will ask the
1173 server for new groups since the last time. This is both faster and
1174 cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list of killed
1175 groups altogether, so you may set @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to
1176 @code{nil}, which will save time both at startup, at exit, and all over.
1177 Saves disk space, too. Why isn't this the default, then?
1178 Unfortunately, not all servers support this command.
1179
1180 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1181 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1182 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1183 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1184 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1185 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1186 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1187 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1188 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1189 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1190 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1191
1192 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1193 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1194 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1195 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1196 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1197 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1198
1199
1200 @node Subscription Methods
1201 @subsection Subscription Methods
1202
1203 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1204 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1205 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1206
1207 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1208 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1209
1210 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1211
1212 @table @code
1213
1214 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1215 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1216 Make all new groups zombies. This is the default. You can browse the
1217 zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either kill them all off properly
1218 (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them (with @kbd{u}).
1219
1220 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1221 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1222 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1223 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1224
1225 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1226 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1227 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1228
1229 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1230 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1231 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1232 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1233 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1234 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1235 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1236 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1237 up. Or something like that.
1238
1239 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1240 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1241 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1242 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1243 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1244
1245 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1246 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1247 Kill all new groups.
1248
1249 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1250 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1251 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1252 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1253 topic parameter that looks like
1254
1255 @example
1256 "nnslashdot"
1257 @end example
1258
1259 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1260 that topic.
1261
1262 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1263 top-level topic.
1264
1265 @end table
1266
1267 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1268 A closely related variable is
1269 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1270 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1271 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1272 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1273 hierarchy or not.
1274
1275 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1276 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1277 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1278 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1279
1280
1281 @node Filtering New Groups
1282 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1283
1284 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1285 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1286 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1287
1288 @example
1289 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1290 @end example
1291
1292 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1293 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1294 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1295 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1296 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1297 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1298 subscribing these groups.
1299 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1300 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1301
1302 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1303 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1304 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1305 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1306 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1307 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1308 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1309 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1310
1311 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1312 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1313 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1314 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1315 but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1316 more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1317 used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1318 groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1319 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, and @code{nnmaildir})
1320 subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this variable to
1321 @code{nil}.
1322
1323 New groups that match this regexp are subscribed using
1324 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1325
1326
1327 @node Changing Servers
1328 @section Changing Servers
1329 @cindex changing servers
1330
1331 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1332 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1333 very flaky and you want to use another.
1334
1335 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1336 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1337
1338 @emph{Wrong!}
1339
1340 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1341 @acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1342 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1343 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1344 worthless.
1345
1346 Gnus provides a few functions to attempt to translate a @file{.newsrc}
1347 file from one server to another. They all have one thing in
1348 common---they take a looong time to run. You don't want to use these
1349 functions more than absolutely necessary.
1350
1351 @kindex M-x gnus-change-server
1352 @findex gnus-change-server
1353 If you have access to both servers, Gnus can request the headers for all
1354 the articles you have read and compare @code{Message-ID}s and map the
1355 article numbers of the read articles and article marks. The @kbd{M-x
1356 gnus-change-server} command will do this for all your native groups. It
1357 will prompt for the method you want to move to.
1358
1359 @kindex M-x gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1360 @findex gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1361 You can also move individual groups with the @kbd{M-x
1362 gnus-group-move-group-to-server} command. This is useful if you want to
1363 move a (foreign) group from one server to another.
1364
1365 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1366 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1367 If you don't have access to both the old and new server, all your marks
1368 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use the @kbd{M-x
1369 gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} command to clear out all data
1370 that you have on your native groups. Use with caution.
1371
1372 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1373 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1374 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1375 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1376
1377 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1378 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1379 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1380 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1381 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1382 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1383 cache for all groups).
1384
1385
1386 @node Startup Files
1387 @section Startup Files
1388 @cindex startup files
1389 @cindex .newsrc
1390 @cindex .newsrc.el
1391 @cindex .newsrc.eld
1392
1393 Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1394 @file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1395 groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1396 read.
1397
1398 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1399 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1400 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1401 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1402 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1403 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1404 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1405
1406 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1407 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1408 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1409 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1410 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1411 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1412
1413 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1414 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1415 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1416 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1417 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1418 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1419 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1420 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1421 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1422 convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1423 want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1424 news reader.
1425
1426 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1427 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1428 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1429 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1430 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1431 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1432 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1433 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1434 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1435 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1436 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1437 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1438
1439 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1440 @vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1441 @vindex version-control
1442 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1443 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1444 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1445 If you want version control for this file, set
1446 @code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1447 @code{version-control} variable.
1448
1449 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1450 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1451 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1452 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1453 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1454 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1455 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1456 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1457 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1458 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1459
1460 @lisp
1461 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1462 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1463
1464 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1465 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1466 @end lisp
1467
1468 @vindex gnus-init-file
1469 @vindex gnus-site-init-file
1470 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1471 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1472 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1473 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1474 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1475 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1476 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1477 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1478 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1479 the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1480 Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1481 @code{gnus-init-file}.
1482
1483
1484 @node Auto Save
1485 @section Auto Save
1486 @cindex dribble file
1487 @cindex auto-save
1488
1489 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1490 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1491 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1492 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1493 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1494 this file.
1495
1496 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1497 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1498 saved.
1499
1500 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1501 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1502 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1503
1504 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1505 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1506 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1507 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1508 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1509 file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1510
1511 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1512 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1513 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1514
1515
1516 @node The Active File
1517 @section The Active File
1518 @cindex active file
1519 @cindex ignored groups
1520
1521 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1522 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1523 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1524
1525 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1526 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1527 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1528 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1529 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1530 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1531 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1532
1533 @c This variable is
1534 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1535 @c if you set it to anything else.
1536
1537 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1538 @c @head
1539 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1540 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1541 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1542
1543 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1544 you actually subscribe to.
1545
1546 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1547 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1548 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1549 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1550
1551 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1552 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1553 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1554 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1555 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1556 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1557
1558 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1559 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1560 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1561 variable.
1562
1563 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1564 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1565 @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1566 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1567 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1568 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1569
1570 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1571 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1572
1573 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1574 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1575
1576 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1577 secondary select methods.
1578
1579
1580 @node Startup Variables
1581 @section Startup Variables
1582
1583 @table @code
1584
1585 @item gnus-load-hook
1586 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1587 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1588 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1589 times you start Gnus.
1590
1591 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1592 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1593 A hook run after starting up Gnus successfully.
1594
1595 @item gnus-startup-hook
1596 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1597 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1598
1599 @item gnus-started-hook
1600 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1601 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1602 successfully.
1603
1604 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1605 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1606 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1607 generating the group buffer.
1608
1609 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1610 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1611 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1612 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1613 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1614 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1615 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1616 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1617
1618 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1619 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1620 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1621 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1622 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1623 @file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1624
1625 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1626 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1627 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1628
1629 @item gnus-play-startup-jingle
1630 @vindex gnus-play-startup-jingle
1631 If non-@code{nil}, play the Gnus jingle at startup.
1632
1633 @item gnus-startup-jingle
1634 @vindex gnus-startup-jingle
1635 Jingle to be played if the above variable is non-@code{nil}. The
1636 default is @samp{Tuxedomoon.Jingle4.au}.
1637
1638 @end table
1639
1640
1641 @node Group Buffer
1642 @chapter Group Buffer
1643 @cindex group buffer
1644
1645 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1646 @c
1647 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1648 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1649 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1650 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1651 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1652 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1653 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1654 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1655 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1656 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1657 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1658 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1659 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1660 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1661 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1662 @c human rights at 9...
1663
1664
1665 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1666 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1667 long as Gnus is active.
1668
1669 @iftex
1670 @iflatex
1671 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1672 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1673 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1674 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1675 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1676 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1677 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1678 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1679 }
1680 @end iflatex
1681 @end iftex
1682
1683 @menu
1684 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1685 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1686 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1687 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1688 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1689 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1690 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1691 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1692 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1693 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1694 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1695 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1696 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1697 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1698 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1699 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1700 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1701 @end menu
1702
1703
1704 @node Group Buffer Format
1705 @section Group Buffer Format
1706
1707 @menu
1708 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1709 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1710 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1711 @end menu
1712
1713 You can customize the Group Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
1714 customize-apropos RET gnus-group-tool-bar}. This feature is only
1715 available in Emacs.
1716
1717 The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly depending on the
1718 cursor position. Therefore, moving around in the Group Buffer is
1719 slower. You can disable this via the variable
1720 @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}. Its default value depends on your
1721 Emacs version.
1722
1723 @node Group Line Specification
1724 @subsection Group Line Specification
1725 @cindex group buffer format
1726
1727 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1728 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1729
1730 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1731
1732 @example
1733 25: news.announce.newusers
1734 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1735 @end example
1736
1737 Quite simple, huh?
1738
1739 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1740 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1741 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1742 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1743
1744 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1745 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1746 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1747 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1748 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C.
1749 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1750
1751 @samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1752
1753 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1754 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1755 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1756 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1757 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1758
1759 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1760 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1761 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1762
1763 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1764
1765 @table @samp
1766
1767 @item M
1768 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1769
1770 @item S
1771 Whether the group is subscribed.
1772
1773 @item L
1774 Level of subscribedness.
1775
1776 @item N
1777 Number of unread articles.
1778
1779 @item I
1780 Number of dormant articles.
1781
1782 @item T
1783 Number of ticked articles.
1784
1785 @item R
1786 Number of read articles.
1787
1788 @item U
1789 Number of unseen articles.
1790
1791 @item t
1792 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1793 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1794
1795 Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1796 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1797 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1798 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1799 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1800 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1801 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job. If you
1802 want to work on this, please contact the Gnus mailing list.
1803
1804 @item y
1805 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1806
1807 @item i
1808 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1809
1810 @item g
1811 Full group name.
1812
1813 @item G
1814 Group name.
1815
1816 @item C
1817 Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1818 comment element in the group parameters.
1819
1820 @item D
1821 Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1822 before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1823 @code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1824 command.
1825
1826 @item o
1827 @samp{m} if moderated.
1828
1829 @item O
1830 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1831
1832 @item s
1833 Select method.
1834
1835 @item B
1836 If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1837
1838 @item n
1839 Select from where.
1840
1841 @item z
1842 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1843 used.
1844
1845 @item P
1846 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1847
1848 @item c
1849 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1850 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1851 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1852 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1853 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1854
1855 @item m
1856 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1857 @cindex %
1858 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1859 the group lately.
1860
1861 @item p
1862 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1863
1864 @item d
1865 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1866 Timestamp}).
1867
1868 @item u
1869 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1870 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1871 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1872 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1873 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1874 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1875 specifier.
1876 @end table
1877
1878 @cindex *
1879 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1880 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1881 group, or a bogus native group.
1882
1883
1884 @node Group Mode Line Specification
1885 @subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1886 @cindex group mode line
1887
1888 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1889 The mode line can be changed by setting
1890 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1891 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1892
1893 @table @samp
1894 @item S
1895 The native news server.
1896 @item M
1897 The native select method.
1898 @end table
1899
1900
1901 @node Group Highlighting
1902 @subsection Group Highlighting
1903 @cindex highlighting
1904 @cindex group highlighting
1905
1906 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1907 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1908 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1909 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1910 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1911
1912 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1913 background is dark:
1914
1915 @lisp
1916 (cond (window-system
1917 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1918 (defface my-group-face-1
1919 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1920 (defface my-group-face-2
1921 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1922 "Second group face")
1923 (defface my-group-face-3
1924 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1925 (defface my-group-face-4
1926 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1927 (defface my-group-face-5
1928 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1929
1930 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1931 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1932 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1933 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1934 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1935 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1936 @end lisp
1937
1938 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1939
1940 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1941 include:
1942
1943 @table @code
1944 @item group
1945 The group name.
1946 @item unread
1947 The number of unread articles in the group.
1948 @item method
1949 The select method.
1950 @item mailp
1951 Whether the group is a mail group.
1952 @item level
1953 The level of the group.
1954 @item score
1955 The score of the group.
1956 @item ticked
1957 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1958 @item total
1959 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1960 @var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1961 @item topic
1962 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1963 topic being inserted.
1964 @end table
1965
1966 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1967 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1968 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1969
1970 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1971 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1972 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1973 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}. This hook
1974 calls @code{gnus-group-highlight-line} by default.
1975
1976
1977 @node Group Maneuvering
1978 @section Group Maneuvering
1979 @cindex group movement
1980
1981 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1982 expected, hopefully.
1983
1984 @table @kbd
1985
1986 @item n
1987 @kindex n (Group)
1988 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1989 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1990 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1991
1992 @item p
1993 @itemx DEL
1994 @kindex DEL (Group)
1995 @kindex p (Group)
1996 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
1997 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
1998 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
1999
2000 @item N
2001 @kindex N (Group)
2002 @findex gnus-group-next-group
2003 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
2004
2005 @item P
2006 @kindex P (Group)
2007 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
2008 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2009
2010 @item M-n
2011 @kindex M-n (Group)
2012 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2013 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2014 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2015
2016 @item M-p
2017 @kindex M-p (Group)
2018 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2019 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2020 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2021 @end table
2022
2023 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2024
2025 @table @kbd
2026
2027 @item j
2028 @kindex j (Group)
2029 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2030 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2031 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2032 like living groups.
2033
2034 @item ,
2035 @kindex , (Group)
2036 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2037 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2038 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2039
2040 @item .
2041 @kindex . (Group)
2042 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2043 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2044 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2045 @end table
2046
2047 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2048 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2049 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2050 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2051 is @code{t}.
2052
2053
2054 @node Selecting a Group
2055 @section Selecting a Group
2056 @cindex group selection
2057
2058 @table @kbd
2059
2060 @item SPACE
2061 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2062 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2063 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2064 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2065 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2066 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2067 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2068 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2069 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2070 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2071
2072 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2073 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2074 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2075
2076 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2077 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2078 ones.
2079
2080 @item RET
2081 @kindex RET (Group)
2082 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2083 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2084 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2085 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2086 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2087 entry.
2088
2089 @item M-RET
2090 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2091 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2092 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2093 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2094 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2095 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2096 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2097 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2098 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2099 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2100
2101 @item M-SPACE
2102 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2103 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2104 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2105 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2106 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2107
2108 @item C-M-RET
2109 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2110 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2111 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2112 doing any processing of its contents
2113 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2114 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2115 manner will have no permanent effects.
2116
2117 @end table
2118
2119 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2120 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2121 consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2122 considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2123 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2124 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2125 articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2126 negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2127 fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2128 most recently will be fetched.
2129
2130 @vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2131 @code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2132 @code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2133 newsgroups.
2134
2135 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2136 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2137 @vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2138 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2139 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2140 Which article this is is controlled by the
2141 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2142 variable are:
2143
2144 @table @code
2145
2146 @item unread
2147 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2148
2149 @item first
2150 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2151
2152 @item unseen
2153 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2154
2155 @item unseen-or-unread
2156 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2157 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2158 unread article.
2159
2160 @item best
2161 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2162
2163 @end table
2164
2165 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2166 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2167
2168 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2169 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2170 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2171 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2172 selected.
2173
2174
2175 @node Subscription Commands
2176 @section Subscription Commands
2177 @cindex subscription
2178
2179 @table @kbd
2180
2181 @item S t
2182 @itemx u
2183 @kindex S t (Group)
2184 @kindex u (Group)
2185 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2186 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2187 Toggle subscription to the current group
2188 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2189
2190 @item S s
2191 @itemx U
2192 @kindex S s (Group)
2193 @kindex U (Group)
2194 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2195 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2196 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2197 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2198
2199 @item S k
2200 @itemx C-k
2201 @kindex S k (Group)
2202 @kindex C-k (Group)
2203 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2204 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2205 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2206
2207 @item S y
2208 @itemx C-y
2209 @kindex S y (Group)
2210 @kindex C-y (Group)
2211 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2212 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2213
2214 @item C-x C-t
2215 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2216 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2217 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2218 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2219 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2220
2221 @item S w
2222 @itemx C-w
2223 @kindex S w (Group)
2224 @kindex C-w (Group)
2225 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2226 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2227
2228 @item S z
2229 @kindex S z (Group)
2230 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2231 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2232
2233 @item S C-k
2234 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2235 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2236 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2237 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2238 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2239 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2240 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2241 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2242 @file{.newsrc} file.
2243
2244 @end table
2245
2246 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2247
2248
2249 @node Group Data
2250 @section Group Data
2251
2252 @table @kbd
2253
2254 @item c
2255 @kindex c (Group)
2256 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2257 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2258 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2259 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2260 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2261 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2262 the group buffer.
2263
2264 @item C
2265 @kindex C (Group)
2266 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2267 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2268 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2269
2270 @item M-c
2271 @kindex M-c (Group)
2272 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2273 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2274 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2275
2276 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2277 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2278 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2279 If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2280 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2281 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2282 caution.
2283
2284 @end table
2285
2286
2287 @node Group Levels
2288 @section Group Levels
2289 @cindex group level
2290 @cindex level
2291
2292 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2293 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2294 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2295 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2296 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2297
2298 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2299
2300 @table @kbd
2301
2302 @item S l
2303 @kindex S l (Group)
2304 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2305 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2306 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2307 prompted for a level.
2308 @end table
2309
2310 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2311 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2312 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2313 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2314 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2315 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2316 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2317 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2318 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2319 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2320 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2321 same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2322 you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2323 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2324 reasons of efficiency.
2325
2326 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2327 low levels (e.g. 1 or 2).
2328
2329 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2330 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2331 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2332 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2333 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2334 groups are hidden, in a way.
2335
2336 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2337 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2338 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2339 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2340 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2341 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2342
2343 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2344 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2345 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2346 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2347 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2348 list of killed groups.)
2349
2350 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2351 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2352 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2353
2354 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2355 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2356 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2357 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2358 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2359 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2360 relevant valid ranges.
2361
2362 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2363 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2364 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2365 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2366 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2367 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2368 rest.
2369
2370 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2371 one with the best level.
2372
2373 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2374 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2375 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2376 by default.
2377
2378 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2379 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2380 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2381 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2382 listed.
2383
2384 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2385 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2386 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2387 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2388
2389 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2390 Gnus will normally just activate (i. e., query the server about) groups
2391 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2392 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2393 to 5. The default is 6.
2394
2395
2396 @node Group Score
2397 @section Group Score
2398 @cindex group score
2399 @cindex group rank
2400 @cindex rank
2401
2402 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2403 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2404 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2405 reason?
2406
2407 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2408 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2409 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2410 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2411 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2412 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2413 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2414 least significant part.))
2415
2416 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2417 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2418 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2419 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2420 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2421 action after each summary exit, you can add
2422 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2423 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2424 slow things down somewhat.
2425
2426
2427 @node Marking Groups
2428 @section Marking Groups
2429 @cindex marking groups
2430
2431 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2432 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2433 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2434 bidding on those groups.
2435
2436 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2437 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2438 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2439
2440 @table @kbd
2441
2442 @item #
2443 @kindex # (Group)
2444 @itemx M m
2445 @kindex M m (Group)
2446 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2447 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2448
2449 @item M-#
2450 @kindex M-# (Group)
2451 @itemx M u
2452 @kindex M u (Group)
2453 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2454 Remove the mark from the current group
2455 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2456
2457 @item M U
2458 @kindex M U (Group)
2459 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2460 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2461
2462 @item M w
2463 @kindex M w (Group)
2464 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2465 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2466
2467 @item M b
2468 @kindex M b (Group)
2469 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2470 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2471
2472 @item M r
2473 @kindex M r (Group)
2474 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2475 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2476 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2477 @end table
2478
2479 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2480
2481 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2482 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2483 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2484 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2485 the command to be executed.
2486
2487
2488 @node Foreign Groups
2489 @section Foreign Groups
2490 @cindex foreign groups
2491
2492 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2493 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2494 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2495 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2496 consulted.
2497
2498 Changes from the group editing commands are stored in
2499 @file{~/.newsrc.eld} (@code{gnus-startup-file}). An alternative is the
2500 variable @code{gnus-parameters}, @xref{Group Parameters}.
2501
2502 @table @kbd
2503
2504 @item G m
2505 @kindex G m (Group)
2506 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2507 @cindex making groups
2508 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2509 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2510 to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2511
2512 @item G M
2513 @kindex G M (Group)
2514 @findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2515 Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2516 will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2517
2518 @item G r
2519 @kindex G r (Group)
2520 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2521 @cindex renaming groups
2522 Rename the current group to something else
2523 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2524 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2525 on some back ends.
2526
2527 @item G c
2528 @kindex G c (Group)
2529 @cindex customizing
2530 @findex gnus-group-customize
2531 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2532
2533 @item G e
2534 @kindex G e (Group)
2535 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2536 @cindex renaming groups
2537 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2538 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2539
2540 @item G p
2541 @kindex G p (Group)
2542 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2543 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2544 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2545
2546 @item G E
2547 @kindex G E (Group)
2548 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2549 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2550 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2551
2552 @item G d
2553 @kindex G d (Group)
2554 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2555 @cindex nndir
2556 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2557 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2558
2559 @item G h
2560 @kindex G h (Group)
2561 @cindex help group
2562 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2563 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2564
2565 @item G a
2566 @kindex G a (Group)
2567 @cindex (ding) archive
2568 @cindex archive group
2569 @findex gnus-group-make-archive-group
2570 @vindex gnus-group-archive-directory
2571 @vindex gnus-group-recent-archive-directory
2572 Make a Gnus archive group (@code{gnus-group-make-archive-group}). By
2573 default a group pointing to the most recent articles will be created
2574 (@code{gnus-group-recent-archive-directory}), but given a prefix, a full
2575 group will be created from @code{gnus-group-archive-directory}.
2576
2577 @item G k
2578 @kindex G k (Group)
2579 @findex gnus-group-make-kiboze-group
2580 @cindex nnkiboze
2581 Make a kiboze group. You will be prompted for a name, for a regexp to
2582 match groups to be ``included'' in the kiboze group, and a series of
2583 strings to match on headers (@code{gnus-group-make-kiboze-group}).
2584 @xref{Kibozed Groups}.
2585
2586 @item G D
2587 @kindex G D (Group)
2588 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2589 @cindex nneething
2590 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2591 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2592 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2593
2594 @item G f
2595 @kindex G f (Group)
2596 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2597 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2598 @cindex nndoc
2599 Make a group based on some file or other
2600 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2601 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2602 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2603 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2604 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2605 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2606 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2607 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2608 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2609
2610 @item G u
2611 @kindex G u (Group)
2612 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2613 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2614 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2615 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2616
2617 @item G w
2618 @kindex G w (Group)
2619 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2620 @cindex Google
2621 @cindex nnweb
2622 @cindex gmane
2623 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2624 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2625 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2626 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2627 include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2628 @xref{Web Searches}.
2629
2630 If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2631 to a particular group by using a match string like
2632 @samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2633
2634 @item G R
2635 @kindex G R (Group)
2636 @findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2637 Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2638 (@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL.
2639 @xref{RSS}.
2640
2641 @item G DEL
2642 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2643 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2644 This function will delete the current group
2645 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2646 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2647 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2648 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2649 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2650
2651 @item G V
2652 @kindex G V (Group)
2653 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2654 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2655 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2656
2657 @item G v
2658 @kindex G v (Group)
2659 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2660 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2661 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2662 @end table
2663
2664 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2665 methods.
2666
2667 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2668 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2669 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2670 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2671 groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2672 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2673 newsgroups.
2674
2675
2676 @node Group Parameters
2677 @section Group Parameters
2678 @cindex group parameters
2679
2680 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2681 Here's an example group parameter list:
2682
2683 @example
2684 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2685 (auto-expire . t))
2686 @end example
2687
2688 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2689 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2690 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2691 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2692
2693 Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2694 is an alist of regexps and values.
2695
2696 The following group parameters can be used:
2697
2698 @table @code
2699 @item to-address
2700 @cindex to-address
2701 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2702
2703 @example
2704 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2705 @end example
2706
2707 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2708 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2709 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2710 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2711 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2712
2713 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2714 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2715 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2716 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2717 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2718 list address instead.
2719
2720 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2721
2722 @item to-list
2723 @cindex to-list
2724 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2725
2726 @example
2727 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2728 @end example
2729
2730 It is totally ignored
2731 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2732 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2733
2734 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2735 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2736 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2737 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2738 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2739
2740 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2741 @cindex mail list groups
2742 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2743 entering summary buffer.
2744
2745 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2746
2747 @anchor{subscribed}
2748 @item subscribed
2749 @cindex subscribed
2750 @cindex Mail-Followup-To
2751 @findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2752 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2753 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2754 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2755 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2756 headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2757 following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2758
2759 @lisp
2760 (setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2761 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2762 @end lisp
2763
2764 @xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2765 a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2766
2767 @item visible
2768 @cindex visible
2769 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2770 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2771 of whether it has any unread articles.
2772
2773 This parameter cannot be set via @code{gnus-parameters}. See
2774 @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.
2775
2776 @item broken-reply-to
2777 @cindex broken-reply-to
2778 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2779 headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2780 if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2781 can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2782 has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2783 itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2784
2785 @item to-group
2786 @cindex to-group
2787 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2788 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2789
2790 @item newsgroup
2791 @cindex newsgroup
2792 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2793 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2794 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2795 news group.
2796
2797 @item gcc-self
2798 @cindex gcc-self
2799 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2800 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2801 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2802 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2803 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2804 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2805 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
2806
2807 @strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2808 @code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2809 doesn't accept articles.
2810
2811 @item auto-expire
2812 @cindex auto-expire
2813 @cindex expiring mail
2814 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2815 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2816 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2817
2818 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2819
2820 @item total-expire
2821 @cindex total-expire
2822 @cindex expiring mail
2823 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2824 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2825 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2826 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2827 expiry.
2828
2829 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2830
2831 @item expiry-wait
2832 @cindex expiry-wait
2833 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2834 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2835 @code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2836 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2837 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2838 can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2839 symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2840
2841 @item expiry-target
2842 @cindex expiry-target
2843 Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2844 @code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2845
2846 @item score-file
2847 @cindex score file group parameter
2848 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2849 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2850 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2851
2852 @item adapt-file
2853 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2854 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2855 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2856 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2857
2858 @item admin-address
2859 @cindex admin-address
2860 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2861 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2862 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2863 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2864
2865 @item display
2866 @cindex display
2867 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2868 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2869
2870 @table @code
2871 @item all
2872 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2873
2874 @item an integer
2875 Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2876 entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2877
2878 @item default
2879 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2880 ticked articles.
2881
2882 @item an array
2883 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2884
2885 Here are some examples:
2886
2887 @table @code
2888 @item [unread]
2889 Display only unread articles.
2890
2891 @item [not expire]
2892 Display everything except expirable articles.
2893
2894 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2895 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2896 responded to.
2897 @end table
2898
2899 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2900 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2901 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2902 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2903 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, @code{unseen} and @code{recent}.
2904
2905 @end table
2906
2907 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2908 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2909 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2910
2911 @item comment
2912 @cindex comment
2913 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2914 arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
2915 group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
2916
2917 @item charset
2918 @cindex charset
2919 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
2920 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
2921 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
2922
2923 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
2924
2925 @item ignored-charsets
2926 @cindex ignored-charset
2927 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
2928 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
2929 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
2930
2931 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
2932
2933 @item posting-style
2934 @cindex posting-style
2935 You can store additional posting style information for this group
2936 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
2937 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
2938 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
2939 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
2940
2941 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
2942 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
2943 like this in the group parameters:
2944
2945 @example
2946 (posting-style
2947 (name "Funky Name")
2948 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
2949 (signature "Funky Signature"))
2950 @end example
2951
2952 @item post-method
2953 @cindex post-method
2954 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
2955 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
2956
2957 @item banner
2958 @cindex banner
2959 An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
2960 that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
2961 @var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
2962 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
2963 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
2964
2965 @item sieve
2966 @cindex sieve
2967 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
2968 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
2969 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
2970 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
2971
2972 For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
2973 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
2974 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
2975 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
2976
2977 @example
2978 if address \"sender\" \"sieve-admin@@extundo.com\" @{
2979 fileinto \"INBOX.list.sieve\";
2980 @}
2981 @end example
2982
2983 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
2984 Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
2985
2986 @item (agent parameters)
2987 If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of the its parameters
2988 to control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
2989 Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
2990 agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
2991 minimize the configuration effort.
2992
2993 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
2994 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
2995 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
2996 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
2997 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
2998 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
2999 @code{eval}ed there.
3000
3001 Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer.
3002 But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
3003 message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
3004 message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
3005 question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
3006 Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
3007 parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
3008 @file{~/.gnus} file:
3009
3010 @lisp
3011 (add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
3012 @end lisp
3013
3014 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
3015 A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
3016 the subject fields of articles. E.g. if the news group
3017
3018 @example
3019 nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3020 @end example
3021
3022 has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3023 tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3024 the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3025 into the group parameters for the group.
3026
3027 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3028 hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
3029 @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group.
3030 @code{dummy-variable} will be set to the (meaningless) result of the
3031 @code{(ding)} form.
3032
3033 Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3034 pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3035 following is added to a group parameter
3036
3037 @lisp
3038 (gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3039 '(lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3040 @end lisp
3041
3042 when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3043 expired.
3044
3045 @end table
3046
3047 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
3048 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
3049 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
3050 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
3051 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
3052
3053 @vindex gnus-parameters
3054 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3055 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect (For this
3056 case see @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.).
3057 For example:
3058
3059 @lisp
3060 (setq gnus-parameters
3061 '(("mail\\..*"
3062 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3063 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3064 (gnus-summary-line-format
3065 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3066 (gcc-self . t)
3067 (display . all))
3068
3069 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3070 (to-group . "\\1"))
3071
3072 ("mail\\.me"
3073 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3074
3075 ("list\\..*"
3076 (total-expire . t)
3077 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3078 @end lisp
3079
3080 String value of parameters will be subjected to regexp substitution, as
3081 the @code{to-group} example shows.
3082
3083 @vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3084 By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3085 specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3086 or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3087 @code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3088 value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3089 example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3090 applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3091 group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3092 value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3093 @code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3094 always in a case-insensitive manner.
3095
3096
3097 @node Listing Groups
3098 @section Listing Groups
3099 @cindex group listing
3100
3101 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3102
3103 @table @kbd
3104
3105 @item l
3106 @itemx A s
3107 @kindex A s (Group)
3108 @kindex l (Group)
3109 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
3110 List all groups that have unread articles
3111 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3112 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3113 only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3114 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3115 groups).
3116
3117 @item L
3118 @itemx A u
3119 @kindex A u (Group)
3120 @kindex L (Group)
3121 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3122 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3123 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3124 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3125 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3126 unsubscribed groups).
3127
3128 @item A l
3129 @kindex A l (Group)
3130 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3131 List all unread groups on a specific level
3132 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3133 with no unread articles.
3134
3135 @item A k
3136 @kindex A k (Group)
3137 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3138 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3139 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3140 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3141 from the server.
3142
3143 @item A z
3144 @kindex A z (Group)
3145 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3146 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3147
3148 @item A m
3149 @kindex A m (Group)
3150 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3151 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3152 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3153
3154 @item A M
3155 @kindex A M (Group)
3156 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3157 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3158
3159 @item A A
3160 @kindex A A (Group)
3161 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3162 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3163 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3164 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3165 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3166 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3167 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3168 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3169
3170 @item A a
3171 @kindex A a (Group)
3172 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3173 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3174 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3175
3176 @item A d
3177 @kindex A d (Group)
3178 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3179 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3180 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3181
3182 @item A c
3183 @kindex A c (Group)
3184 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3185 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3186
3187 @item A ?
3188 @kindex A ? (Group)
3189 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3190 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3191
3192 @item A /
3193 @kindex A / (Group)
3194 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3195 List groups limited within the current selection
3196 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}).
3197
3198 @item A f
3199 @kindex A f (Group)
3200 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3201 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3202
3203 @item A p
3204 @kindex A p (Group)
3205 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3206 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3207
3208 @end table
3209
3210 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3211 @cindex visible group parameter
3212 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3213 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3214 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3215 get the same effect.
3216
3217 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3218 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3219 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3220 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3221 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3222
3223
3224 @node Sorting Groups
3225 @section Sorting Groups
3226 @cindex sorting groups
3227
3228 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3229 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3230 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3231 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3232 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3233 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3234 include:
3235
3236 @table @code
3237
3238 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3239 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3240 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3241
3242 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3243 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3244 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3245
3246 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3247 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3248 Sort by group level.
3249
3250 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3251 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3252 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3253
3254 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3255 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3256 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3257 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3258
3259 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3260 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3261 Sort by number of unread articles.
3262
3263 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3264 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3265 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3266
3267 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3268 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3269 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3270
3271
3272 @end table
3273
3274 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3275 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3276 the last one.
3277
3278
3279 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3280 some sorting criteria:
3281
3282 @table @kbd
3283 @item G S a
3284 @kindex G S a (Group)
3285 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3286 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3287 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3288
3289 @item G S u
3290 @kindex G S u (Group)
3291 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3292 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3293 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3294
3295 @item G S l
3296 @kindex G S l (Group)
3297 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3298 Sort the group buffer by group level
3299 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3300
3301 @item G S v
3302 @kindex G S v (Group)
3303 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3304 Sort the group buffer by group score
3305 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3306
3307 @item G S r
3308 @kindex G S r (Group)
3309 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3310 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3311 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3312
3313 @item G S m
3314 @kindex G S m (Group)
3315 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3316 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3317 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3318
3319 @item G S n
3320 @kindex G S n (Group)
3321 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3322 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3323 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3324
3325 @end table
3326
3327 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3328 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3329
3330 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3331 commands will sort in reverse order.
3332
3333 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3334
3335 @table @kbd
3336 @item G P a
3337 @kindex G P a (Group)
3338 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3339 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3340 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3341
3342 @item G P u
3343 @kindex G P u (Group)
3344 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3345 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3346 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3347
3348 @item G P l
3349 @kindex G P l (Group)
3350 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3351 Sort the groups by group level
3352 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3353
3354 @item G P v
3355 @kindex G P v (Group)
3356 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3357 Sort the groups by group score
3358 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3359
3360 @item G P r
3361 @kindex G P r (Group)
3362 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3363 Sort the groups by group rank
3364 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3365
3366 @item G P m
3367 @kindex G P m (Group)
3368 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3369 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3370 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3371
3372 @item G P n
3373 @kindex G P n (Group)
3374 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3375 Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3376 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3377
3378 @item G P s
3379 @kindex G P s (Group)
3380 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3381 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3382
3383 @end table
3384
3385 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3386 move groups around.
3387
3388
3389 @node Group Maintenance
3390 @section Group Maintenance
3391 @cindex bogus groups
3392
3393 @table @kbd
3394 @item b
3395 @kindex b (Group)
3396 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3397 Find bogus groups and delete them
3398 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3399
3400 @item F
3401 @kindex F (Group)
3402 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3403 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3404 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3405 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3406 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3407 zombies.
3408
3409 @item C-c C-x
3410 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3411 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3412 @cindex expiring mail
3413 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3414 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3415 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3416 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3417
3418 @item C-c C-M-x
3419 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3420 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3421 @cindex expiring mail
3422 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3423 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3424
3425 @end table
3426
3427
3428 @node Browse Foreign Server
3429 @section Browse Foreign Server
3430 @cindex foreign servers
3431 @cindex browsing servers
3432
3433 @table @kbd
3434 @item B
3435 @kindex B (Group)
3436 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3437 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3438 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3439 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3440 @end table
3441
3442 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3443 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3444 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3445 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3446
3447 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3448
3449 @table @kbd
3450 @item n
3451 @kindex n (Browse)
3452 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3453 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3454
3455 @item p
3456 @kindex p (Browse)
3457 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3458 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3459
3460 @item SPACE
3461 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3462 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3463 Enter the current group and display the first article
3464 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3465
3466 @item RET
3467 @kindex RET (Browse)
3468 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3469 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3470
3471 @item u
3472 @kindex u (Browse)
3473 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3474 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3475 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}).
3476
3477 @item l
3478 @itemx q
3479 @kindex q (Browse)
3480 @kindex l (Browse)
3481 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3482 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3483
3484 @item d
3485 @kindex d (Browse)
3486 @findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3487 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3488
3489 @item ?
3490 @kindex ? (Browse)
3491 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3492 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3493 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3494 @end table
3495
3496
3497 @node Exiting Gnus
3498 @section Exiting Gnus
3499 @cindex exiting Gnus
3500
3501 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3502
3503 @table @kbd
3504 @item z
3505 @kindex z (Group)
3506 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3507 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3508 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3509 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3510
3511 @item q
3512 @kindex q (Group)
3513 @findex gnus-group-exit
3514 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3515 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3516
3517 @item Q
3518 @kindex Q (Group)
3519 @findex gnus-group-quit
3520 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3521 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3522 @end table
3523
3524 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3525 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3526 @vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3527 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3528 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3529 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3530 exiting Gnus.
3531
3532 Note:
3533
3534 @quotation
3535 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3536 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3537 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3538 plastic chair.
3539 @end quotation
3540
3541
3542 @node Group Topics
3543 @section Group Topics
3544 @cindex topics
3545
3546 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3547 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3548 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3549 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3550 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3551 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3552
3553 @iftex
3554 @iflatex
3555 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3556 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3557 }
3558 @end iflatex
3559 @end iftex
3560
3561 Here's an example:
3562
3563 @example
3564 Gnus
3565 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3566 3: comp.emacs
3567 2: alt.religion.emacs
3568 Naughty Emacs
3569 452: alt.sex.emacs
3570 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3571 Misc
3572 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3573 13: comp.sources.unix
3574 @end example
3575
3576 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3577 @kindex t (Group)
3578 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3579 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3580 is a toggling command.)
3581
3582 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3583 dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3584 Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3585 under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3586 Hot and bothered?
3587
3588 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3589 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3590 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3591
3592 @lisp
3593 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3594 @end lisp
3595
3596 @menu
3597 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3598 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3599 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3600 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3601 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3602 @end menu
3603
3604
3605 @node Topic Commands
3606 @subsection Topic Commands
3607 @cindex topic commands
3608
3609 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3610 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3611 definitions slightly.
3612
3613 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3614 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3615 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3616 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3617 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3618 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3619
3620 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3621 the way you like.
3622
3623 @table @kbd
3624
3625 @item T n
3626 @kindex T n (Topic)
3627 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3628 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3629 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3630
3631 @item T TAB
3632 @itemx TAB
3633 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3634 @kindex TAB (Topic)
3635 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3636 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3637 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3638 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3639
3640 @item M-TAB
3641 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3642 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3643 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3644 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3645
3646 @end table
3647
3648 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3649 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3650 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3651 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3652
3653 @table @kbd
3654
3655 @item C-k
3656 @kindex C-k (Topic)
3657 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3658 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3659 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3660
3661 @item C-y
3662 @kindex C-y (Topic)
3663 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3664 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3665 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3666 before all groups.
3667
3668 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3669 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3670 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3671 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3672 paste. Like I said -- E-Z.
3673
3674 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3675 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3676
3677 @end table
3678
3679 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3680 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3681 key.
3682
3683 @table @kbd
3684
3685 @item RET
3686 @kindex RET (Topic)
3687 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3688 @itemx SPACE
3689 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3690 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3691 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3692 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3693 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3694 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3695
3696 @end table
3697
3698 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3699
3700 @table @kbd
3701
3702 @item T m
3703 @kindex T m (Topic)
3704 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3705 Move the current group to some other topic
3706 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3707 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3708
3709 @item T j
3710 @kindex T j (Topic)
3711 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3712 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3713
3714 @item T c
3715 @kindex T c (Topic)
3716 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3717 Copy the current group to some other topic
3718 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3719 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3720
3721 @item T h
3722 @kindex T h (Topic)
3723 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3724 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3725 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3726
3727 @item T s
3728 @kindex T s (Topic)
3729 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3730 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3731 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3732
3733 @item T D
3734 @kindex T D (Topic)
3735 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3736 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3737 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3738 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3739 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3740 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3741 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3742 topic.
3743
3744 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3745 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3746
3747 @item T M
3748 @kindex T M (Topic)
3749 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3750 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3751 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3752
3753 @item T C
3754 @kindex T C (Topic)
3755 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3756 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3757 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3758
3759 @item T H
3760 @kindex T H (Topic)
3761 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3762 Toggle hiding empty topics
3763 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3764
3765 @item T #
3766 @kindex T # (Topic)
3767 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3768 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3769 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3770 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3771
3772 @item T M-#
3773 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3774 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3775 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3776 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3777 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3778
3779 @item C-c C-x
3780 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3781 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3782 @cindex expiring mail
3783 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3784 expiry process (if any)
3785 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3786
3787 @item T r
3788 @kindex T r (Topic)
3789 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3790 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3791
3792 @item T DEL
3793 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3794 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3795 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3796
3797 @item A T
3798 @kindex A T (Topic)
3799 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3800 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3801 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3802
3803 @item T M-n
3804 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3805 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3806 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3807
3808 @item T M-p
3809 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3810 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3811 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3812
3813 @item G p
3814 @kindex G p (Topic)
3815 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3816 @cindex group parameters
3817 @cindex topic parameters
3818 @cindex parameters
3819 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3820 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3821
3822 @end table
3823
3824
3825 @node Topic Variables
3826 @subsection Topic Variables
3827 @cindex topic variables
3828
3829 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
3830 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
3831
3832 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3833 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3834 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3835 Valid elements are:
3836
3837 @table @samp
3838 @item i
3839 Indentation.
3840 @item n
3841 Topic name.
3842 @item v
3843 Visibility.
3844 @item l
3845 Level.
3846 @item g
3847 Number of groups in the topic.
3848 @item a
3849 Number of unread articles in the topic.
3850 @item A
3851 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
3852 @end table
3853
3854 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
3855 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
3856 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
3857 The default is 2.
3858
3859 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
3860 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
3861
3862 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
3863 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
3864 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
3865
3866
3867 @node Topic Sorting
3868 @subsection Topic Sorting
3869 @cindex topic sorting
3870
3871 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
3872 commands:
3873
3874
3875 @table @kbd
3876 @item T S a
3877 @kindex T S a (Topic)
3878 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3879 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
3880 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3881
3882 @item T S u
3883 @kindex T S u (Topic)
3884 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
3885 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
3886 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3887
3888 @item T S l
3889 @kindex T S l (Topic)
3890 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
3891 Sort the current topic by group level
3892 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
3893
3894 @item T S v
3895 @kindex T S v (Topic)
3896 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
3897 Sort the current topic by group score
3898 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3899
3900 @item T S r
3901 @kindex T S r (Topic)
3902 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
3903 Sort the current topic by group rank
3904 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3905
3906 @item T S m
3907 @kindex T S m (Topic)
3908 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
3909 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
3910 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
3911
3912 @item T S e
3913 @kindex T S e (Topic)
3914 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
3915 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
3916 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
3917
3918 @item T S s
3919 @kindex T S s (Topic)
3920 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
3921 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
3922 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
3923 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
3924
3925 @end table
3926
3927 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
3928 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
3929 sorting.
3930
3931
3932 @node Topic Topology
3933 @subsection Topic Topology
3934 @cindex topic topology
3935 @cindex topology
3936
3937 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
3938
3939 @example
3940 @group
3941 Gnus
3942 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3943 3: comp.emacs
3944 2: alt.religion.emacs
3945 Naughty Emacs
3946 452: alt.sex.emacs
3947 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3948 Misc
3949 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3950 13: comp.sources.unix
3951 @end group
3952 @end example
3953
3954 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
3955 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
3956 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
3957 follows:
3958
3959 @lisp
3960 (("Gnus" visible)
3961 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
3962 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
3963 (("Misc" visible)))
3964 @end lisp
3965
3966 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
3967 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
3968 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
3969 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
3970 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
3971 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
3972
3973 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
3974 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
3975 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
3976
3977
3978 @node Topic Parameters
3979 @subsection Topic Parameters
3980 @cindex topic parameters
3981
3982 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
3983 (and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
3984 topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
3985 enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
3986 Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
3987
3988 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
3989 parameters:
3990
3991 @table @code
3992 @item subscribe
3993 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
3994 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
3995 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
3996 topic.
3997
3998 @item subscribe-level
3999 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
4000 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
4001 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
4002
4003 @end table
4004
4005 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
4006 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
4007 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
4008 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
4009
4010 @example
4011 @group
4012 Gnus
4013 Emacs
4014 3: comp.emacs
4015 2: alt.religion.emacs
4016 452: alt.sex.emacs
4017 Relief
4018 452: alt.sex.emacs
4019 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4020 Misc
4021 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4022 13: comp.sources.unix
4023 452: alt.sex.emacs
4024 @end group
4025 @end example
4026
4027 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4028 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4029 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4030 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4031 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4032 . "religion.SCORE")}.
4033
4034 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4035 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4036 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4037 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4038 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4039
4040 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4041 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4042 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4043 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4044 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4045 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4046 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4047 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4048
4049
4050 @node Misc Group Stuff
4051 @section Misc Group Stuff
4052
4053 @menu
4054 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4055 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4056 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4057 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4058 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
4059 @end menu
4060
4061 @table @kbd
4062
4063 @item v
4064 @kindex v (Group)
4065 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Group)
4066 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it key to some
4067 function or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4068
4069 @lisp
4070 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map (kbd "v j d")
4071 (lambda ()
4072 (interactive)
4073 (gnus-group-jump-to-group "nndraft:drafts")))
4074 @end lisp
4075
4076 On keys reserved for users in Emacs and on keybindings in general
4077 @xref{Keymaps, Keymaps, , emacs, The Emacs Editor}.
4078
4079 @item ^
4080 @kindex ^ (Group)
4081 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4082 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4083 @xref{Server Buffer}.
4084
4085 @item a
4086 @kindex a (Group)
4087 @findex gnus-group-post-news
4088 Start composing a message (a news by default)
4089 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4090 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4091 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4092 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4093 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4094
4095 @item m
4096 @kindex m (Group)
4097 @findex gnus-group-mail
4098 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4099 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4100 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4101 @xref{Composing Messages}.
4102
4103 @item i
4104 @kindex i (Group)
4105 @findex gnus-group-news
4106 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4107 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4108 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4109
4110 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4111 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4112 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4113 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4114 for this to work though.
4115
4116 @end table
4117
4118 Variables for the group buffer:
4119
4120 @table @code
4121
4122 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
4123 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4124 is called after the group buffer has been
4125 created.
4126
4127 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4128 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4129 is called after the group buffer is
4130 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4131 unnatural way.
4132
4133 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4134 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4135 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4136 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
4137
4138 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4139 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4140 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4141 whether they are empty or not.
4142
4143 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4144 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4145 An alist of method and the charset for group names. It is used to show
4146 non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4147
4148 For example:
4149 @lisp
4150 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4151 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4152 @end lisp
4153
4154 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4155 @cindex UTF-8 group names
4156 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4157 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names. It
4158 is used to show non-@acronym{ASCII} group names. @code{((".*"
4159 utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported, otherwise the
4160 default is @code{nil}.
4161
4162 For example:
4163 @lisp
4164 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4165 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)))
4166 @end lisp
4167
4168 @end table
4169
4170 @node Scanning New Messages
4171 @subsection Scanning New Messages
4172 @cindex new messages
4173 @cindex scanning new news
4174
4175 @table @kbd
4176
4177 @item g
4178 @kindex g (Group)
4179 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4180 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4181 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4182 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4183 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4184 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4185 back end(s).
4186
4187 @item M-g
4188 @kindex M-g (Group)
4189 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4190 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4191 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4192 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4193 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4194 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4195 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4196
4197 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4198 @cindex activating groups
4199 @item C-c M-g
4200 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4201 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4202
4203 @item R
4204 @kindex R (Group)
4205 @cindex restarting
4206 @findex gnus-group-restart
4207 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4208 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4209 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
4210
4211 @end table
4212
4213 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4214 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4215
4216 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4217 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4218 news.
4219
4220
4221 @node Group Information
4222 @subsection Group Information
4223 @cindex group information
4224 @cindex information on groups
4225
4226 @table @kbd
4227
4228
4229 @item H f
4230 @kindex H f (Group)
4231 @findex gnus-group-fetch-faq
4232 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
4233 @cindex FAQ
4234 @cindex ange-ftp
4235 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} for the current group
4236 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the @acronym{FAQ}
4237 from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory on
4238 a remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories.
4239 In that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
4240 between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} (or @code{efs}) will be
4241 used for fetching the file.
4242
4243 If fetching from the first site is unsuccessful, Gnus will attempt to go
4244 through @code{gnus-group-faq-directory} and try to open them one by one.
4245
4246 @item H c
4247 @kindex H c (Group)
4248 @findex gnus-group-fetch-charter
4249 @vindex gnus-group-charter-alist
4250 @cindex charter
4251 Try to open the charter for the current group in a web browser
4252 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-charter}). Query for a group if given a
4253 prefix argument.
4254
4255 Gnus will use @code{gnus-group-charter-alist} to find the location of
4256 the charter. If no location is known, Gnus will fetch the control
4257 messages for the group, which in some cases includes the charter.
4258
4259 @item H C
4260 @kindex H C (Group)
4261 @findex gnus-group-fetch-control
4262 @vindex gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url
4263 @cindex control message
4264 Fetch the control messages for the group from the archive at
4265 @code{ftp.isc.org} (@code{gnus-group-fetch-control}). Query for a
4266 group if given a prefix argument.
4267
4268 If @code{gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url} is non-@code{nil},
4269 Gnus will open the control messages in a browser using
4270 @code{browse-url}. Otherwise they are fetched using @code{ange-ftp}
4271 and displayed in an ephemeral group.
4272
4273 Note that the control messages are compressed. To use this command
4274 you need to turn on @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed
4275 Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
4276
4277 @item H d
4278 @itemx C-c C-d
4279 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4280 @kindex H d (Group)
4281 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4282 @cindex describing groups
4283 @cindex group description
4284 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
4285 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4286 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4287
4288 @item M-d
4289 @kindex M-d (Group)
4290 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4291 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4292 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4293
4294 @item H v
4295 @itemx V
4296 @kindex V (Group)
4297 @kindex H v (Group)
4298 @cindex version
4299 @findex gnus-version
4300 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4301
4302 @item ?
4303 @kindex ? (Group)
4304 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4305 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4306
4307 @item C-c C-i
4308 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4309 @cindex info
4310 @cindex manual
4311 @findex gnus-info-find-node
4312 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4313 @end table
4314
4315
4316 @node Group Timestamp
4317 @subsection Group Timestamp
4318 @cindex timestamps
4319 @cindex group timestamps
4320
4321 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4322 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4323 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4324
4325 @lisp
4326 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4327 @end lisp
4328
4329 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4330
4331 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4332 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4333
4334 @lisp
4335 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4336 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4337 @end lisp
4338
4339 This will result in lines looking like:
4340
4341 @example
4342 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4343 0: custom 19961002T012713
4344 @end example
4345
4346 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4347 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4348 something like:
4349
4350 @lisp
4351 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4352 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4353 @end lisp
4354
4355 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4356 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4357 trick:
4358
4359 @lisp
4360 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4361 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4362 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4363 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4364 (if time
4365 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4366 "")))
4367 @end lisp
4368
4369
4370 @node File Commands
4371 @subsection File Commands
4372 @cindex file commands
4373
4374 @table @kbd
4375
4376 @item r
4377 @kindex r (Group)
4378 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4379 @vindex gnus-init-file
4380 @cindex reading init file
4381 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4382 @file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4383
4384 @item s
4385 @kindex s (Group)
4386 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4387 @cindex saving .newsrc
4388 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4389 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4390 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4391
4392 @c @item Z
4393 @c @kindex Z (Group)
4394 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4395 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4396
4397 @end table
4398
4399
4400 @node Sieve Commands
4401 @subsection Sieve Commands
4402 @cindex group sieve commands
4403
4404 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4405 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4406 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4407 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4408 script that can be transfered to the server somehow.
4409
4410 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4411 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4412 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4413 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4414 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4415 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4416 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4417 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4418 regenerate the Sieve script.
4419
4420 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4421 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4422 is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4423 placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4424 is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4425 example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4426 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4427 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4428 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4429 except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4430
4431 @example
4432 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4433 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4434 stop;
4435 @}
4436 @end example
4437
4438 @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4439
4440 @table @kbd
4441
4442 @item D g
4443 @kindex D g (Group)
4444 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
4445 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4446 @cindex generating sieve script
4447 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4448 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4449
4450 @item D u
4451 @kindex D u (Group)
4452 @findex gnus-sieve-update
4453 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4454 @cindex updating sieve script
4455 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4456 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4457 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4458
4459 @end table
4460
4461
4462 @node Summary Buffer
4463 @chapter Summary Buffer
4464 @cindex summary buffer
4465
4466 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4467 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4468
4469 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4470 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4471
4472 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4473
4474 You can customize the Summary Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
4475 customize-apropos RET gnus-summary-tool-bar}. This feature is only
4476 available in Emacs.
4477
4478 @kindex v (Summary)
4479 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Summary)
4480 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it key to some
4481 function or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4482 @lisp
4483 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map (kbd "v -") "LrS") ;; lower subthread
4484 @end lisp
4485
4486 @menu
4487 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4488 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4489 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4490 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4491 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4492 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4493 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4494 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4495 * Threading:: How threads are made.
4496 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4497 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4498 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4499 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4500 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4501 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4502 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4503 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4504 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4505 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
4506 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4507 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4508 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4509 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4510 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4511 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4512 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4513 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4514 or reselecting the current group.
4515 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4516 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4517 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4518 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4519 @end menu
4520
4521
4522 @node Summary Buffer Format
4523 @section Summary Buffer Format
4524 @cindex summary buffer format
4525
4526 @iftex
4527 @iflatex
4528 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4529 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4530 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4531 }
4532 @end iflatex
4533 @end iftex
4534
4535 @menu
4536 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4537 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4538 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4539 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4540 @end menu
4541
4542 @findex mail-extract-address-components
4543 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
4544 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4545 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4546 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4547 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4548 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4549 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4550 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4551 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4552 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
4553
4554 @lisp
4555 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
4556 'mail-extract-address-components)
4557 @end lisp
4558
4559 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4560 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4561 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4562 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4563
4564
4565 @node Summary Buffer Lines
4566 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4567
4568 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4569 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4570 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4571 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4572 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4573
4574 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4575 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4576 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4577 possible to change this. Just write a new function
4578 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4579 @xref{Positioning Point}.
4580
4581 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4582
4583 The following format specification characters and extended format
4584 specification(s) are understood:
4585
4586 @table @samp
4587 @item N
4588 Article number.
4589 @item S
4590 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4591 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4592 @item s
4593 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4594 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4595 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4596 @item F
4597 Full @code{From} header.
4598 @item n
4599 The name (from the @code{From} header).
4600 @item f
4601 The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4602 From Newsgroups}).
4603 @item a
4604 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4605 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4606 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4607 may be more thorough.
4608 @item A
4609 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4610 the @code{a} spec.
4611 @item L
4612 Number of lines in the article.
4613 @item c
4614 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4615 in some methods (like nnfolder).
4616 @item k
4617 Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4618 for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4619 @item I
4620 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4621 @item B
4622 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4623 lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
4624
4625 @example
4626 >
4627 +->
4628 | +->
4629 | | \->
4630 | | \->
4631 | \->
4632 +->
4633 \->
4634 @end example
4635
4636 You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4637 that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4638 replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4639 line-drawing glyphs.
4640 @table @code
4641 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4642 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4643 Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4644 instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4645
4646 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4647 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4648 Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4649 @code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4650
4651 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4652 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4653 Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4654 instead. The default is @samp{}.
4655
4656 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4657 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4658 Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
4659
4660 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4661 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4662 Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
4663
4664 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4665 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4666 Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
4667
4668 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4669 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4670 Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
4671
4672 @end table
4673
4674 @item T
4675 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4676 pushes everything after it off the screen).
4677 @item [
4678 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4679 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4680 @item ]
4681 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4682 for adopted articles.
4683 @item >
4684 One space for each thread level.
4685 @item <
4686 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4687 @item U
4688 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4689
4690 @item R
4691 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4692 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4693 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4694
4695 @item i
4696 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4697 @item z
4698 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4699 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4700 default level. If the difference between
4701 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4702 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4703 @item V
4704 Total thread score.
4705 @item x
4706 @code{Xref}.
4707 @item D
4708 @code{Date}.
4709 @item d
4710 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4711 @item o
4712 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4713 @item M
4714 @code{Message-ID}.
4715 @item r
4716 @code{References}.
4717 @item t
4718 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4719 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4720 @item e
4721 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4722 article has any children.
4723 @item P
4724 The line number.
4725 @item O
4726 Download mark.
4727 @item *
4728 Desired cursor position (instead of after first colon).
4729 @item &user-date;
4730 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4731 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4732 @item u
4733 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4734 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4735 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4736 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4737 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4738 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4739 @end table
4740
4741 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4742 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4743 There can only be one such area.
4744
4745 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4746 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4747 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4748 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4749 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4750 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4751
4752 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4753 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4754
4755 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
4756
4757
4758 @node To From Newsgroups
4759 @subsection To From Newsgroups
4760 @cindex To
4761 @cindex Newsgroups
4762
4763 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4764 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
4765 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
4766 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
4767 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4768
4769 @enumerate
4770 @item
4771 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
4772 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
4773 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
4774 instance:
4775
4776 @lisp
4777 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4778 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
4779 @end lisp
4780
4781 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
4782 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
4783
4784 @item
4785 @findex gnus-extra-header
4786 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
4787 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
4788 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
4789
4790 @example
4791 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
4792 @end example
4793
4794 @item
4795 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4796 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
4797 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
4798 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
4799 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
4800 headers are used instead.
4801
4802 @end enumerate
4803
4804 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
4805 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
4806 to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
4807 If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
4808 changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
4809 and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g. nnml) to cause
4810 regeneration.
4811
4812 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4813 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
4814 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
4815 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
4816
4817 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
4818 @file{~/.gnus.el}:
4819
4820 @lisp
4821 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4822 '(To Newsgroups))
4823 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
4824 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
4825 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
4826 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4827 "Your Name Here")
4828 @end lisp
4829
4830 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
4831 to fit your needs.)
4832
4833 A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
4834 convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
4835 support:
4836
4837 The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
4838 the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
4839 nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
4840
4841 @example
4842 Newsgroups:full
4843 @end example
4844
4845 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
4846 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
4847
4848
4849 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
4850 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
4851
4852 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
4853 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
4854 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
4855 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
4856
4857 Here are the elements you can play with:
4858
4859 @table @samp
4860 @item G
4861 Group name.
4862 @item p
4863 Unprefixed group name.
4864 @item A
4865 Current article number.
4866 @item z
4867 Current article score.
4868 @item V
4869 Gnus version.
4870 @item U
4871 Number of unread articles in this group.
4872 @item e
4873 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
4874 summary buffer.
4875 @item Z
4876 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
4877 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
4878 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
4879 and no unselected ones.
4880 @item g
4881 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
4882 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
4883 @item S
4884 Subject of the current article.
4885 @item u
4886 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
4887 @item s
4888 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
4889 @item d
4890 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4891 @item t
4892 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4893 @item r
4894 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
4895 @item E
4896 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
4897 @end table
4898
4899
4900 @node Summary Highlighting
4901 @subsection Summary Highlighting
4902
4903 @table @code
4904
4905 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4906 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4907 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
4908 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
4909 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4910
4911 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
4912 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
4913 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
4914 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4915
4916 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
4917 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
4918 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
4919 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
4920
4921 @item gnus-summary-highlight
4922 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
4923 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
4924 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
4925 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
4926 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
4927 to something like
4928 @lisp
4929 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
4930 ((> score default) . bold))
4931 @end lisp
4932 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
4933 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
4934 @end table
4935
4936
4937 @node Summary Maneuvering
4938 @section Summary Maneuvering
4939 @cindex summary movement
4940
4941 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
4942 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
4943
4944 None of these commands select articles.
4945
4946 @table @kbd
4947 @item G M-n
4948 @itemx M-n
4949 @kindex M-n (Summary)
4950 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
4951 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
4952 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
4953 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
4954
4955 @item G M-p
4956 @itemx M-p
4957 @kindex M-p (Summary)
4958 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
4959 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
4960 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
4961 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
4962
4963 @item G g
4964 @kindex G g (Summary)
4965 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
4966 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
4967 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
4968 @end table
4969
4970 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
4971 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
4972 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
4973 to the group buffer.
4974
4975 Variables related to summary movement:
4976
4977 @table @code
4978
4979 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
4980 @item gnus-auto-select-next
4981 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
4982 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
4983 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
4984 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
4985 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
4986 next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
4987 is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
4988 confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
4989 will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
4990 Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
4991 command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
4992 @pxref{Group Levels}.
4993
4994 @item gnus-auto-select-same
4995 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
4996 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
4997 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
4998 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
4999 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
5000 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
5001
5002 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
5003
5004 @item gnus-summary-check-current
5005 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
5006 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
5007 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
5008 Instead, they will choose the current article.
5009
5010 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
5011 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
5012 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
5013 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
5014 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
5015 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
5016 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
5017 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
5018 threads.
5019
5020 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
5021 the given number of lines from the top.
5022
5023 @end table
5024
5025
5026 @node Choosing Articles
5027 @section Choosing Articles
5028 @cindex selecting articles
5029
5030 @menu
5031 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
5032 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
5033 @end menu
5034
5035
5036 @node Choosing Commands
5037 @subsection Choosing Commands
5038
5039 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
5040 and they all select and display an article.
5041
5042 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
5043 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
5044
5045 @table @kbd
5046 @item SPACE
5047 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5048 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5049 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
5050 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5051
5052 If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
5053 again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
5054 @kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
5055
5056 @item G n
5057 @itemx n
5058 @kindex n (Summary)
5059 @kindex G n (Summary)
5060 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
5061 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
5062 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
5063
5064 @item G p
5065 @itemx p
5066 @kindex p (Summary)
5067 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5068 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5069 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
5070
5071 @item G N
5072 @itemx N
5073 @kindex N (Summary)
5074 @kindex G N (Summary)
5075 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
5076 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
5077
5078 @item G P
5079 @itemx P
5080 @kindex P (Summary)
5081 @kindex G P (Summary)
5082 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5083 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
5084
5085 @item G C-n
5086 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
5087 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5088 Go to the next article with the same subject
5089 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
5090
5091 @item G C-p
5092 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
5093 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5094 Go to the previous article with the same subject
5095 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
5096
5097 @item G f
5098 @itemx .
5099 @kindex G f (Summary)
5100 @kindex . (Summary)
5101 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5102 Go to the first unread article
5103 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
5104
5105 @item G b
5106 @itemx ,
5107 @kindex G b (Summary)
5108 @kindex , (Summary)
5109 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5110 Go to the unread article with the highest score
5111 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5112 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
5113
5114 @item G l
5115 @itemx l
5116 @kindex l (Summary)
5117 @kindex G l (Summary)
5118 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5119 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
5120
5121 @item G o
5122 @kindex G o (Summary)
5123 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5124 @cindex history
5125 @cindex article history
5126 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5127 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5128 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5129 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5130 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5131 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
5132
5133 @item G j
5134 @itemx j
5135 @kindex j (Summary)
5136 @kindex G j (Summary)
5137 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5138 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5139 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
5140
5141 @end table
5142
5143
5144 @node Choosing Variables
5145 @subsection Choosing Variables
5146
5147 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
5148
5149 @table @code
5150 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5151 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5152 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5153 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5154 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5155 the server and display it in the article buffer.
5156
5157 @item gnus-select-article-hook
5158 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5159 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
5160 @code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
5161 you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
5162 hook will do so.
5163
5164 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
5165 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5166 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5167 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5168 @findex gnus-unread-mark
5169 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5170 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5171 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5172 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
5173 articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5174 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5175 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5176 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5177 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
5178
5179 @end table
5180
5181
5182 @node Paging the Article
5183 @section Scrolling the Article
5184 @cindex article scrolling
5185
5186 @table @kbd
5187
5188 @item SPACE
5189 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5190 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5191 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5192 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5193 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5194
5195 @vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5196 @vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5197 If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5198 the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5199 skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5200 what is considered uninteresting with
5201 @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5202 pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
5203
5204 @item DEL
5205 @kindex DEL (Summary)
5206 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5207 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
5208
5209 @item RET
5210 @kindex RET (Summary)
5211 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5212 Scroll the current article one line forward
5213 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
5214
5215 @item M-RET
5216 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
5217 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5218 Scroll the current article one line backward
5219 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
5220
5221 @item A g
5222 @itemx g
5223 @kindex A g (Summary)
5224 @kindex g (Summary)
5225 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
5226 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5227 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5228 given a prefix, fetch the current article, but don't run any of the
5229 article treatment functions. This will give you a ``raw'' article, just
5230 the way it came from the server.
5231
5232 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5233 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5234 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
5235
5236 @lisp
5237 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5238 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
5239 (2 . big5)))
5240 @end lisp
5241
5242 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
5243
5244 @item A <
5245 @itemx <
5246 @kindex < (Summary)
5247 @kindex A < (Summary)
5248 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5249 Scroll to the beginning of the article
5250 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
5251
5252 @item A >
5253 @itemx >
5254 @kindex > (Summary)
5255 @kindex A > (Summary)
5256 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5257 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
5258
5259 @item A s
5260 @itemx s
5261 @kindex A s (Summary)
5262 @kindex s (Summary)
5263 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5264 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5265 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
5266
5267 @item h
5268 @kindex h (Summary)
5269 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5270 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5271
5272 @end table
5273
5274
5275 @node Reply Followup and Post
5276 @section Reply, Followup and Post
5277
5278 @menu
5279 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5280 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5281 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5282 * Canceling and Superseding::
5283 @end menu
5284
5285
5286 @node Summary Mail Commands
5287 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
5288 @cindex mail
5289 @cindex composing mail
5290
5291 Commands for composing a mail message:
5292
5293 @table @kbd
5294
5295 @item S r
5296 @itemx r
5297 @kindex S r (Summary)
5298 @kindex r (Summary)
5299 @findex gnus-summary-reply
5300 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5301 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5302 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5303 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5304
5305 @item S R
5306 @itemx R
5307 @kindex R (Summary)
5308 @kindex S R (Summary)
5309 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5310 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5311 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5312 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5313 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5314
5315 @item S w
5316 @kindex S w (Summary)
5317 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5318 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5319 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5320 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5321 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5322 present, that's used instead.
5323
5324 @item S W
5325 @kindex S W (Summary)
5326 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5327 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5328 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5329 the process/prefix convention.
5330
5331 @item S v
5332 @kindex S v (Summary)
5333 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5334 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5335 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5336 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5337 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5338 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5339
5340 @item S V
5341 @kindex S V (Summary)
5342 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5343 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5344 original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5345 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5346
5347 @item S B r
5348 @kindex S B r (Summary)
5349 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5350 Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5351 @code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5352 If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5353 @code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5354 the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5355 correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5356
5357 @item S B R
5358 @kindex S B R (Summary)
5359 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5360 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5361 original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5362 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5363
5364 @item S o m
5365 @itemx C-c C-f
5366 @kindex S o m (Summary)
5367 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5368 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5369 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5370 Forward the current article to some other person
5371 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5372 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5373 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5374 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5375 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5376 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5377 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5378 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5379 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5380 section.
5381
5382 @item S m
5383 @itemx m
5384 @kindex m (Summary)
5385 @kindex S m (Summary)
5386 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5387 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5388 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5389 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5390 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5391
5392 @item S i
5393 @itemx i
5394 @kindex i (Summary)
5395 @kindex S i (Summary)
5396 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5397 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5398 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5399 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5400
5401 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5402 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5403 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5404 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5405 for this to work though.
5406
5407 @item S D b
5408 @kindex S D b (Summary)
5409 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5410 @cindex bouncing mail
5411 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5412 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5413 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5414 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5415 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5416 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5417 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5418 very well fail, though.
5419
5420 @item S D r
5421 @kindex S D r (Summary)
5422 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5423 Not to be confused with the previous command,
5424 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5425 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5426 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5427 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5428 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5429 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5430 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5431
5432 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5433 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5434 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5435 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5436 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5437
5438 This command understands the process/prefix convention
5439 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5440
5441 @item S D e
5442 @kindex S D e (Summary)
5443 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5444
5445 Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5446 if it were a new message before resending.
5447
5448 @item S O m
5449 @kindex S O m (Summary)
5450 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5451 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5452 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5453 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5454
5455 @item S M-c
5456 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
5457 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5458 @cindex crossposting
5459 @cindex excessive crossposting
5460 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5461 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5462
5463 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5464 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5465 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5466 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5467 command understands the process/prefix convention
5468 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5469
5470 @end table
5471
5472 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5473 Manual}, for more information.
5474
5475
5476 @node Summary Post Commands
5477 @subsection Summary Post Commands
5478 @cindex post
5479 @cindex composing news
5480
5481 Commands for posting a news article:
5482
5483 @table @kbd
5484 @item S p
5485 @itemx a
5486 @kindex a (Summary)
5487 @kindex S p (Summary)
5488 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
5489 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5490 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5491 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5492 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5493
5494 @item S f
5495 @itemx f
5496 @kindex f (Summary)
5497 @kindex S f (Summary)
5498 @findex gnus-summary-followup
5499 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5500 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5501
5502 @item S F
5503 @itemx F
5504 @kindex S F (Summary)
5505 @kindex F (Summary)
5506 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5507 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5508 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5509 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5510 process/prefix convention.
5511
5512 @item S n
5513 @kindex S n (Summary)
5514 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5515 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5516 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5517
5518 @item S N
5519 @kindex S N (Summary)
5520 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5521 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5522 message through mail and include the original message
5523 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5524 the process/prefix convention.
5525
5526 @item S o p
5527 @kindex S o p (Summary)
5528 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5529 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5530 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5531 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5532 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5533 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5534 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5535 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5536 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5537 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5538 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5539 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
5540
5541 @item S O p
5542 @kindex S O p (Summary)
5543 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5544 @cindex digests
5545 @cindex making digests
5546 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5547 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
5548 process/prefix convention.
5549
5550 @item S u
5551 @kindex S u (Summary)
5552 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
5553 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5554 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5555 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5556 @end table
5557
5558 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5559 Manual}, for more information.
5560
5561
5562 @node Summary Message Commands
5563 @subsection Summary Message Commands
5564
5565 @table @kbd
5566 @item S y
5567 @kindex S y (Summary)
5568 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5569 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5570 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5571 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5572 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5573
5574 @end table
5575
5576
5577 @node Canceling and Superseding
5578 @subsection Canceling Articles
5579 @cindex canceling articles
5580 @cindex superseding articles
5581
5582 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5583 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5584
5585 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5586
5587 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5588 @kindex C (Summary)
5589 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5590 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5591 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5592 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5593 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5594 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5595
5596 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5597 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5598 question.
5599
5600 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5601 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5602 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5603
5604 Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5605 @code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5606 message, Message Manual}).
5607
5608 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5609 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5610 your original article.
5611
5612 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5613 @kindex S (Summary)
5614 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5615 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5616 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5617 usual way.
5618
5619 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5620 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5621 have posted almost the same article twice.
5622
5623 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5624 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5625 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5626 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5627 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5628 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5629 header by substituting one of those words for the word
5630 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5631 you would do normally. The previous article will be
5632 canceled/superseded.
5633
5634 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5635
5636 @node Delayed Articles
5637 @section Delayed Articles
5638 @cindex delayed sending
5639 @cindex send delayed
5640
5641 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5642 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5643 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5644 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5645
5646 @lisp
5647 (gnus-delay-initialize)
5648 @end lisp
5649
5650 @findex gnus-delay-article
5651 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5652 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5653 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5654 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5655
5656 @itemize @bullet
5657 @item
5658 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5659 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5660 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5661 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
5662
5663 @item
5664 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5665 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5666 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5667
5668 @item
5669 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5670 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5671 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5672 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5673 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5674 that means a time tomorrow.
5675 @end itemize
5676
5677 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5678 couple of variables:
5679
5680 @table @code
5681 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
5682 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5683 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5684 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5685
5686 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
5687 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5688 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5689 formats described above.
5690
5691 @item gnus-delay-group
5692 @vindex gnus-delay-group
5693 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5694 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5695 value is @code{"delayed"}.
5696
5697 @item gnus-delay-header
5698 @vindex gnus-delay-header
5699 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5700 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5701 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5702 @end table
5703
5704 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5705 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5706 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5707 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5708 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5709
5710 @findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5711 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5712 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5713 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5714 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5715 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5716 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5717
5718 @table @code
5719 @item gnus-delay-initialize
5720 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
5721 By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5722 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5723 argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5724 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5725 argument is ignored.
5726
5727 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5728 Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5729 Just don't forget to set that up :-)
5730 @end table
5731
5732
5733 @node Marking Articles
5734 @section Marking Articles
5735 @cindex article marking
5736 @cindex article ticking
5737 @cindex marks
5738
5739 There are several marks you can set on an article.
5740
5741 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
5742 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
5743 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
5744
5745 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
5746
5747 @ifinfo
5748 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
5749 @end ifinfo
5750
5751 @menu
5752 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
5753 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
5754 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
5755 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
5756 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
5757 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
5758 @end menu
5759
5760
5761 @node Unread Articles
5762 @subsection Unread Articles
5763
5764 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
5765 other.
5766
5767 @table @samp
5768 @item !
5769 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
5770 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
5771
5772 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
5773 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
5774 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
5775 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
5776 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
5777 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
5778 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
5779
5780 @item ?
5781 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
5782 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
5783
5784 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
5785 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
5786 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
5787 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
5788 messages.
5789
5790 @item SPACE
5791 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
5792 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
5793
5794 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
5795 @end table
5796
5797
5798 @node Read Articles
5799 @subsection Read Articles
5800 @cindex expirable mark
5801
5802 All the following marks mark articles as read.
5803
5804 @table @samp
5805
5806 @item r
5807 @vindex gnus-del-mark
5808 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
5809 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
5810
5811 @item R
5812 @vindex gnus-read-mark
5813 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
5814
5815 @item O
5816 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
5817 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
5818 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
5819
5820 @item K
5821 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
5822 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
5823
5824 @item X
5825 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
5826 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
5827
5828 @item Y
5829 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
5830 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
5831
5832 @item C
5833 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
5834 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
5835
5836 @item G
5837 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
5838 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
5839
5840 @item F
5841 @vindex gnus-souped-mark
5842 @sc{soup}ed article (@code{gnus-souped-mark}). @xref{SOUP}.
5843
5844 @item Q
5845 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
5846 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
5847 Threading}.
5848
5849 @item M
5850 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
5851 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
5852 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
5853
5854 @end table
5855
5856 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
5857 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
5858
5859 One more special mark, though:
5860
5861 @table @samp
5862 @item E
5863 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
5864 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
5865
5866 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
5867 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
5868 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
5869 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
5870 any time.
5871 @end table
5872
5873
5874 @node Other Marks
5875 @subsection Other Marks
5876 @cindex process mark
5877 @cindex bookmarks
5878
5879 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
5880 read or not.
5881
5882 @itemize @bullet
5883
5884 @item
5885 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
5886 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
5887 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
5888 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
5889 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
5890
5891 @item
5892 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
5893 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
5894 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
5895 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
5896
5897 @item
5898 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
5899 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
5900 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
5901
5902 @item
5903 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
5904 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
5905 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5906
5907 @item
5908 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
5909 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
5910 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
5911 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
5912
5913 @item
5914 @vindex gnus-recent-mark
5915 Articles that according to the server haven't been shown to the user
5916 before are marked with a @samp{N} in the second column
5917 (@code{gnus-recent-mark}). Note that not all servers support this
5918 mark, in which case it simply never appears. Compare with
5919 @code{gnus-unseen-mark}.
5920
5921 @item
5922 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
5923 Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
5924 with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
5925 Compare with @code{gnus-recent-mark}.
5926
5927 @item
5928 @vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
5929 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
5930 downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
5931 @samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
5932 (The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
5933 use.)
5934
5935 @item
5936 @vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
5937 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
5938 not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
5939 are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
5940 articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
5941 @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
5942
5943 @item
5944 @vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
5945 The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
5946 automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
5947 download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
5948 explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
5949 (The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
5950 use.)
5951
5952 @item
5953 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
5954 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
5955 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
5956 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
5957 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
5958
5959 @item
5960 @vindex gnus-process-mark
5961 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
5962 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
5963 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
5964 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
5965 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
5966
5967 @end itemize
5968
5969 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
5970 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
5971 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
5972
5973 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
5974 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
5975 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
5976
5977
5978 @node Setting Marks
5979 @subsection Setting Marks
5980 @cindex setting marks
5981
5982 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
5983
5984 @table @kbd
5985 @item M c
5986 @itemx M-u
5987 @kindex M c (Summary)
5988 @kindex M-u (Summary)
5989 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
5990 @cindex mark as unread
5991 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
5992 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
5993 article as unread.
5994
5995 @item M t
5996 @itemx !
5997 @kindex ! (Summary)
5998 @kindex M t (Summary)
5999 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
6000 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
6001 @xref{Article Caching}.
6002
6003 @item M ?
6004 @itemx ?
6005 @kindex ? (Summary)
6006 @kindex M ? (Summary)
6007 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
6008 Mark the current article as dormant
6009 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6010
6011 @item M d
6012 @itemx d
6013 @kindex M d (Summary)
6014 @kindex d (Summary)
6015 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
6016 Mark the current article as read
6017 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
6018
6019 @item D
6020 @kindex D (Summary)
6021 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
6022 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
6023 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
6024
6025 @item M k
6026 @itemx k
6027 @kindex k (Summary)
6028 @kindex M k (Summary)
6029 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
6030 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
6031 and then select the next unread article
6032 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
6033
6034 @item M K
6035 @itemx C-k
6036 @kindex M K (Summary)
6037 @kindex C-k (Summary)
6038 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
6039 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
6040 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
6041
6042 @item M C
6043 @kindex M C (Summary)
6044 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
6045 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
6046 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
6047
6048 @item M C-c
6049 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
6050 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
6051 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
6052 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
6053
6054 @item M H
6055 @kindex M H (Summary)
6056 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
6057 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
6058 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
6059
6060 @item M h
6061 @kindex M h (Summary)
6062 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
6063 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
6064 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
6065
6066 @item C-w
6067 @kindex C-w (Summary)
6068 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6069 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6070 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
6071
6072 @item M V k
6073 @kindex M V k (Summary)
6074 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6075 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6076 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
6077
6078 @item M e
6079 @itemx E
6080 @kindex M e (Summary)
6081 @kindex E (Summary)
6082 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6083 Mark the current article as expirable
6084 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
6085
6086 @item M b
6087 @kindex M b (Summary)
6088 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6089 Set a bookmark in the current article
6090 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
6091
6092 @item M B
6093 @kindex M B (Summary)
6094 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6095 Remove the bookmark from the current article
6096 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
6097
6098 @item M V c
6099 @kindex M V c (Summary)
6100 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6101 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6102 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6103
6104 @item M V u
6105 @kindex M V u (Summary)
6106 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6107 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6108 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
6109
6110 @item M V m
6111 @kindex M V m (Summary)
6112 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6113 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6114 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6115 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6116 @end table
6117
6118 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6119 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6120 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6121 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6122 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6123 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6124 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6125 The default is @code{t}.
6126
6127
6128 @node Generic Marking Commands
6129 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
6130
6131 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
6132 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6133 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
6134 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
6135 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6136 well.
6137
6138 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6139 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6140 command should do.
6141
6142 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6143 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6144 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6145 to list in this manual.
6146
6147 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6148 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6149 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6150 article, you could say something like:
6151
6152 @lisp
6153 @group
6154 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6155 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6156 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6157 @end group
6158 @end lisp
6159
6160 @noindent
6161 or
6162
6163 @lisp
6164 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6165 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6166 @end lisp
6167
6168
6169 @node Setting Process Marks
6170 @subsection Setting Process Marks
6171 @cindex setting process marks
6172
6173 Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6174 used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6175 process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6176 articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6177 commands into the cache. For more information,
6178 @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
6179
6180 @table @kbd
6181
6182 @item M P p
6183 @itemx #
6184 @kindex # (Summary)
6185 @kindex M P p (Summary)
6186 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6187 Mark the current article with the process mark
6188 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6189 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
6190
6191 @item M P u
6192 @itemx M-#
6193 @kindex M P u (Summary)
6194 @kindex M-# (Summary)
6195 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6196 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
6197
6198 @item M P U
6199 @kindex M P U (Summary)
6200 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6201 Remove the process mark from all articles
6202 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
6203
6204 @item M P i
6205 @kindex M P i (Summary)
6206 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6207 Invert the list of process marked articles
6208 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
6209
6210 @item M P R
6211 @kindex M P R (Summary)
6212 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6213 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6214 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
6215
6216 @item M P G
6217 @kindex M P G (Summary)
6218 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6219 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6220 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
6221
6222 @item M P r
6223 @kindex M P r (Summary)
6224 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6225 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
6226
6227 @item M P g
6228 @kindex M P g (Summary)
6229 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6230 Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
6231
6232 @item M P t
6233 @kindex M P t (Summary)
6234 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6235 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6236 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6237
6238 @item M P T
6239 @kindex M P T (Summary)
6240 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6241 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6242 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6243
6244 @item M P v
6245 @kindex M P v (Summary)
6246 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6247 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6248 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
6249
6250 @item M P s
6251 @kindex M P s (Summary)
6252 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6253 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6254
6255 @item M P S
6256 @kindex M P S (Summary)
6257 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6258 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6259 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
6260
6261 @item M P a
6262 @kindex M P a (Summary)
6263 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6264 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6265
6266 @item M P b
6267 @kindex M P b (Summary)
6268 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6269 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6270 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6271
6272 @item M P k
6273 @kindex M P k (Summary)
6274 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6275 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6276 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6277
6278 @item M P y
6279 @kindex M P y (Summary)
6280 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6281 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6282 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
6283
6284 @item M P w
6285 @kindex M P w (Summary)
6286 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6287 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6288 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
6289
6290 @end table
6291
6292 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6293 set process marks based on article body contents.
6294
6295
6296 @node Limiting
6297 @section Limiting
6298 @cindex limiting
6299
6300 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6301 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6302 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6303 buffer.
6304
6305 All limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched
6306 from the servers. None of these commands query the server for
6307 additional articles.
6308
6309 @table @kbd
6310
6311 @item / /
6312 @itemx / s
6313 @kindex / / (Summary)
6314 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6315 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6316 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6317 matching articles.
6318
6319 @item / a
6320 @kindex / a (Summary)
6321 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6322 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6323 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6324 matching articles.
6325
6326 @item / x
6327 @kindex / x (Summary)
6328 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6329 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6330 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6331 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6332 matching articles.
6333
6334 @item / u
6335 @itemx x
6336 @kindex / u (Summary)
6337 @kindex x (Summary)
6338 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6339 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6340 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6341 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6342 dormant articles will also be excluded.
6343
6344 @item / m
6345 @kindex / m (Summary)
6346 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6347 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6348 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
6349
6350 @item / t
6351 @kindex / t (Summary)
6352 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6353 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6354 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6355 articles younger than that number of days.
6356
6357 @item / n
6358 @kindex / n (Summary)
6359 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6360 With prefix @samp{n}, limit the summary buffer to the next @samp{n}
6361 articles. If not given a prefix, use the process marked articles
6362 instead. (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}).
6363
6364 @item / w
6365 @kindex / w (Summary)
6366 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6367 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6368 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6369 the stack.
6370
6371 @item / .
6372 @kindex / . (Summary)
6373 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6374 Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6375 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
6376
6377 @item / v
6378 @kindex / v (Summary)
6379 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6380 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6381 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6382
6383 @item / p
6384 @kindex / p (Summary)
6385 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6386 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6387 group parameter predicate
6388 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6389 Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
6390
6391 @item / E
6392 @itemx M S
6393 @kindex M S (Summary)
6394 @kindex / E (Summary)
6395 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6396 Include all expunged articles in the limit
6397 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6398
6399 @item / D
6400 @kindex / D (Summary)
6401 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6402 Include all dormant articles in the limit
6403 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6404
6405 @item / *
6406 @kindex / * (Summary)
6407 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6408 Include all cached articles in the limit
6409 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6410
6411 @item / d
6412 @kindex / d (Summary)
6413 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6414 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6415 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6416
6417 @item / M
6418 @kindex / M (Summary)
6419 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6420 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6421
6422 @item / T
6423 @kindex / T (Summary)
6424 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6425 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6426
6427 @item / c
6428 @kindex / c (Summary)
6429 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6430 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6431 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6432
6433 @item / C
6434 @kindex / C (Summary)
6435 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6436 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6437 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6438 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6439
6440 @item / N
6441 @kindex / N (Summary)
6442 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6443 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6444 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6445
6446 @item / o
6447 @kindex / o (Summary)
6448 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6449 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6450 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6451
6452 @end table
6453
6454
6455 @node Threading
6456 @section Threading
6457 @cindex threading
6458 @cindex article threading
6459
6460 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6461 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6462 hierarchical fashion.
6463
6464 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6465 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6466 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6467 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6468 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6469 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6470 @ref{Customizing Threading}.
6471
6472 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6473
6474 @table @dfn
6475 @item root
6476 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6477
6478 @item thread
6479 A tree-like article structure.
6480
6481 @item sub-thread
6482 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6483
6484 @item loose threads
6485 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6486 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6487 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6488 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6489 called loose threads.
6490
6491 @item thread gathering
6492 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6493
6494 @item sparse threads
6495 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6496 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6497
6498 @end table
6499
6500
6501 @menu
6502 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6503 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6504 @end menu
6505
6506
6507 @node Customizing Threading
6508 @subsection Customizing Threading
6509 @cindex customizing threading
6510
6511 @menu
6512 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6513 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6514 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6515 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6516 @end menu
6517
6518
6519 @node Loose Threads
6520 @subsubsection Loose Threads
6521 @cindex <
6522 @cindex >
6523 @cindex loose threads
6524
6525 @table @code
6526 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6527 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6528 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6529 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6530 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6531 read or killed the root in a previous session.
6532
6533 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6534 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6535 There are four possible values:
6536
6537 @iftex
6538 @iflatex
6539 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6540 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6541 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6542 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6543 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6544 }
6545 @end iflatex
6546 @end iftex
6547
6548 @cindex adopting articles
6549
6550 @table @code
6551
6552 @item adopt
6553 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6554 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6555 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6556 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6557
6558 @item dummy
6559 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6560 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6561 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6562 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6563 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6564 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6565 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6566 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6567 If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6568 ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
6569
6570 @item empty
6571 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6572 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6573 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6574 Buffer Format}).)
6575
6576 @item none
6577 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6578 display them after one another.
6579
6580 @item nil
6581 Don't gather loose threads.
6582 @end table
6583
6584 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6585 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6586 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6587 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6588 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6589 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6590 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6591 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6592 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6593 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6594 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6595
6596 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
6597 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6598 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6599 Matching}).
6600
6601 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6602 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6603 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6604 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6605 simplification is used.
6606
6607 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6608 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6609 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6610 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6611
6612 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6613 @lisp
6614 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6615 (concat
6616 "\\`\\[?\\("
6617 (mapconcat
6618 'identity
6619 '("looking"
6620 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6621 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6622 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6623 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6624 ;; ...
6625 )
6626 "\\|")
6627 "\\)\\s *\\("
6628 (mapconcat 'identity
6629 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6630 "\\|")
6631 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6632 @end lisp
6633
6634 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6635 subjects.
6636
6637 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6638 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6639 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6640 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6641 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6642 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6643
6644 Useful functions to put in this list include:
6645
6646 @table @code
6647 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6648 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6649 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6650
6651 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6652 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6653 Simplify fuzzily.
6654
6655 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6656 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6657 Remove excessive whitespace.
6658
6659 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6660 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6661 Remove all whitespace.
6662 @end table
6663
6664 You may also write your own functions, of course.
6665
6666
6667 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6668 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6669 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6670 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6671 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6672 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6673 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6674 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6675
6676 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6677 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6678 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6679 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6680 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6681 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6682 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6683 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6684 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6685 cholera:
6686
6687 @table @code
6688 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6689 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6690 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6691 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
6692
6693 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6694 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6695 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
6696 @end table
6697
6698 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
6699 something like:
6700
6701 @lisp
6702 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6703 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
6704 @end lisp
6705
6706 @end table
6707
6708
6709 @node Filling In Threads
6710 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
6711
6712 @table @code
6713 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
6714 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
6715 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
6716 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
6717 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
6718 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
6719 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
6720 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
6721 old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
6722 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
6723 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
6724 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
6725 do about that.
6726
6727 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
6728 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
6729 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
6730
6731 @item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6732 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6733 Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
6734 newsgroups.
6735
6736 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
6737 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
6738 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
6739 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
6740 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
6741 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
6742 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
6743 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
6744 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
6745 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
6746 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
6747 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
6748 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
6749 @code{nil} by default.
6750
6751 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
6752 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
6753 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
6754 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
6755 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
6756 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
6757 web-based groups, like the @code{nnultimate} groups.
6758
6759 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
6760 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
6761 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
6762
6763 @end table
6764
6765
6766 @node More Threading
6767 @subsubsection More Threading
6768
6769 @table @code
6770 @item gnus-show-threads
6771 @vindex gnus-show-threads
6772 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
6773 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
6774 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
6775 slower and more awkward.
6776
6777 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6778 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6779 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
6780 generated.
6781
6782 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
6783 Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
6784 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
6785
6786 Here's an example:
6787
6788 @lisp
6789 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6790 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
6791 gnus-article-unseen-p))
6792 @end lisp
6793
6794 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
6795 unread, but you get my drift.)
6796
6797
6798 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
6799 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
6800 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
6801 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
6802 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
6803 threads are expunged.
6804
6805 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
6806 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
6807 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
6808 will be hidden.
6809
6810 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6811 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6812 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
6813 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
6814 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
6815 result in a new thread.
6816
6817 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
6818 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
6819 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
6820 The default is 4.
6821
6822 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6823 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6824 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
6825 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
6826 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
6827 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
6828 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
6829 Setting this variable to an alternate value
6830 (e.g. @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
6831 appropriate hook (e.g. @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
6832 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
6833
6834 @end table
6835
6836
6837 @node Low-Level Threading
6838 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
6839
6840 @table @code
6841
6842 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
6843 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
6844 Hook run before parsing any headers.
6845
6846 @item gnus-alter-header-function
6847 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
6848 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
6849 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
6850 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
6851 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
6852 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
6853 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
6854 meaningful. Here's one example:
6855
6856 @lisp
6857 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
6858
6859 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
6860 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
6861 (when (string-match
6862 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
6863 (mail-header-set-id
6864 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
6865 header))))
6866 @end lisp
6867
6868 @end table
6869
6870
6871 @node Thread Commands
6872 @subsection Thread Commands
6873 @cindex thread commands
6874
6875 @table @kbd
6876
6877 @item T k
6878 @itemx C-M-k
6879 @kindex T k (Summary)
6880 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
6881 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
6882 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
6883 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
6884 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
6885 articles instead.
6886
6887 @item T l
6888 @itemx C-M-l
6889 @kindex T l (Summary)
6890 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
6891 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
6892 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
6893 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
6894
6895 @item T i
6896 @kindex T i (Summary)
6897 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
6898 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
6899 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
6900
6901 @item T #
6902 @kindex T # (Summary)
6903 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6904 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
6905 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6906
6907 @item T M-#
6908 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
6909 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6910 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
6911 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6912
6913 @item T T
6914 @kindex T T (Summary)
6915 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
6916 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
6917
6918 @item T s
6919 @kindex T s (Summary)
6920 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
6921 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
6922 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
6923
6924 @item T h
6925 @kindex T h (Summary)
6926 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
6927 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
6928
6929 @item T S
6930 @kindex T S (Summary)
6931 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
6932 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
6933
6934 @item T H
6935 @kindex T H (Summary)
6936 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
6937 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
6938
6939 @item T t
6940 @kindex T t (Summary)
6941 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
6942 Re-thread the current article's thread
6943 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
6944 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
6945
6946 @item T ^
6947 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
6948 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
6949 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
6950 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
6951
6952 @end table
6953
6954 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
6955 understand the numeric prefix.
6956
6957 @table @kbd
6958
6959 @item T n
6960 @kindex T n (Summary)
6961 @itemx C-M-f
6962 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
6963 @itemx M-down
6964 @kindex M-down (Summary)
6965 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
6966 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
6967
6968 @item T p
6969 @kindex T p (Summary)
6970 @itemx C-M-b
6971 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
6972 @itemx M-up
6973 @kindex M-up (Summary)
6974 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
6975 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
6976
6977 @item T d
6978 @kindex T d (Summary)
6979 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
6980 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
6981
6982 @item T u
6983 @kindex T u (Summary)
6984 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
6985 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
6986
6987 @item T o
6988 @kindex T o (Summary)
6989 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
6990 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
6991 @end table
6992
6993 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
6994 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
6995 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
6996 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
6997 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
6998 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
6999 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
7000 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
7001 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
7002 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
7003 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
7004 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
7005 Matching}).
7006
7007
7008 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
7009 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
7010
7011 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
7012 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
7013 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
7014 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7015 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
7016 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7017 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
7018 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
7019 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
7020 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
7021 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
7022 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
7023 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
7024 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
7025
7026 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
7027 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
7028 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
7029 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
7030 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
7031 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
7032 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
7033 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
7034
7035 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
7036 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
7037 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread.
7038
7039 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
7040 last function in the list. You should probably always include
7041 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
7042 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
7043 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
7044 ascending article order.
7045
7046 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
7047 by number, you could do something like:
7048
7049 @lisp
7050 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7051 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7052 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7053 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
7054 @end lisp
7055
7056 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
7057 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
7058 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
7059 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
7060 which the articles arrived.
7061
7062 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
7063 say something like:
7064
7065 @lisp
7066 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7067 '((lambda (t1 t2)
7068 (not (gnus-thread-sort-by-number t1 t2)))
7069 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7070 @end lisp
7071
7072 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7073 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7074 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7075 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7076 tickles your fancy.
7077
7078 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7079 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7080 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7081 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7082 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7083 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7084 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7085 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7086 other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7087 variable. It is very similar to the
7088 @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7089 different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7090 predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7091 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7092 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7093 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7094 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
7095
7096 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7097 say something like:
7098
7099 @lisp
7100 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7101 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7102 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7103 @end lisp
7104
7105
7106
7107 @node Asynchronous Fetching
7108 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7109 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
7110 @cindex article pre-fetch
7111 @cindex pre-fetch
7112
7113 If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7114 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7115 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7116 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7117 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
7118
7119 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7120 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
7121
7122 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7123 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7124 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7125 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7126 connection is blocked.
7127
7128 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7129 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7130 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7131 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
7132
7133 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7134 the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7135 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7136 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7137 extra connection.
7138
7139 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7140 you really want to.
7141
7142 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
7143 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7144 happen automatically.
7145
7146 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7147 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7148 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7149 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7150 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7151 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7152 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7153
7154 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7155 @findex gnus-async-read-p
7156 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7157 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7158 variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7159 function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7160 to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-read-p}, which
7161 returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7162 article data structure as the only parameter.
7163
7164 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7165 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
7166
7167 @lisp
7168 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7169 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7170 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7171 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7172 100)))
7173
7174 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7175 @end lisp
7176
7177 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7178 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7179 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
7180
7181 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7182 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7183 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7184 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
7185
7186 @table @code
7187 @item read
7188 Remove articles when they are read.
7189
7190 @item exit
7191 Remove articles when exiting the group.
7192 @end table
7193
7194 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
7195
7196 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7197 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7198 @c from the next group.
7199
7200
7201 @node Article Caching
7202 @section Article Caching
7203 @cindex article caching
7204 @cindex caching
7205
7206 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7207 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7208 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7209 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7210 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
7211
7212 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
7213
7214 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7215 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
7216 @vindex gnus-use-cache
7217 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7218 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7219 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7220 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7221 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
7222
7223 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7224 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7225 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7226 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7227 as dormant, and don't worry.
7228
7229 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
7230
7231 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7232 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7233 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7234 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7235 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7236 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7237 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7238 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7239 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7240 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
7241
7242 @findex gnus-jog-cache
7243 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7244 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7245 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7246 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7247 command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7248 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7249 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7250 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7251 not then be downloaded by this command.
7252
7253 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7254 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7255 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7256 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7257 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7258 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
7259
7260 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7261 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7262 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7263 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7264 variables, the group is not cached.
7265
7266 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7267 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7268 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7269 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7270 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7271 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7272 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7273 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7274 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7275 file.
7276
7277 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7278 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7279 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7280 where, isn't that cool?
7281
7282 @node Persistent Articles
7283 @section Persistent Articles
7284 @cindex persistent articles
7285
7286 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7287 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7288 useful in my opinion.
7289
7290 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7291 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7292 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7293 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7294 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7295 the expiry going on at the news server.
7296
7297 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7298 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7299 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
7300
7301 @table @kbd
7302
7303 @item *
7304 @kindex * (Summary)
7305 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7306 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7307
7308 @item M-*
7309 @kindex M-* (Summary)
7310 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7311 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7312 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7313 article.
7314 @end table
7315
7316 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7317
7318 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7319 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7320 interested in persistent articles:
7321
7322 @lisp
7323 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
7324 @end lisp
7325
7326
7327 @node Article Backlog
7328 @section Article Backlog
7329 @cindex backlog
7330 @cindex article backlog
7331
7332 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7333 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7334 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7335 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7336 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7337 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7338 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7339 increase memory usage some.
7340
7341 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7342 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7343 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7344 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7345 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7346 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7347 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
7348
7349 The default value is 20.
7350
7351
7352 @node Saving Articles
7353 @section Saving Articles
7354 @cindex saving articles
7355
7356 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7357 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7358 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7359 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7360 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
7361
7362 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7363 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7364 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
7365
7366 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7367 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7368 unwanted headers before saving the article.
7369
7370 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
7371 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7372 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7373 deleted before saving.
7374
7375 @table @kbd
7376
7377 @item O o
7378 @itemx o
7379 @kindex O o (Summary)
7380 @kindex o (Summary)
7381 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
7382 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7383 Save the current article using the default article saver
7384 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7385
7386 @item O m
7387 @kindex O m (Summary)
7388 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7389 Save the current article in a Unix mail box (mbox) file
7390 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7391
7392 @item O r
7393 @kindex O r (Summary)
7394 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7395 Save the current article in Rmail format
7396 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}).
7397
7398 @item O f
7399 @kindex O f (Summary)
7400 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7401 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7402 Save the current article in plain file format
7403 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7404
7405 @item O F
7406 @kindex O F (Summary)
7407 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7408 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7409 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7410
7411 @item O b
7412 @kindex O b (Summary)
7413 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7414 Save the current article body in plain file format
7415 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7416
7417 @item O h
7418 @kindex O h (Summary)
7419 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7420 Save the current article in mh folder format
7421 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7422
7423 @item O v
7424 @kindex O v (Summary)
7425 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7426 Save the current article in a VM folder
7427 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7428
7429 @item O p
7430 @itemx |
7431 @kindex O p (Summary)
7432 @kindex | (Summary)
7433 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7434 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7435 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7436 If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7437 complete headers in the piped output.
7438
7439 @item O P
7440 @kindex O P (Summary)
7441 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7442 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7443 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7444 external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7445 Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7446 variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7447 (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7448
7449 @end table
7450
7451 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7452 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7453 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7454 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7455 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7456 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7457 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7458 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7459 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7460 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7461 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7462 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7463 files.
7464
7465
7466 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7467 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7468 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the eight ready-made
7469 functions below, or you can create your own.
7470
7471 @table @code
7472
7473 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7474 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7475 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7476 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7477 This is the default format, @dfn{Babyl}. Uses the function in the
7478 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7479 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7480
7481 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7482 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7483 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7484 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7485 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7486 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7487
7488 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7489 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7490 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
7491 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7492 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7493 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7494 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7495
7496 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7497 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7498 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7499 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7500 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7501 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7502
7503 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7504 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7505 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7506 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7507 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7508
7509 @item gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7510 @findex gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7511 Write the article body straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7512 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7513 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7514 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7515
7516 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7517 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7518 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
7519 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7520 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7521 @cindex rcvstore
7522 @cindex MH folders
7523 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7524 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7525 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7526 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7527 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7528
7529 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7530 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7531 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7532 reader to use this setting.
7533 @end table
7534
7535 The symbol of each function may have the following properties:
7536
7537 @table @code
7538 @item :decode
7539 The value non-@code{nil} means save decoded articles. This is
7540 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-save-in-file},
7541 @code{gnus-summary-save-body-in-file},
7542 @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file}, and
7543 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
7544
7545 @item :function
7546 The value specifies an alternative function which appends, not
7547 overwrites, articles to a file. This implies that when saving many
7548 articles at a time, @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} is bound to
7549 @code{t} and all articles are saved in a single file. This is
7550 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file} and
7551 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
7552
7553 @item :headers
7554 The value specifies the symbol of a variable of which the value
7555 specifies headers to be saved. If it is omitted,
7556 @code{gnus-save-all-headers} and @code{gnus-saved-headers} control what
7557 headers should be saved.
7558 @end table
7559
7560 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7561 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7562 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7563 @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7564 default.
7565
7566 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7567 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7568 available functions that generate names:
7569
7570 @table @code
7571
7572 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7573 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
7574 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7575
7576 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
7577 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7578 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7579
7580 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
7581 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
7582 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7583
7584 @item gnus-plain-save-name
7585 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7586 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7587
7588 @item gnus-sender-save-name
7589 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
7590 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
7591 @end table
7592
7593 @vindex gnus-split-methods
7594 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
7595 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
7596 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
7597 related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
7598 like:
7599
7600 @lisp
7601 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
7602 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
7603 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
7604 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
7605 @end lisp
7606
7607 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
7608 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
7609 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
7610 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
7611 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
7612 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
7613 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
7614 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
7615 called returns a string or a list of strings.
7616
7617 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
7618 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
7619 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
7620 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
7621
7622 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
7623 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
7624 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
7625 name.
7626
7627 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
7628 lots of mail groups called things like
7629 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
7630 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
7631 following will do just that:
7632
7633 @lisp
7634 (defun my-save-name (group)
7635 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
7636 (substring group (match-end 0))))
7637
7638 (setq gnus-split-methods
7639 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
7640 (my-save-name)))
7641 @end lisp
7642
7643
7644 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7645 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
7646 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
7647 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
7648 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
7649 all the files in the top level directory
7650 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
7651 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
7652 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
7653 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
7654
7655 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
7656 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
7657 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
7658 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
7659 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
7660 for kill files.
7661
7662 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
7663 a spool, you could
7664
7665 @lisp
7666 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
7667 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
7668 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
7669 @end lisp
7670
7671 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
7672 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
7673 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
7674 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
7675
7676
7677 @node Decoding Articles
7678 @section Decoding Articles
7679 @cindex decoding articles
7680
7681 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
7682 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
7683
7684 @menu
7685 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
7686 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
7687 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
7688 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
7689 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
7690 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
7691 @end menu
7692
7693 @cindex series
7694 @cindex article series
7695 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
7696 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
7697 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
7698 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
7699 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
7700
7701 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
7702 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
7703 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
7704
7705 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
7706 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
7707 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
7708
7709 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
7710 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
7711 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
7712
7713
7714 @node Uuencoded Articles
7715 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
7716 @cindex uudecode
7717 @cindex uuencoded articles
7718
7719 @table @kbd
7720
7721 @item X u
7722 @kindex X u (Summary)
7723 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
7724 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
7725 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
7726
7727 @item X U
7728 @kindex X U (Summary)
7729 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
7730 Uudecodes and saves the current series
7731 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7732
7733 @item X v u
7734 @kindex X v u (Summary)
7735 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
7736 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
7737
7738 @item X v U
7739 @kindex X v U (Summary)
7740 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
7741 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
7742 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
7743
7744 @end table
7745
7746 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
7747 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
7748 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
7749 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
7750 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7751
7752 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
7753 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
7754 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
7755 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
7756 @kbd{X u}.
7757
7758 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
7759 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
7760 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
7761 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
7762 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
7763 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
7764 off.
7765
7766
7767 @node Shell Archives
7768 @subsection Shell Archives
7769 @cindex unshar
7770 @cindex shell archives
7771 @cindex shared articles
7772
7773 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
7774 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
7775 some commands to deal with these:
7776
7777 @table @kbd
7778
7779 @item X s
7780 @kindex X s (Summary)
7781 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
7782 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
7783
7784 @item X S
7785 @kindex X S (Summary)
7786 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
7787 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
7788
7789 @item X v s
7790 @kindex X v s (Summary)
7791 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
7792 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
7793
7794 @item X v S
7795 @kindex X v S (Summary)
7796 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
7797 Unshars, views and saves the current series
7798 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
7799 @end table
7800
7801
7802 @node PostScript Files
7803 @subsection PostScript Files
7804 @cindex PostScript
7805
7806 @table @kbd
7807
7808 @item X p
7809 @kindex X p (Summary)
7810 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
7811 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
7812
7813 @item X P
7814 @kindex X P (Summary)
7815 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
7816 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
7817 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
7818
7819 @item X v p
7820 @kindex X v p (Summary)
7821 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
7822 View the current PostScript series
7823 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
7824
7825 @item X v P
7826 @kindex X v P (Summary)
7827 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
7828 View and save the current PostScript series
7829 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
7830 @end table
7831
7832
7833 @node Other Files
7834 @subsection Other Files
7835
7836 @table @kbd
7837 @item X o
7838 @kindex X o (Summary)
7839 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
7840 Save the current series
7841 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
7842
7843 @item X b
7844 @kindex X b (Summary)
7845 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
7846 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
7847 doesn't really work yet.
7848 @end table
7849
7850
7851 @node Decoding Variables
7852 @subsection Decoding Variables
7853
7854 Adjective, not verb.
7855
7856 @menu
7857 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
7858 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
7859 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
7860 @end menu
7861
7862
7863 @node Rule Variables
7864 @subsubsection Rule Variables
7865 @cindex rule variables
7866
7867 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
7868 variables are of the form
7869
7870 @lisp
7871 (list '(regexp1 command2)
7872 '(regexp2 command2)
7873 ...)
7874 @end lisp
7875
7876 @table @code
7877
7878 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7879 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7880 @cindex sox
7881 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
7882 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
7883 say something like:
7884 @lisp
7885 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7886 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
7887 @end lisp
7888
7889 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7890 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7891 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
7892 user and default view rules.
7893
7894 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7895 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7896 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
7897 archives.
7898 @end table
7899
7900
7901 @node Other Decode Variables
7902 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
7903
7904 @table @code
7905 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7906
7907 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7908 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
7909 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
7910 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
7911 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
7912
7913 @table @code
7914
7915 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
7916 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
7917 View the file.
7918
7919 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
7920 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
7921 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
7922 @end table
7923
7924 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7925 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7926 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
7927 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
7928 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
7929 time.
7930
7931 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7932 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7933 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
7934
7935 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7936 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7937 Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
7938 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
7939 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
7940 kludgey.
7941
7942 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7943 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7944 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
7945
7946 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7947 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7948 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
7949 looking for files to display.
7950
7951 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
7952 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
7953 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
7954 after viewing it.
7955
7956 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7957 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7958 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
7959 rules.
7960
7961 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7962 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7963 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
7964 unpacking commands.
7965
7966 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7967 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7968 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
7969 from articles.
7970
7971 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7972 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7973 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
7974 decoded articles as unread.
7975
7976 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7977 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7978 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
7979 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
7980
7981 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
7982 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
7983 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
7984
7985 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
7986 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
7987 @cindex metamail
7988 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
7989 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
7990 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
7991 @code{metamail} for viewing.
7992
7993 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
7994 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
7995 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
7996 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
7997 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
7998 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
7999 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
8000 simply dropped them.
8001
8002 @end table
8003
8004
8005 @node Uuencoding and Posting
8006 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
8007
8008 @table @code
8009
8010 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8011 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8012 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
8013 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
8014 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
8015 for you when you post the article.
8016
8017 @item gnus-uu-post-length
8018 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
8019 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
8020 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
8021
8022 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
8023 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
8024 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
8025 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
8026 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
8027 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
8028 think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
8029
8030 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8031 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8032 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
8033 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
8034 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
8035 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
8036 Default is @code{t}.
8037
8038 @end table
8039
8040
8041 @node Viewing Files
8042 @subsection Viewing Files
8043 @cindex viewing files
8044 @cindex pseudo-articles
8045
8046 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
8047 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
8048 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
8049 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
8050 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
8051 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
8052 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
8053
8054 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
8055 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
8056 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
8057 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
8058
8059 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
8060 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
8061 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
8062
8063 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
8064 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
8065 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
8066 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
8067 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
8068
8069 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
8070 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
8071 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
8072 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
8073 a list of parameters to that command.
8074
8075 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
8076 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
8077 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
8078
8079 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
8080 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
8081 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
8082
8083
8084 @node Article Treatment
8085 @section Article Treatment
8086
8087 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
8088 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
8089 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
8090 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
8091 these articles easier.
8092
8093 @menu
8094 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
8095 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
8096 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
8097 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
8098 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8099 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8100 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8101 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8102 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
8103 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8104 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8105 @end menu
8106
8107
8108 @node Article Highlighting
8109 @subsection Article Highlighting
8110 @cindex highlighting
8111
8112 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8113 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
8114
8115 @table @kbd
8116
8117 @item W H a
8118 @kindex W H a (Summary)
8119 @findex gnus-article-highlight
8120 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8121 Do much highlighting of the current article
8122 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8123 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
8124
8125 @item W H h
8126 @kindex W H h (Summary)
8127 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8128 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8129 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8130 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8131 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8132 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8133 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8134 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8135 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8136 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8137 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
8138
8139 @item W H c
8140 @kindex W H c (Summary)
8141 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8142 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
8143
8144 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
8145
8146 @table @code
8147 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8148
8149 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8150 If the article size if bigger than this variable (which is 25000 by
8151 default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
8152
8153 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8154 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8155 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
8156
8157 @item gnus-cite-face-list
8158 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8159 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8160 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8161 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8162 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
8163
8164 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
8165 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8166 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
8167
8168 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8169 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8170 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
8171
8172 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8173 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8174 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8175 that it's a citation.
8176
8177 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8178 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8179 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
8180
8181 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8182 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8183 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
8184
8185 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8186 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8187 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8188 cited text belonging to the attribution.
8189
8190 @item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8191 @vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8192 If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8193 beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8194 in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8195 is @code{t}.
8196
8197 @end table
8198
8199
8200 @item W H s
8201 @kindex W H s (Summary)
8202 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
8203 @vindex gnus-signature-face
8204 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8205 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8206 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8207 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8208 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8209 default.
8210
8211 @end table
8212
8213 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
8214
8215
8216 @node Article Fontisizing
8217 @subsection Article Fontisizing
8218 @cindex emphasis
8219 @cindex article emphasis
8220
8221 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
8222 @kindex W e (Summary)
8223 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8224 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8225 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8226 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
8227
8228 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8229 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8230 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8231 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8232 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8233 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8234 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8235 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8236 highlighting.
8237
8238 @lisp
8239 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8240 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8241 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
8242 @end lisp
8243
8244 @cindex slash
8245 @cindex asterisk
8246 @cindex underline
8247 @cindex /
8248 @cindex *
8249
8250 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8251 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8252 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8253 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8254 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8255 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8256 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8257 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8258 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8259 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8260 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8261 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8262 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
8263
8264 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8265 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8266 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8267 say something like:
8268
8269 @lisp
8270 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
8271 @end lisp
8272
8273 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
8274
8275 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8276 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8277 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8278 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
8279
8280 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
8281
8282
8283 @node Article Hiding
8284 @subsection Article Hiding
8285 @cindex article hiding
8286
8287 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8288 too much cruft in most articles.
8289
8290 @table @kbd
8291
8292 @item W W a
8293 @kindex W W a (Summary)
8294 @findex gnus-article-hide
8295 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8296 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8297 headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
8298
8299 @item W W h
8300 @kindex W W h (Summary)
8301 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8302 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8303 Headers}.
8304
8305 @item W W b
8306 @kindex W W b (Summary)
8307 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8308 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8309 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
8310
8311 @item W W s
8312 @kindex W W s (Summary)
8313 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8314 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8315 Signature}.
8316
8317 @item W W l
8318 @kindex W W l (Summary)
8319 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8320 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8321 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8322 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8323 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8324 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8325 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
8326
8327 @table @code
8328
8329 @item gnus-list-identifiers
8330 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8331 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8332 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
8333
8334 @end table
8335
8336 @item W W P
8337 @kindex W W P (Summary)
8338 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8339 Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8340 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
8341
8342 @item W W B
8343 @kindex W W B (Summary)
8344 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8345 @vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8346 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8347 @cindex banner
8348 @cindex OneList
8349 @cindex stripping advertisements
8350 @cindex advertisements
8351 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8352 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8353 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8354 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8355 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8356 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8357 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8358 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8359 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8360 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8361 used.
8362
8363 Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8364 the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8365 @code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
8366
8367 @table @code
8368
8369 @item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8370 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8371 Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8372 @code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8373 matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8374 symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8375 a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8376 address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8377 sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8378 banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8379 sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
8380
8381 @lisp
8382 ("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8383 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8384 @end lisp
8385
8386 @end table
8387
8388 @item W W c
8389 @kindex W W c (Summary)
8390 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8391 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8392 customizing the hiding:
8393
8394 @table @code
8395
8396 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8397 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8398 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8399 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8400 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8401 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8402 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8403 specs are valid:
8404
8405 @table @samp
8406 @item b
8407 Starting point of the hidden text.
8408 @item e
8409 Ending point of the hidden text.
8410 @item l
8411 Number of characters in the hidden region.
8412 @item n
8413 Number of lines of hidden text.
8414 @end table
8415
8416 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8417 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8418 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8419 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8420 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
8421
8422 @end table
8423
8424 @item W W C-c
8425 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8426 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
8427
8428 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8429 following two variables:
8430
8431 @table @code
8432 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8433 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8434 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
8435 50), hide the cited text.
8436
8437 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8438 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8439 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8440 is hidden.
8441 @end table
8442
8443 @item W W C
8444 @kindex W W C (Summary)
8445 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8446 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8447 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8448 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8449 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8450
8451 @end table
8452
8453 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8454 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8455 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8456
8457 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8458 citation customization.
8459
8460 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8461 automatically.
8462
8463
8464 @node Article Washing
8465 @subsection Article Washing
8466 @cindex washing
8467 @cindex article washing
8468
8469 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8470 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8471
8472 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8473 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8474 Cleaner, perhaps.
8475
8476 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8477 articles by default.
8478
8479 @table @kbd
8480
8481 @item C-u g
8482 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8483 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8484 the server.
8485
8486 @item g
8487 Force redisplaying of the current article
8488 (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8489 If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8490 interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8491 (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8492
8493 @item W l
8494 @kindex W l (Summary)
8495 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8496 Remove page breaks from the current article
8497 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8498 delimiters.
8499
8500 @item W r
8501 @kindex W r (Summary)
8502 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8503 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8504 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8505 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8506 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8507 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8508
8509 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8510 positions in the alphabet, e. g. @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8511 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8512 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8513
8514 @item W m
8515 @kindex W m (Summary)
8516 @findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8517 Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
8518
8519 @item W t
8520 @item t
8521 @kindex W t (Summary)
8522 @kindex t (Summary)
8523 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8524 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8525 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8526
8527 @item W v
8528 @kindex W v (Summary)
8529 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8530 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8531 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8532
8533 @item W o
8534 @kindex W o (Summary)
8535 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8536 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8537
8538 @item W d
8539 @kindex W d (Summary)
8540 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8541 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8542 @cindex Smartquotes
8543 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8544 @cindex Latin 1
8545 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8546 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8547 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8548 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8549 interactively.
8550
8551 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
8552 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
8553 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
8554 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
8555
8556 @item W Y f
8557 @kindex W Y f (Summary)
8558 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
8559 @cindex Outlook Express
8560 Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
8561 unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
8562 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
8563
8564 @item W Y u
8565 @kindex W Y u (Summary)
8566 @findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
8567 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
8568 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
8569 Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
8570 what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
8571 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
8572 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
8573 maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
8574 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
8575
8576 @item W Y a
8577 @kindex W Y a (Summary)
8578 @findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
8579 Repair a broken attribution line.@*
8580 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
8581
8582 @item W Y c
8583 @kindex W Y c (Summary)
8584 @findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
8585 Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
8586 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
8587
8588 @item W w
8589 @kindex W w (Summary)
8590 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
8591 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
8592
8593 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
8594 when filling.
8595
8596 @item W Q
8597 @kindex W Q (Summary)
8598 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
8599 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
8600
8601 @item W C
8602 @kindex W C (Summary)
8603 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
8604 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
8605 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
8606
8607 @item W c
8608 @kindex W c (Summary)
8609 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
8610 Translate CRLF pairs (i. e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
8611 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
8612 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
8613 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
8614
8615 @item W q
8616 @kindex W q (Summary)
8617 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
8618 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
8619 Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
8620 sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
8621 makes strings like @samp{déjà vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu}, which
8622 doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually done
8623 automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8624 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8625 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8626
8627 @item W 6
8628 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
8629 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
8630 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
8631 one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
8632 non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
8633 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8634 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8635 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8636
8637 @item W Z
8638 @kindex W Z (Summary)
8639 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
8640 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
8641 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
8642 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
8643
8644 @item W u
8645 @kindex W u (Summary)
8646 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
8647 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
8648 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
8649 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
8650 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
8651
8652 @item W h
8653 @kindex W h (Summary)
8654 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
8655 Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
8656 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8657 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
8658
8659 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for. If it is a number,
8660 the charset defined in @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist}
8661 (@pxref{Paging the Article}) will be used.
8662
8663 @vindex gnus-article-wash-function
8664 The default is to use the function specified by
8665 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
8666 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
8667 @acronym{HTML}, but this is controlled by the
8668 @code{gnus-article-wash-function} variable. Pre-defined functions you
8669 can use include:
8670
8671 @table @code
8672 @item w3
8673 Use Emacs/W3.
8674
8675 @item w3m
8676 Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
8677
8678 @item w3m-standalone
8679 Use @uref{http://w3m.sourceforge.net/, w3m}.
8680
8681 @item links
8682 Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
8683
8684 @item lynx
8685 Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
8686
8687 @item html2text
8688 Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
8689
8690 @end table
8691
8692 @item W b
8693 @kindex W b (Summary)
8694 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
8695 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
8696 @xref{Article Buttons}.
8697
8698 @item W B
8699 @kindex W B (Summary)
8700 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
8701 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
8702 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
8703
8704 @item W p
8705 @kindex W p (Summary)
8706 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
8707 Verify a signed control message
8708 (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
8709 @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
8710 hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
8711 the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
8712 message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
8713 available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
8714
8715 @item W s
8716 @kindex W s (Summary)
8717 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
8718 Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
8719 @acronym{S/MIME}) message
8720 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
8721
8722 @item W a
8723 @kindex W a (Summary)
8724 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
8725 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
8726 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
8727
8728 @item W E l
8729 @kindex W E l (Summary)
8730 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
8731 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
8732 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
8733
8734 @item W E m
8735 @kindex W E m (Summary)
8736 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
8737 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
8738 lines with a single empty line.
8739 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
8740
8741 @item W E t
8742 @kindex W E t (Summary)
8743 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
8744 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
8745 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
8746
8747 @item W E a
8748 @kindex W E a (Summary)
8749 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
8750 Do all the three commands above
8751 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
8752
8753 @item W E A
8754 @kindex W E A (Summary)
8755 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
8756 Remove all blank lines
8757 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
8758
8759 @item W E s
8760 @kindex W E s (Summary)
8761 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
8762 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
8763 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
8764
8765 @item W E e
8766 @kindex W E e (Summary)
8767 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
8768 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
8769 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
8770
8771 @end table
8772
8773 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
8774
8775
8776 @node Article Header
8777 @subsection Article Header
8778
8779 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
8780
8781 @table @kbd
8782
8783 @item W G u
8784 @kindex W G u (Summary)
8785 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
8786 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
8787
8788 @item W G n
8789 @kindex W G n (Summary)
8790 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
8791 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
8792 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
8793
8794 @item W G f
8795 @kindex W G f (Summary)
8796 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
8797 Fold all the message headers
8798 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
8799
8800 @item W E w
8801 @kindex W E w (Summary)
8802 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
8803 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
8804 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
8805
8806 @end table
8807
8808
8809 @node Article Buttons
8810 @subsection Article Buttons
8811 @cindex buttons
8812
8813 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
8814 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
8815 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
8816 button on these references.
8817
8818 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8819 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
8820 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
8821 Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
8822 one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
8823
8824 @table @code
8825
8826 @item gnus-button-alist
8827 @vindex gnus-button-alist
8828 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
8829
8830 @lisp
8831 (@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8832 @end lisp
8833
8834 @table @var
8835
8836 @item regexp
8837 All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
8838 considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
8839 embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
8840 variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
8841 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
8842
8843 @item button-par
8844 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
8845 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
8846 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
8847
8848 @item use-p
8849 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
8850 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
8851 avoid false matches. Often variables named
8852 @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
8853 Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
8854
8855 @c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
8856
8857 @item function
8858 This function will be called when you click on this button.
8859
8860 @item data-par
8861 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
8862 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
8863
8864 @end table
8865
8866 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
8867
8868 @lisp
8869 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
8870 @end lisp
8871
8872 @item gnus-header-button-alist
8873 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
8874 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
8875 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
8876 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
8877
8878 @lisp
8879 (@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8880 @end lisp
8881
8882 @var{header} is a regular expression.
8883 @end table
8884
8885 @subsubsection Related variables and functions
8886
8887 @table @code
8888 @item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
8889 @xref{Article Button Levels}.
8890
8891 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
8892
8893 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
8894 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
8895 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
8896 default values of the variables above.
8897
8898 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
8899
8900 @item gnus-button-man-handler
8901 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8902 The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
8903 argument with a string naming the man page.
8904
8905 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
8906
8907 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8908 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8909 Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
8910
8911 @item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8912 @vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8913 This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
8914 @samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
8915 message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
8916 @code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
8917 a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
8918 @code{ask}, always query the user what do do. If it is a function, this
8919 function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
8920 function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
8921 @code{ask}. The default value is the function
8922 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8923
8924 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8925 @findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8926 Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
8927 address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
8928 it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
8929 string is invalid.
8930
8931 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8932 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8933 An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
8934 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8935
8936 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-tex-level
8937
8938 @item gnus-button-ctan-handler
8939 @findex gnus-button-ctan-handler
8940 The function to use for displaying CTAN links. It must take one
8941 argument, the string naming the URL.
8942
8943 @item gnus-ctan-url
8944 @vindex gnus-ctan-url
8945 Top directory of a CTAN (Comprehensive TeX Archive Network) archive used
8946 by @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler}.
8947
8948 @c Misc stuff
8949
8950 @item gnus-article-button-face
8951 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
8952 Face used on buttons.
8953
8954 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
8955 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
8956 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
8957
8958 @end table
8959
8960 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
8961
8962
8963 @node Article Button Levels
8964 @subsection Article button levels
8965 @cindex button levels
8966 The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
8967 the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
8968 buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
8969 already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
8970 more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
8971 you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
8972 specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
8973 variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
8974
8975 @lisp
8976 ;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
8977 (setq gnus-parameters
8978 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
8979 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
8980 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
8981 @end lisp
8982
8983 @table @code
8984
8985 @item gnus-button-browse-level
8986 @vindex gnus-button-browse-level
8987 Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
8988 news URLs. Related variables and functions include
8989 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
8990 @code{browse-url-browser-function}.
8991
8992 @item gnus-button-emacs-level
8993 @vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
8994 Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
8995 @code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
8996 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
8997 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
8998 @code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
8999 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
9000 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
9001 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
9002 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
9003 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
9004 @code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
9005
9006 @item gnus-button-man-level
9007 @vindex gnus-button-man-level
9008 Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
9009 See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
9010
9011 @item gnus-button-message-level
9012 @vindex gnus-button-message-level
9013 Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
9014 Related variables and functions include
9015 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
9016 @code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
9017 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
9018 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
9019
9020 @item gnus-button-tex-level
9021 @vindex gnus-button-tex-level
9022 Controls the display of references to @TeX{} or LaTeX stuff, e.g. for CTAN
9023 URLs. See the variables @code{gnus-ctan-url},
9024 @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler},
9025 @code{gnus-button-ctan-directory-regexp}, and
9026 @code{gnus-button-handle-ctan-bogus-regexp}.
9027
9028 @end table
9029
9030
9031 @node Article Date
9032 @subsection Article Date
9033
9034 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
9035 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
9036 when the article was sent.
9037
9038 @table @kbd
9039
9040 @item W T u
9041 @kindex W T u (Summary)
9042 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
9043 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
9044 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
9045
9046 @item W T i
9047 @kindex W T i (Summary)
9048 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
9049 @cindex ISO 8601
9050 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
9051 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
9052
9053 @item W T l
9054 @kindex W T l (Summary)
9055 @findex gnus-article-date-local
9056 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
9057
9058 @item W T p
9059 @kindex W T p (Summary)
9060 @findex gnus-article-date-english
9061 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
9062 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
9063
9064 @item W T s
9065 @kindex W T s (Summary)
9066 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
9067 @findex gnus-article-date-user
9068 @findex format-time-string
9069 Display the date using a user-defined format
9070 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
9071 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
9072 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
9073 for a list of possible format specs.
9074
9075 @item W T e
9076 @kindex W T e (Summary)
9077 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
9078 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
9079 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
9080 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
9081 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
9082
9083 @example
9084 X-Sent: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
9085 @end example
9086
9087 @vindex gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header
9088 The value of @code{gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header} determines
9089 whether this header will just be added below the old Date one, or will
9090 replace it.
9091
9092 An advantage of using Gnus to read mail is that it converts simple bugs
9093 into wonderful absurdities.
9094
9095 If you want to have this line updated continually, you can put
9096
9097 @lisp
9098 (gnus-start-date-timer)
9099 @end lisp
9100
9101 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, or you can run it off of some hook. If
9102 you want to stop the timer, you can use the @code{gnus-stop-date-timer}
9103 command.
9104
9105 @item W T o
9106 @kindex W T o (Summary)
9107 @findex gnus-article-date-original
9108 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9109 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9110 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9111 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9112 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
9113
9114 @end table
9115
9116 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9117 preferred format automatically.
9118
9119
9120 @node Article Display
9121 @subsection Article Display
9122 @cindex picons
9123 @cindex x-face
9124 @cindex smileys
9125
9126 These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9127 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
9128
9129 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9130 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
9131
9132 @code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9133 headers (@pxref{Face}).
9134
9135 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9136 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
9137
9138 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9139 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
9140
9141 All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9142 they'll be removed.
9143
9144 @table @kbd
9145 @item W D x
9146 @kindex W D x (Summary)
9147 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9148 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9149 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
9150
9151 @item W D d
9152 @kindex W D d (Summary)
9153 @findex gnus-article-display-face
9154 Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9155 (@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
9156
9157 @item W D s
9158 @kindex W D s (Summary)
9159 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
9160 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
9161
9162 @item W D f
9163 @kindex W D f (Summary)
9164 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9165 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
9166
9167 @item W D m
9168 @kindex W D m (Summary)
9169 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
9170 Piconify all mail headers (i. e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9171 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
9172
9173 @item W D n
9174 @kindex W D n (Summary)
9175 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
9176 Piconify all news headers (i. e., @code{Newsgroups} and
9177 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
9178
9179 @item W D D
9180 @kindex W D D (Summary)
9181 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
9182 Remove all images from the article buffer
9183 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
9184
9185 @end table
9186
9187
9188
9189 @node Article Signature
9190 @subsection Article Signature
9191 @cindex signatures
9192 @cindex article signature
9193
9194 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
9195 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9196 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9197 that says what is to be considered a signature is
9198 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9199 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9200 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9201 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9202 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
9203
9204 @lisp
9205 (setq gnus-signature-separator
9206 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9207 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9208 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9209 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9210 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9211 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9212 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9213 @end lisp
9214
9215 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9216 positives.
9217
9218 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
9219 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9220 signature when displaying articles.
9221
9222 @enumerate
9223 @item
9224 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9225 that integer.
9226 @item
9227 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9228 than that number.
9229 @item
9230 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9231 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9232 @item
9233 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9234 in question is not a signature.
9235 @end enumerate
9236
9237 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9238 listed above. Here's an example:
9239
9240 @lisp
9241 (setq gnus-signature-limit
9242 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9243 @end lisp
9244
9245 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9246 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9247 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9248 signature after all.
9249
9250
9251 @node Article Miscellanea
9252 @subsection Article Miscellanea
9253
9254 @table @kbd
9255 @item A t
9256 @kindex A t (Summary)
9257 @findex gnus-article-babel
9258 Translate the article from one language to another
9259 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
9260
9261 @end table
9262
9263
9264 @node MIME Commands
9265 @section MIME Commands
9266 @cindex MIME decoding
9267 @cindex attachments
9268 @cindex viewing attachments
9269
9270 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9271 instance, @kbd{3 b} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
9272
9273 @table @kbd
9274 @item b
9275 @itemx K v
9276 @kindex b (Summary)
9277 @kindex K v (Summary)
9278 View the @acronym{MIME} part.
9279
9280 @item K o
9281 @kindex K o (Summary)
9282 Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
9283
9284 @item K c
9285 @kindex K c (Summary)
9286 Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
9287
9288 @item K e
9289 @kindex K e (Summary)
9290 View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
9291
9292 @item K i
9293 @kindex K i (Summary)
9294 View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
9295
9296 @item K |
9297 @kindex K | (Summary)
9298 Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9299 @end table
9300
9301 The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9302 the same manner:
9303
9304 @table @kbd
9305 @item K b
9306 @kindex K b (Summary)
9307 Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9308 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9309 parts.
9310
9311 @item K m
9312 @kindex K m (Summary)
9313 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9314 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9315 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9316 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9317 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
9318
9319 @item X m
9320 @kindex X m (Summary)
9321 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9322 Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9323 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9324 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9325
9326 @item M-t
9327 @kindex M-t (Summary)
9328 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9329 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9330 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
9331
9332 @item W M w
9333 @kindex W M w (Summary)
9334 @findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9335 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9336 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
9337
9338 @item W M c
9339 @kindex W M c (Summary)
9340 @findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9341 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9342 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
9343
9344 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9345 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9346 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9347 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9348 include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9349 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9350
9351 @item W M v
9352 @kindex W M v (Summary)
9353 @findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9354 View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9355 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
9356
9357 @end table
9358
9359 Relevant variables:
9360
9361 @table @code
9362 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9363 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9364 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9365 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9366 @code{nil}.
9367
9368 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
9369
9370 @lisp
9371 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9372 '("text/x-vcard"))
9373 @end lisp
9374
9375 @item gnus-article-loose-mime
9376 @vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9377 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9378 before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9379 when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9380 default is @code{nil}.
9381
9382 @item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9383 @vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9384 @cindex uuencode
9385 @cindex yEnc
9386 There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9387 is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9388 this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9389 see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9390 Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}. Only
9391 single-part yEnc encoded attachments can be decoded. There's no support
9392 for encoding in Gnus.
9393
9394 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9395 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9396 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9397 this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9398 displayed or this variable is overridden by
9399 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9400 @code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9401 @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
9402
9403 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9404 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9405 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9406 this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9407 displayed. This variable overrides
9408 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9409 This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9410 is @code{nil}.
9411
9412 To see e.g. security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
9413 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9414 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
9415
9416 You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
9417 display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
9418 those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
9419 (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
9420 Emacs MIME Manual}).
9421
9422 @item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9423 @vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9424 If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9425 default value is @code{nil}.
9426
9427 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9428 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9429 For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9430 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
9431 users to gather information from the article (e. g., add Vcard info to
9432 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e. g., automatically
9433 save all jpegs into some directory).
9434
9435 Here's an example function the does the latter:
9436
9437 @lisp
9438 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9439 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9440 (with-temp-buffer
9441 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9442 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9443 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9444 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9445 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
9446 @end lisp
9447
9448 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9449 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9450 Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
9451
9452 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9453 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9454 Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9455
9456 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9457 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9458 Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9459
9460 If displaying "text/html" is discouraged, see
9461 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, images or other material inside a
9462 "multipart/related" part might be overlooked when this variable is
9463 @code{nil}. @ref{Display Customization, Display Customization, ,
9464 emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}.
9465
9466 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9467 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9468 Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
9469 overrides @code{nil} values of
9470 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9471 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
9472
9473 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9474 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9475 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9476 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
9477
9478 Ready-made functions include@*
9479 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9480 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9481 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9482 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9483 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9484 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9485 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9486 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9487 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9488 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9489 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9490 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9491
9492 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
9493 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
9494
9495 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
9496 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
9497 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
9498
9499 @lisp
9500 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9501 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9502 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9503 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
9504 @end lisp
9505
9506 @noindent
9507 to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9508
9509 @end table
9510
9511
9512 @node Charsets
9513 @section Charsets
9514 @cindex charsets
9515
9516 People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
9517 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
9518 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
9519 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
9520 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
9521 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
9522 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
9523
9524 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
9525 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
9526 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
9527 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
9528
9529 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
9530 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
9531 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
9532 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
9533 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
9534 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
9535 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
9536 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
9537 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
9538
9539 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
9540 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
9541 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
9542 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
9543 quoted-printable header encoding.
9544
9545 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
9546 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
9547 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
9548
9549 @table @var
9550 @item test
9551 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
9552 variable to query,
9553 @item header
9554 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
9555 means encode all charsets),
9556 @item body-list
9557 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
9558 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
9559 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
9560 @end table
9561
9562 @cindex Russian
9563 @cindex koi8-r
9564 @cindex koi8-u
9565 @cindex iso-8859-5
9566 @cindex coding system aliases
9567 @cindex preferred charset
9568
9569 @xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
9570 The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
9571 MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
9572
9573 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
9574
9575 If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
9576 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
9577
9578 @lisp
9579 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
9580 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
9581 @end lisp
9582
9583 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
9584 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
9585
9586 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
9587
9588 @lisp
9589 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
9590 @end lisp
9591
9592 This will almost do the right thing.
9593
9594 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
9595 something like
9596
9597 @lisp
9598 (codepage-setup 1251)
9599 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
9600 @end lisp
9601
9602
9603 @node Article Commands
9604 @section Article Commands
9605
9606 @table @kbd
9607
9608 @item A P
9609 @cindex PostScript
9610 @cindex printing
9611 @kindex A P (Summary)
9612 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
9613 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
9614 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
9615 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
9616 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
9617 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
9618
9619 @end table
9620
9621
9622 @node Summary Sorting
9623 @section Summary Sorting
9624 @cindex summary sorting
9625
9626 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
9627 can't really see why you'd want that.
9628
9629 @table @kbd
9630
9631 @item C-c C-s C-n
9632 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
9633 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
9634 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
9635
9636 @item C-c C-s C-a
9637 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
9638 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
9639 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
9640
9641 @item C-c C-s C-s
9642 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
9643 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
9644 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
9645
9646 @item C-c C-s C-d
9647 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
9648 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
9649 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
9650
9651 @item C-c C-s C-l
9652 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
9653 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
9654 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
9655
9656 @item C-c C-s C-c
9657 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
9658 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
9659 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
9660
9661 @item C-c C-s C-i
9662 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
9663 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
9664 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
9665
9666 @item C-c C-s C-r
9667 @kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
9668 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
9669 Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
9670
9671 @item C-c C-s C-o
9672 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
9673 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
9674 Sort using the default sorting method
9675 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
9676 @end table
9677
9678 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
9679 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
9680 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
9681 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
9682 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
9683 Commands}).
9684
9685
9686 @node Finding the Parent
9687 @section Finding the Parent
9688 @cindex parent articles
9689 @cindex referring articles
9690
9691 @table @kbd
9692 @item ^
9693 @kindex ^ (Summary)
9694 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
9695 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
9696 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
9697 if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
9698 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
9699 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
9700 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
9701 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
9702 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
9703
9704 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
9705 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
9706 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
9707 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
9708 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
9709 article.
9710
9711 @item A R (Summary)
9712 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
9713 @kindex A R (Summary)
9714 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
9715 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
9716
9717 @item A T (Summary)
9718 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
9719 @kindex A T (Summary)
9720 Display the full thread where the current article appears
9721 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
9722 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
9723 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
9724 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
9725 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
9726 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
9727
9728 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
9729 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i. e.,
9730 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
9731 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
9732 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
9733 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
9734
9735 @item M-^ (Summary)
9736 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
9737 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
9738 @cindex Message-ID
9739 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
9740 You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
9741 belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
9742 for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
9743 thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
9744 You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
9745
9746 Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
9747 been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
9748 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
9749 @end table
9750
9751 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
9752 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
9753 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
9754 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
9755 would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
9756 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
9757 necessary.
9758
9759 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
9760 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
9761 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
9762 match.
9763
9764 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
9765 then ask Google if that fails:
9766
9767 @lisp
9768 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
9769 '(current
9770 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
9771 @end lisp
9772
9773 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
9774 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
9775 @code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
9776 articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
9777 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
9778 group. (Anything else would be too time consuming.) @code{nnmh} does
9779 not support this at all.
9780
9781
9782 @node Alternative Approaches
9783 @section Alternative Approaches
9784
9785 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
9786 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
9787
9788 @menu
9789 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
9790 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
9791 @end menu
9792
9793
9794 @node Pick and Read
9795 @subsection Pick and Read
9796 @cindex pick and read
9797
9798 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
9799 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
9800 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
9801 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
9802
9803 @findex gnus-pick-mode
9804 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
9805 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
9806 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
9807 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
9808 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
9809
9810 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
9811
9812 @table @kbd
9813 @item .
9814 @kindex . (Pick)
9815 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
9816 Pick the article or thread on the current line
9817 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9818 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
9819 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
9820 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
9821 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
9822 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
9823
9824 @item SPACE
9825 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
9826 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
9827 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
9828 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
9829
9830 @item u
9831 @kindex u (Pick)
9832 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
9833 Unpick the thread or article
9834 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9835 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
9836 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
9837 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
9838 the thread or article at that line.
9839
9840 @item RET
9841 @kindex RET (Pick)
9842 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
9843 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
9844 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
9845 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
9846 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
9847 will still be visible when you are reading.
9848
9849 @end table
9850
9851 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
9852 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
9853 which is mapped to the same function
9854 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
9855
9856 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
9857
9858 @lisp
9859 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
9860 @end lisp
9861
9862 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
9863 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
9864
9865 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
9866 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
9867 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
9868
9869 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
9870 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
9871 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
9872 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
9873 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
9874 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
9875 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
9876
9877
9878 @node Binary Groups
9879 @subsection Binary Groups
9880 @cindex binary groups
9881
9882 @findex gnus-binary-mode
9883 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
9884 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
9885 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
9886 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
9887 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
9888 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
9889
9890 @kindex g (Binary)
9891 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
9892 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
9893 command, when you have turned on this mode
9894 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
9895
9896 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
9897 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
9898
9899
9900 @node Tree Display
9901 @section Tree Display
9902 @cindex trees
9903
9904 @vindex gnus-use-trees
9905 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
9906 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
9907 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
9908 in the tree buffer.
9909
9910 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
9911
9912 @table @code
9913 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
9914 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
9915 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
9916
9917 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9918 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9919 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
9920 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
9921 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
9922
9923 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
9924 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
9925 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
9926 default is @code{modeline}.
9927
9928 @item gnus-tree-line-format
9929 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
9930 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
9931 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
9932 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
9933 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
9934 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
9935
9936 Valid specs are:
9937
9938 @table @samp
9939 @item n
9940 The name of the poster.
9941 @item f
9942 The @code{From} header.
9943 @item N
9944 The number of the article.
9945 @item [
9946 The opening bracket.
9947 @item ]
9948 The closing bracket.
9949 @item s
9950 The subject.
9951 @end table
9952
9953 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
9954
9955 Variables related to the display are:
9956
9957 @table @code
9958 @item gnus-tree-brackets
9959 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
9960 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
9961 ``sparse'' articles. The format is
9962 @example
9963 ((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
9964 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
9965 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
9966 @end example
9967 and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
9968
9969 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9970 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9971 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
9972 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
9973
9974 @end table
9975
9976 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
9977 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
9978 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
9979 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
9980 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
9981 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
9982 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
9983 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
9984 other windows displayed next to it.
9985
9986 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
9987 at all times:
9988
9989 @lisp
9990 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
9991 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
9992 @end lisp
9993
9994 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
9995 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
9996 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
9997 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
9998 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
9999 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
10000 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
10001
10002 @end table
10003
10004 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
10005
10006 @example
10007 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
10008 | \[Jan]
10009 | \[odd]-[Eri]
10010 | \(***)-[Eri]
10011 | \[odd]-[Paa]
10012 \[Bjo]
10013 \[Gun]
10014 \[Gun]-[Jor]
10015 @end example
10016
10017 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
10018
10019 @example
10020 @group
10021 @{***@}
10022 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
10023 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
10024 |--\-----\-----\ |
10025 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
10026 | | |--\
10027 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
10028 |
10029 [Paa]
10030 @end group
10031 @end example
10032
10033 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
10034 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
10035 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
10036
10037 @lisp
10038 (setq gnus-use-trees t
10039 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10040 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
10041 (gnus-add-configuration
10042 '(article
10043 (vertical 1.0
10044 (horizontal 0.25
10045 (summary 0.75 point)
10046 (tree 1.0))
10047 (article 1.0))))
10048 @end lisp
10049
10050 @xref{Window Layout}.
10051
10052
10053 @node Mail Group Commands
10054 @section Mail Group Commands
10055 @cindex mail group commands
10056
10057 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
10058 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
10059
10060 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
10061 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10062
10063 @table @kbd
10064
10065 @item B e
10066 @kindex B e (Summary)
10067 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
10068 @cindex expiring mail
10069 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
10070 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
10071 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
10072 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
10073
10074 @item B C-M-e
10075 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
10076 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
10077 @cindex expiring mail
10078 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
10079 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
10080 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
10081 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
10082
10083 @item B DEL
10084 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
10085 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
10086 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
10087 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
10088 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
10089 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
10090
10091 @item B m
10092 @kindex B m (Summary)
10093 @cindex move mail
10094 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
10095 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
10096 Move the article from one mail group to another
10097 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10098 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10099
10100 @item B c
10101 @kindex B c (Summary)
10102 @cindex copy mail
10103 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
10104 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
10105 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
10106 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10107 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10108
10109 @item B B
10110 @kindex B B (Summary)
10111 @cindex crosspost mail
10112 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
10113 Crosspost the current article to some other group
10114 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
10115 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10116 be properly updated.
10117
10118 @item B i
10119 @kindex B i (Summary)
10120 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
10121 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10122 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10123 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10124
10125 @item B I
10126 @kindex B I (Summary)
10127 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
10128 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10129 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10130 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10131
10132 @item B r
10133 @kindex B r (Summary)
10134 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10135 @vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10136 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10137 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10138 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10139 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10140 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10141 (which is the default).
10142
10143 @item B w
10144 @itemx e
10145 @kindex B w (Summary)
10146 @kindex e (Summary)
10147 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10148 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10149 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10150 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10151 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10152 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10153 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
10154
10155 @item B q
10156 @kindex B q (Summary)
10157 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10158 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10159 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10160 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
10161
10162 @item B t
10163 @kindex B t (Summary)
10164 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10165 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10166 when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
10167
10168 @item B p
10169 @kindex B p (Summary)
10170 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10171 Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10172 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10173 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10174 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10175 article from your news server (or rather, from
10176 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10177 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10178 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10179 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10180 just not have arrived yet.
10181
10182 @item K E
10183 @kindex K E (Summary)
10184 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10185 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10186 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10187 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10188 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
10189
10190 @end table
10191
10192 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10193 @cindex moving articles
10194 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10195 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10196 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10197 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10198 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10199 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10200 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
10201
10202 @lisp
10203 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
10204 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10205 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10206 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
10207 @end lisp
10208
10209
10210 @node Various Summary Stuff
10211 @section Various Summary Stuff
10212
10213 @menu
10214 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10215 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10216 * Summary Generation Commands::
10217 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10218 @end menu
10219
10220 @table @code
10221 @vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10222 @item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10223 If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10224 built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10225 If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10226 lines. The default is @code{nil}.
10227
10228 @vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10229 @item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10230 If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10231 current article.
10232
10233 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10234 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10235 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
10236
10237 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10238 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10239 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10240 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10241 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10242 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10243 have been set.
10244
10245 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10246 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10247 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10248 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10249 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
10250
10251 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10252 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10253 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10254 generated.
10255
10256 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10257 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10258 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10259 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10260 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10261 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10262 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10263 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10264 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10265 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
10266
10267 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10268 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10269 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10270 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10271 list of articles to be selected.
10272
10273 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10274 the list in one particular group:
10275
10276 @lisp
10277 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10278 (if (string= group "some.group")
10279 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10280 articles))
10281 @end lisp
10282
10283 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10284 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10285 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10286 variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10287 values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10288 buffer is active.
10289
10290 Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10291 @code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10292 assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10293 that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10294 variable will be used instead.
10295
10296 These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10297 while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10298 buffers. For example:
10299
10300 @lisp
10301 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10302 '(message-use-followup-to
10303 (gnus-visible-headers .
10304 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
10305 @end lisp
10306
10307 Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
10308 @end table
10309
10310
10311 @node Summary Group Information
10312 @subsection Summary Group Information
10313
10314 @table @kbd
10315
10316 @item H f
10317 @kindex H f (Summary)
10318 @findex gnus-summary-fetch-faq
10319 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
10320 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} (list of frequently asked questions)
10321 for the current group (@code{gnus-summary-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try
10322 to get the @acronym{FAQ} from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which
10323 is usually a directory on a remote machine. This variable can also be
10324 a list of directories. In that case, giving a prefix to this command
10325 will allow you to choose between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp}
10326 or @code{efs} will probably be used for fetching the file.
10327
10328 @item H d
10329 @kindex H d (Summary)
10330 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10331 Give a brief description of the current group
10332 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10333 rereading the description from the server.
10334
10335 @item H h
10336 @kindex H h (Summary)
10337 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10338 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10339 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
10340
10341 @item H i
10342 @kindex H i (Summary)
10343 @findex gnus-info-find-node
10344 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
10345 @end table
10346
10347
10348 @node Searching for Articles
10349 @subsection Searching for Articles
10350
10351 @table @kbd
10352
10353 @item M-s
10354 @kindex M-s (Summary)
10355 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10356 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10357 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
10358
10359 @item M-r
10360 @kindex M-r (Summary)
10361 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10362 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10363 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
10364
10365 @item &
10366 @kindex & (Summary)
10367 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10368 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10369 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10370 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10371 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10372 search backward instead.
10373
10374 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10375 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
10376
10377 @item M-&
10378 @kindex M-& (Summary)
10379 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10380 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10381 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10382 @end table
10383
10384 @node Summary Generation Commands
10385 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
10386
10387 @table @kbd
10388
10389 @item Y g
10390 @kindex Y g (Summary)
10391 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
10392 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
10393
10394 @item Y c
10395 @kindex Y c (Summary)
10396 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10397 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10398 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
10399
10400 @item Y d
10401 @kindex Y d (Summary)
10402 @findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10403 Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10404 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
10405
10406 @end table
10407
10408
10409 @node Really Various Summary Commands
10410 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
10411
10412 @table @kbd
10413
10414 @item A D
10415 @itemx C-d
10416 @kindex C-d (Summary)
10417 @kindex A D (Summary)
10418 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10419 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10420 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10421 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10422 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10423 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10424 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10425 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10426 fashion.
10427
10428 @item C-M-d
10429 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
10430 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
10431 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
10432 several documents into one biiig group
10433 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
10434 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
10435 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
10436 command understands the process/prefix convention
10437 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10438
10439 @item C-t
10440 @kindex C-t (Summary)
10441 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
10442 Toggle truncation of summary lines
10443 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
10444 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
10445 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
10446
10447 @item =
10448 @kindex = (Summary)
10449 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
10450 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
10451 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
10452
10453 @item C-M-e
10454 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
10455 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
10456 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10457 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
10458
10459 @item C-M-a
10460 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
10461 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
10462 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10463 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
10464
10465 @end table
10466
10467
10468 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
10469 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
10470 @cindex summary exit
10471 @cindex exiting groups
10472
10473 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
10474 group and return you to the group buffer.
10475
10476 @table @kbd
10477
10478 @item Z Z
10479 @itemx Z Q
10480 @itemx q
10481 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
10482 @kindex Z Q (Summary)
10483 @kindex q (Summary)
10484 @findex gnus-summary-exit
10485 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
10486 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
10487 @vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
10488 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
10489 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
10490 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
10491 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
10492 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
10493 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
10494 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
10495 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
10496
10497 @item Z E
10498 @itemx Q
10499 @kindex Z E (Summary)
10500 @kindex Q (Summary)
10501 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
10502 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
10503 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
10504
10505 @item Z c
10506 @itemx c
10507 @kindex Z c (Summary)
10508 @kindex c (Summary)
10509 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
10510 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
10511 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
10512 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
10513
10514 @item Z C
10515 @kindex Z C (Summary)
10516 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
10517 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
10518 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
10519
10520 @item Z n
10521 @kindex Z n (Summary)
10522 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
10523 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
10524 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
10525
10526 @item Z R
10527 @itemx C-x C-s
10528 @kindex Z R (Summary)
10529 @kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
10530 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
10531 Exit this group, and then enter it again
10532 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
10533 all articles, both read and unread.
10534
10535 @item Z G
10536 @itemx M-g
10537 @kindex Z G (Summary)
10538 @kindex M-g (Summary)
10539 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
10540 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
10541 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
10542 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
10543 articles, both read and unread.
10544
10545 @item Z N
10546 @kindex Z N (Summary)
10547 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
10548 Exit the group and go to the next group
10549 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
10550
10551 @item Z P
10552 @kindex Z P (Summary)
10553 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
10554 Exit the group and go to the previous group
10555 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
10556
10557 @item Z s
10558 @kindex Z s (Summary)
10559 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
10560 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
10561 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
10562 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
10563 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
10564 @end table
10565
10566 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
10567 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
10568 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
10569 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
10570
10571 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
10572 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
10573 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
10574 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
10575 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
10576 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
10577 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
10578 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
10579 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
10580 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
10581 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
10582 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
10583
10584 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
10585
10586 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
10587 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
10588 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
10589 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
10590 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
10591 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
10592 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
10593 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
10594 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
10595
10596
10597 @node Crosspost Handling
10598 @section Crosspost Handling
10599
10600 @cindex velveeta
10601 @cindex spamming
10602 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
10603 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
10604 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
10605 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
10606 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
10607 heinous crime. You may want to try NoCeM handling to filter out spam
10608 (@pxref{NoCeM}).
10609
10610 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
10611 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
10612 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
10613 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
10614 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
10615
10616 @cindex cross-posting
10617 @cindex Xref
10618 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
10619 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
10620 correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
10621 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
10622 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
10623 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
10624 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
10625 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
10626 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
10627 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
10628 the cross reference mechanism.
10629
10630 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
10631 @cindex overview.fmt
10632 To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
10633 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
10634 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
10635 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
10636 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
10637 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
10638 overview files.
10639
10640 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
10641 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
10642 set @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
10643 considerably.
10644
10645 C'est la vie.
10646
10647 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
10648
10649
10650 @node Duplicate Suppression
10651 @section Duplicate Suppression
10652
10653 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
10654 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
10655 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
10656 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
10657 reasons.
10658
10659 @enumerate
10660 @item
10661 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
10662 is evil and not very common.
10663
10664 @item
10665 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
10666 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
10667
10668 @item
10669 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
10670 different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
10671
10672 @item
10673 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
10674 @end enumerate
10675
10676 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
10677 well, but these four are the most common situations.
10678
10679 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
10680 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
10681 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
10682 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
10683 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
10684 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
10685 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
10686 once.
10687
10688 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
10689 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
10690 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
10691 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
10692 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
10693 saw the article in.
10694
10695 @table @code
10696 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
10697 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
10698 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
10699
10700 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
10701 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
10702 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
10703 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
10704 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
10705 session are suppressed.
10706
10707 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
10708 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
10709 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
10710 suppression list. The default is 10000.
10711
10712 @item gnus-duplicate-file
10713 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
10714 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
10715 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
10716 @end table
10717
10718 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
10719 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
10720 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
10721 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
10722 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
10723 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
10724 to you to figure out, I think.
10725
10726 @node Security
10727 @section Security
10728
10729 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
10730 The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
10731 and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
10732 things to work:
10733
10734 @enumerate
10735 @item
10736 To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
10737 install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG. The Lisp interface
10738 to GnuPG included with Gnus is called PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg, PGG
10739 Manual}), but Mailcrypt and gpg.el are also supported.
10740
10741 @item
10742 To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL. OpenSSL 0.9.6
10743 or newer is recommended.
10744
10745 @end enumerate
10746
10747 The variables that control security functionality on reading messages
10748 include:
10749
10750 @table @code
10751 @item mm-verify-option
10752 @vindex mm-verify-option
10753 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
10754 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
10755 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10756
10757 @item mm-decrypt-option
10758 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
10759 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
10760 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
10761 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10762
10763 @item mml1991-use
10764 @vindex mml1991-use
10765 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10766 @acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10767 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10768 deprecated.
10769
10770 @item mml2015-use
10771 @vindex mml2015-use
10772 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10773 @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10774 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10775 deprecated.
10776
10777 @end table
10778
10779 By default the buttons that display security information are not
10780 shown, because they clutter reading the actual e-mail. You can type
10781 @kbd{K b} manually to display the information. Use the
10782 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types} and
10783 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} variables to control this
10784 permanently. @ref{MIME Commands} for further details, and hints on
10785 how to customize these variables to always display security
10786 information.
10787
10788 @cindex snarfing keys
10789 @cindex importing PGP keys
10790 @cindex PGP key ring import
10791 Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
10792 key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
10793 rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
10794 allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
10795 through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
10796 @file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
10797 Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
10798 Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
10799 (@pxref{Using MIME}).
10800
10801 @example
10802 application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
10803 @end example
10804 @noindent
10805 This happens to also be the default action defined in
10806 @code{mailcap-mime-data}.
10807
10808 More information on how to set things for sending outgoing signed and
10809 encrypted messages up can be found in the message manual
10810 (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
10811
10812 @node Mailing List
10813 @section Mailing List
10814 @cindex mailing list
10815 @cindex RFC 2396
10816
10817 @kindex A M (summary)
10818 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
10819 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
10820 add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
10821 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
10822 summary buffer.
10823
10824 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
10825
10826 @table @kbd
10827
10828 @item C-c C-n h
10829 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
10830 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
10831 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
10832
10833 @item C-c C-n s
10834 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
10835 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
10836 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
10837
10838 @item C-c C-n u
10839 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
10840 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
10841 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
10842 field exists.
10843
10844 @item C-c C-n p
10845 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
10846 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
10847 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
10848
10849 @item C-c C-n o
10850 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
10851 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10852 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
10853
10854 @item C-c C-n a
10855 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
10856 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10857 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
10858
10859 @end table
10860
10861
10862 @node Article Buffer
10863 @chapter Article Buffer
10864 @cindex article buffer
10865
10866 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
10867 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
10868 tell Gnus otherwise.
10869
10870 @menu
10871 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
10872 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
10873 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
10874 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
10875 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
10876 @end menu
10877
10878
10879 @node Hiding Headers
10880 @section Hiding Headers
10881 @cindex hiding headers
10882 @cindex deleting headers
10883
10884 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
10885 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
10886
10887 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
10888 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
10889 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
10890 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
10891 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
10892 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
10893 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
10894 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
10895 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
10896
10897 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
10898
10899 @table @code
10900
10901 @item gnus-visible-headers
10902 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
10903 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
10904 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
10905 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
10906
10907 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
10908 the article and the subject, you'd say:
10909
10910 @lisp
10911 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
10912 @end lisp
10913
10914 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10915 remain visible.
10916
10917 @item gnus-ignored-headers
10918 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
10919 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
10920 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
10921 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
10922 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
10923
10924 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
10925 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
10926
10927 @lisp
10928 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
10929 @end lisp
10930
10931 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10932 be removed.
10933
10934 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
10935 variable will have no effect.
10936
10937 @end table
10938
10939 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
10940 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
10941 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
10942 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
10943 the headers are to be displayed.
10944
10945 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
10946 and then the subject, you might say something like:
10947
10948 @lisp
10949 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
10950 @end lisp
10951
10952 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
10953 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
10954
10955 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
10956 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
10957 You can hide further boring headers by setting
10958 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
10959 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
10960 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
10961 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
10962 from sight.
10963
10964 These conditions are:
10965 @table @code
10966 @item empty
10967 Remove all empty headers.
10968 @item followup-to
10969 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
10970 @code{Newsgroups} header.
10971 @item reply-to
10972 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
10973 the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
10974 parameter is set.
10975 @item newsgroups
10976 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
10977 name.
10978 @item to-address
10979 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
10980 the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
10981 @item to-list
10982 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
10983 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
10984 @item cc-list
10985 Remove the @code{Cc} header if it only contains the address identical to
10986 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
10987 @item date
10988 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
10989 old.
10990 @item long-to
10991 Remove the @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} header if it is very long.
10992 @item many-to
10993 Remove all @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} headers if there are more than one.
10994 @end table
10995
10996 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
10997
10998 @lisp
10999 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
11000 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
11001 @end lisp
11002
11003 This is also the default value for this variable.
11004
11005
11006 @node Using MIME
11007 @section Using MIME
11008 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11009
11010 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
11011 while people stand around yawning.
11012
11013 @acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
11014 while all newsreaders die of fear.
11015
11016 @acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
11017 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
11018 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
11019
11020 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
11021 @findex gnus-display-mime
11022 Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
11023 to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
11024 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
11025 display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
11026
11027 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
11028 @acronym{MIME} button:
11029
11030 @table @kbd
11031 @findex gnus-article-press-button
11032 @item RET (Article)
11033 @kindex RET (Article)
11034 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
11035 Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
11036 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
11037 the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
11038 files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
11039 object is displayed inline.
11040
11041 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
11042 @item M-RET (Article)
11043 @kindex M-RET (Article)
11044 @itemx v (Article)
11045 Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11046 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
11047
11048 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
11049 @item t (Article)
11050 @kindex t (Article)
11051 View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
11052 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
11053
11054 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
11055 @item C (Article)
11056 @kindex C (Article)
11057 Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11058 charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
11059
11060 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
11061 @item o (Article)
11062 @kindex o (Article)
11063 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
11064 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
11065
11066 @findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
11067 @item C-o (Article)
11068 @kindex C-o (Article)
11069 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
11070 the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
11071 suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
11072 like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
11073 message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
11074 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
11075
11076 @findex gnus-mime-delete-part
11077 @item d (Article)
11078 @kindex d (Article)
11079 Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
11080 information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
11081 (@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
11082
11083 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
11084 @item c (Article)
11085 @kindex c (Article)
11086 Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
11087 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
11088 @file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
11089 @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
11090 Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11091
11092 @findex gnus-mime-print-part
11093 @item p (Article)
11094 @kindex p (Article)
11095 Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
11096 command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
11097 @file{.mailcap} file.
11098
11099 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
11100 @item i (Article)
11101 @kindex i (Article)
11102 Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
11103 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as text/plain. If given a prefix, insert
11104 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
11105 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
11106 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
11107 Article}).
11108
11109 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
11110 @item E (Article)
11111 @kindex E (Article)
11112 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
11113 viewer is available, use an external viewer
11114 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
11115
11116 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
11117 @item e (Article)
11118 @kindex e (Article)
11119 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
11120 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
11121
11122 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
11123 @item | (Article)
11124 @kindex | (Article)
11125 Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
11126
11127 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
11128 @item . (Article)
11129 @kindex . (Article)
11130 Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11131 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
11132
11133 @end table
11134
11135 Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11136 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11137 @acronym{MIME} manual.
11138
11139 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11140 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11141 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11142 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11143 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11144 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11145 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11146 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11147 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
11148
11149 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
11150
11151 Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
11152
11153
11154 @node Customizing Articles
11155 @section Customizing Articles
11156 @cindex article customization
11157
11158 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11159 exist. You can call these functions interactively
11160 (@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11161 called automatically when you select the articles.
11162
11163 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11164 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11165 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11166 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
11167
11168 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11169 for sensible values.
11170
11171 @enumerate
11172 @item
11173 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
11174
11175 @item
11176 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
11177
11178 @item
11179 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
11180
11181 @item
11182 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last part.
11183
11184 @item
11185 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11186 than this number.
11187
11188 @item
11189 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11190 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11191 regexps in the list.
11192
11193 @item
11194 A list where the first element is not a string:
11195
11196 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11197 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11198 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
11199
11200 @lisp
11201 (or last
11202 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11203 @end lisp
11204
11205 @end enumerate
11206
11207 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11208 to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11209 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11210 considered to contain just a single part.
11211
11212 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11213 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11214 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11215 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11216 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11217 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11218 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
11219
11220 @ifinfo
11221 @c Avoid sort of redundant entries in the same section for the printed
11222 @c manual, but add them in info to allow `i gnus-treat-foo-bar RET' or
11223 @c `i foo-bar'.
11224 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize
11225 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize-head
11226 @vindex gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences
11227 @vindex gnus-treat-overstrike
11228 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-cr
11229 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body
11230 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines
11231 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines
11232 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-pem
11233 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines
11234 @vindex gnus-treat-unsplit-urls
11235 @vindex gnus-treat-wash-html
11236 @vindex gnus-treat-date-english
11237 @vindex gnus-treat-date-iso8601
11238 @vindex gnus-treat-date-lapsed
11239 @vindex gnus-treat-date-local
11240 @vindex gnus-treat-date-original
11241 @vindex gnus-treat-date-user-defined
11242 @vindex gnus-treat-date-ut
11243 @vindex gnus-treat-from-picon
11244 @vindex gnus-treat-mail-picon
11245 @vindex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
11246 @vindex gnus-treat-display-smileys
11247 @vindex gnus-treat-body-boundary
11248 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11249 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
11250 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
11251 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
11252 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
11253 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
11254 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
11255 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
11256 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
11257 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
11258 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
11259 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
11260 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
11261 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
11262 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
11263 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
11264 @vindex gnus-treat-translate
11265 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
11266 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
11267 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
11268 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
11269 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
11270 @end ifinfo
11271
11272 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11273 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11274 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11275 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
11276
11277 @table @code
11278 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11279 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
11280
11281 @xref{Article Buttons}.
11282
11283 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11284 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11285 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11286 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11287 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, integer)
11288 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11289 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11290 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11291 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11292 @item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
11293
11294 @xref{Article Washing}.
11295
11296 @item gnus-treat-date-english (head)
11297 @item gnus-treat-date-iso8601 (head)
11298 @item gnus-treat-date-lapsed (head)
11299 @item gnus-treat-date-local (head)
11300 @item gnus-treat-date-original (head)
11301 @item gnus-treat-date-user-defined (head)
11302 @item gnus-treat-date-ut (head)
11303
11304 @xref{Article Date}.
11305
11306 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
11307 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
11308 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
11309
11310 @xref{Picons}.
11311
11312 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
11313
11314 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
11315
11316 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
11317 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
11318 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
11319
11320 @xref{Smileys}.
11321
11322 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11323 @item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
11324
11325 @xref{X-Face}.
11326
11327 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
11328 @item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
11329
11330 @xref{Face}.
11331
11332 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
11333 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
11334 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
11335 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
11336 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
11337 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
11338 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
11339 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
11340 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
11341 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
11342 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
11343 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
11344 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
11345 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
11346 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
11347 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
11348 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
11349 @item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
11350 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
11351 @item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
11352
11353 @xref{Article Hiding}.
11354
11355 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
11356 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
11357 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
11358 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
11359 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
11360 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
11361
11362 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
11363
11364 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
11365 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
11366 @vindex gnus-treat-translate
11367 @item gnus-treat-translate
11368 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
11369 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
11370
11371 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
11372 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
11373 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
11374 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
11375 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
11376 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
11377 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
11378 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
11379
11380 @xref{Article Header}.
11381
11382
11383 @end table
11384
11385 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
11386 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
11387 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
11388 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
11389 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
11390 everything.
11391
11392
11393 @node Article Keymap
11394 @section Article Keymap
11395
11396 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
11397 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
11398 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
11399 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
11400 buffer.
11401
11402 @kindex v (Article)
11403 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Article)
11404 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it key to some
11405 function or better use it as a prefix key.
11406
11407 A few additional keystrokes are available:
11408
11409 @table @kbd
11410
11411 @item SPACE
11412 @kindex SPACE (Article)
11413 @findex gnus-article-next-page
11414 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
11415 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
11416
11417 @item DEL
11418 @kindex DEL (Article)
11419 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
11420 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
11421 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
11422
11423 @item C-c ^
11424 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
11425 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
11426 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
11427 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
11428 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
11429
11430 @item C-c C-m
11431 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
11432 @findex gnus-article-mail
11433 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
11434 given a prefix, include the mail.
11435
11436 @item s
11437 @kindex s (Article)
11438 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
11439 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
11440 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
11441
11442 @item ?
11443 @kindex ? (Article)
11444 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
11445 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
11446 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
11447
11448 @item TAB
11449 @kindex TAB (Article)
11450 @findex gnus-article-next-button
11451 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
11452 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
11453
11454 @item M-TAB
11455 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
11456 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
11457 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
11458
11459 @item R
11460 @kindex R (Article)
11461 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
11462 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
11463 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If given a prefix, make a
11464 wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11465 region.
11466
11467 @item F
11468 @kindex F (Article)
11469 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
11470 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
11471 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If given a prefix, make
11472 a wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11473 region.
11474
11475
11476 @end table
11477
11478
11479 @node Misc Article
11480 @section Misc Article
11481
11482 @table @code
11483
11484 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
11485 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
11486 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
11487 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
11488 article buffer.
11489
11490 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
11491 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
11492 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11493 Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
11494 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
11495
11496 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
11497 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
11498 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
11499 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
11500 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
11501 the contents of the article buffer.
11502
11503 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
11504 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
11505 Hook called in article mode buffers.
11506
11507 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11508 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11509 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
11510 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
11511
11512 @vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
11513 @item gnus-article-over-scroll
11514 If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
11515 no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
11516
11517 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
11518 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
11519 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
11520 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
11521 Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
11522 with two extensions:
11523
11524 @table @samp
11525
11526 @item w
11527 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
11528 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
11529 performed. The characters and their meaning:
11530
11531 @table @samp
11532
11533 @item c
11534 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
11535
11536 @item h
11537 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
11538
11539 @item p
11540 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
11541 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
11542 security status, i.e. good or bad signature.)
11543
11544 @item s
11545 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
11546
11547 @item o
11548 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
11549
11550 @item e
11551 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasised strings in the article buffer.
11552
11553 @end table
11554
11555 @item m
11556 The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
11557
11558 @end table
11559
11560 @vindex gnus-break-pages
11561
11562 @item gnus-break-pages
11563 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
11564 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
11565 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
11566 paging will not be done.
11567
11568 @item gnus-page-delimiter
11569 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
11570 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
11571 (formfeed).
11572
11573 @cindex IDNA
11574 @cindex internationalized domain names
11575 @vindex gnus-use-idna
11576 @item gnus-use-idna
11577 This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
11578 internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
11579 @samp{Cc} headers. This requires
11580 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
11581 variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
11582
11583 @end table
11584
11585
11586 @node Composing Messages
11587 @chapter Composing Messages
11588 @cindex composing messages
11589 @cindex messages
11590 @cindex mail
11591 @cindex sending mail
11592 @cindex reply
11593 @cindex followup
11594 @cindex post
11595 @cindex using gpg
11596 @cindex using s/mime
11597 @cindex using smime
11598
11599 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
11600 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
11601 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
11602 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
11603 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
11604 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
11605
11606 @menu
11607 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
11608 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
11609 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
11610 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
11611 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
11612 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
11613 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
11614 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
11615 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
11616 @end menu
11617
11618 Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
11619 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
11620
11621
11622 @node Mail
11623 @section Mail
11624
11625 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
11626
11627 @table @code
11628 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
11629 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
11630 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
11631 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
11632 @code{nil} include all headers.
11633
11634 @item gnus-add-to-list
11635 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
11636 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
11637 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
11638
11639 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11640 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11641 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
11642 about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
11643 interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
11644 receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
11645 non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
11646 matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
11647
11648 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
11649 press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
11650
11651 @item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11652 @vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11653 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
11654 @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
11655 useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
11656
11657 @end table
11658
11659
11660 @node Posting Server
11661 @section Posting Server
11662
11663 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
11664 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
11665
11666 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
11667
11668 It can be quite complicated.
11669
11670 @vindex gnus-post-method
11671 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
11672 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
11673 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
11674 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
11675 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
11676 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
11677 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
11678 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
11679 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
11680
11681 @lisp
11682 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
11683 @end lisp
11684
11685 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
11686 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
11687 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
11688 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
11689
11690 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
11691 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
11692
11693 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
11694 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
11695 for posting.
11696
11697 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
11698 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
11699
11700 When sending mail, Message invokes @code{message-send-mail-function}.
11701 The default function, @code{message-send-mail-with-sendmail}, pipes
11702 your article to the @code{sendmail} binary for further queuing and
11703 sending. When your local system is not configured for sending mail
11704 using @code{sendmail}, and you have access to a remote @acronym{SMTP}
11705 server, you can set @code{message-send-mail-function} to
11706 @code{smtpmail-send-it} and make sure to setup the @code{smtpmail}
11707 package correctly. An example:
11708
11709 @lisp
11710 (setq message-send-mail-function 'smtpmail-send-it
11711 smtpmail-default-smtp-server "YOUR SMTP HOST")
11712 @end lisp
11713
11714 To the thing similar to this, there is
11715 @code{message-smtpmail-send-it}. It is useful if your @acronym{ISP}
11716 requires the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication.
11717 @xref{POP before SMTP}.
11718
11719 Other possible choices for @code{message-send-mail-function} includes
11720 @code{message-send-mail-with-mh}, @code{message-send-mail-with-qmail},
11721 and @code{feedmail-send-it}.
11722
11723 @node POP before SMTP
11724 @section POP before SMTP
11725 @cindex pop before smtp
11726 @findex message-smtpmail-send-it
11727 @findex mail-source-touch-pop
11728
11729 Does your @acronym{ISP} require the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
11730 authentication? It is whether you need to connect to the @acronym{POP}
11731 mail server within a certain time before sending mails. If so, there is
11732 a convenient way. To do that, put the following lines in your
11733 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
11734
11735 @lisp
11736 (setq message-send-mail-function 'message-smtpmail-send-it)
11737 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
11738 @end lisp
11739
11740 @noindent
11741 It means to let Gnus connect to the @acronym{POP} mail server in advance
11742 whenever you send a mail. The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function
11743 does only a @acronym{POP} authentication according to the value of
11744 @code{mail-sources} without fetching mails, just before sending a mail.
11745 Note that you have to use @code{message-smtpmail-send-it} which runs
11746 @code{message-send-mail-hook} rather than @code{smtpmail-send-it} and
11747 set the value of @code{mail-sources} for a @acronym{POP} connection
11748 correctly. @xref{Mail Sources}.
11749
11750 If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
11751 @code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
11752 @code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
11753 used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
11754 is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
11755 mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
11756
11757 @lisp
11758 (setq mail-source-primary-source
11759 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11760 :password "secret"))
11761 @end lisp
11762
11763 @noindent
11764 Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
11765 @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
11766
11767 @lisp
11768 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
11769 (lambda ()
11770 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
11771 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11772 :password "secret")))
11773 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
11774 @end lisp
11775
11776 @node Mail and Post
11777 @section Mail and Post
11778
11779 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
11780 posting:
11781
11782 @table @code
11783 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
11784 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
11785 @cindex mailing lists
11786
11787 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
11788 gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
11789 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
11790 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
11791 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
11792 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
11793 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
11794 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
11795 still a pain, though.
11796
11797 @item gnus-user-agent
11798 @vindex gnus-user-agent
11799 @cindex User-Agent
11800
11801 This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
11802 User-Agent header. It can be one of the symbols @code{gnus} (show only
11803 Gnus version), @code{emacs-gnus} (show only Emacs and Gnus versions),
11804 @code{emacs-gnus-config} (same as @code{emacs-gnus} plus system
11805 configuration), @code{emacs-gnus-type} (same as @code{emacs-gnus} plus
11806 system type) or a custom string. If you set it to a string, be sure to
11807 use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
11808
11809 @end table
11810
11811 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
11812 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
11813 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
11814
11815 @cindex ispell
11816 @findex ispell-message
11817 @lisp
11818 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
11819 @end lisp
11820
11821 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
11822 you're in, you could say something like the following:
11823
11824 @lisp
11825 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
11826 (lambda ()
11827 (cond
11828 ((string-match
11829 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
11830 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
11831 (t
11832 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
11833 @end lisp
11834
11835 Modify to suit your needs.
11836
11837
11838 @node Archived Messages
11839 @section Archived Messages
11840 @cindex archived messages
11841 @cindex sent messages
11842
11843 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
11844 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
11845 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
11846 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}, which
11847 is the default.
11848
11849 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
11850 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
11851 Group Commands}).
11852
11853 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
11854 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
11855 use to store sent messages. The default is:
11856
11857 @lisp
11858 (nnfolder "archive"
11859 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
11860 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
11861 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
11862 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
11863 @end lisp
11864
11865 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
11866 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
11867 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
11868 directory chosen, you could say something like:
11869
11870 @lisp
11871 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
11872 '(nnfolder "archive"
11873 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
11874 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
11875 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
11876 @end lisp
11877
11878 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
11879 @cindex Gcc
11880 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
11881 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
11882 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
11883
11884 This variable can be used to do the following:
11885
11886 @table @asis
11887 @item a string
11888 Messages will be saved in that group.
11889
11890 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
11891 message will not be stored in the select method given by
11892 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
11893 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
11894 has the default value shown above. Then setting
11895 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
11896 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
11897 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
11898 @samp{nnml:foo}.
11899
11900 @item a list of strings
11901 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
11902
11903 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
11904 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
11905
11906 @item @code{nil}
11907 No message archiving will take place. This is the default.
11908 @end table
11909
11910 Let's illustrate:
11911
11912 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
11913 @lisp
11914 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
11915 @end lisp
11916
11917 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
11918 @lisp
11919 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
11920 @end lisp
11921
11922 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
11923 @lisp
11924 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11925 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
11926 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
11927 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
11928 @end lisp
11929
11930 More complex stuff:
11931 @lisp
11932 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11933 '((if (message-news-p)
11934 "misc-news"
11935 "misc-mail")))
11936 @end lisp
11937
11938 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
11939 messages in one file per month:
11940
11941 @lisp
11942 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11943 '((if (message-news-p)
11944 "misc-news"
11945 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
11946 @end lisp
11947
11948 @c (XEmacs 19.13 doesn't have @code{format-time-string}, so you'll have to
11949 @c use a different value for @code{gnus-message-archive-group} there.)
11950
11951 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
11952 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
11953 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
11954 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
11955 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
11956 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
11957 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
11958 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
11959 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
11960 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
11961
11962 That's the default method of archiving sent messages. Gnus offers a
11963 different way for the people who don't like the default method. In that
11964 case you should set @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{nil};
11965 this will disable archiving.
11966
11967 @table @code
11968 @item gnus-outgoing-message-group
11969 @vindex gnus-outgoing-message-group
11970 All outgoing messages will be put in this group. If you want to store
11971 all your outgoing mail and articles in the group @samp{nnml:archive},
11972 you set this variable to that value. This variable can also be a list of
11973 group names.
11974
11975 If you want to have greater control over what group to put each
11976 message in, you can set this variable to a function that checks the
11977 current newsgroup name and then returns a suitable group name (or list
11978 of names).
11979
11980 This variable can be used instead of @code{gnus-message-archive-group},
11981 but the latter is the preferred method.
11982
11983 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
11984 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
11985 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
11986
11987 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
11988 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
11989 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
11990 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
11991 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
11992 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
11993 changed in the future.
11994
11995 @end table
11996
11997
11998 @node Posting Styles
11999 @section Posting Styles
12000 @cindex posting styles
12001 @cindex styles
12002
12003 All them variables, they make my head swim.
12004
12005 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
12006 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
12007 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
12008 on?
12009
12010 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
12011 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
12012 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
12013 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
12014 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
12015 variable:
12016
12017 @lisp
12018 ((".*"
12019 (signature "Peace and happiness")
12020 (organization "What me?"))
12021 ("^comp"
12022 (signature "Death to everybody"))
12023 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
12024 (organization "Emacs is it")))
12025 @end lisp
12026
12027 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
12028 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
12029 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
12030 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
12031 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
12032 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
12033 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
12034 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
12035
12036 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
12037 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
12038 If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
12039 will look in the original article for a header whose name is
12040 @var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
12041 @var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
12042 replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
12043 followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
12044 @code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
12045 no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
12046 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
12047 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
12048 said to @dfn{match}.
12049
12050 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
12051 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
12052 addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
12053 form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
12054 @code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
12055 contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
12056 @var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
12057 name can be one of:
12058
12059 @itemize @bullet
12060 @item @code{signature}
12061 @item @code{signature-file}
12062 @item @code{x-face-file}
12063 @item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
12064 @item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
12065 @item @code{body}
12066 @end itemize
12067
12068 The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
12069 this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
12070 the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
12071 name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
12072 is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
12073
12074 The attribute value can be a string (used verbatim), a function with
12075 zero arguments (the return value will be used), a variable (its value
12076 will be used) or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value
12077 will be used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
12078 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current article
12079 are available through the @code{message-reply-headers} variable, which
12080 is a vector of the following headers: number subject from date id
12081 references chars lines xref extra.
12082
12083 @vindex message-reply-headers
12084
12085 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
12086 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
12087 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
12088
12089 @findex message-mail-p
12090 @findex message-news-p
12091
12092 So here's a new example:
12093
12094 @lisp
12095 (setq gnus-posting-styles
12096 '((".*"
12097 (signature-file "~/.signature")
12098 (name "User Name")
12099 (x-face-file "~/.xface")
12100 (x-url (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
12101 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
12102 ("^rec.humor"
12103 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
12104 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
12105 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
12106 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
12107 (signature my-news-signature))
12108 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
12109 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
12110 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
12111 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
12112 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
12113 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
12114 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
12115 (address "user@@bar.foo")
12116 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
12117 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
12118 ("nnml:.*"
12119 (From (save-excursion
12120 (set-buffer gnus-article-buffer)
12121 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
12122 ("^nn.+:"
12123 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
12124 @end lisp
12125
12126 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
12127 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
12128 if you fill many roles.
12129 You may also use @code{message-alternative-emails} instead.
12130 @xref{Message Headers, ,Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
12131
12132 @node Drafts
12133 @section Drafts
12134 @cindex drafts
12135
12136 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
12137 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
12138 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
12139 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
12140 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
12141
12142 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
12143 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
12144 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
12145 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
12146 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
12147 group.)
12148
12149 @cindex nndraft
12150 @vindex nndraft-directory
12151 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
12152 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
12153 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
12154 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
12155 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
12156 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
12157
12158 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
12159 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
12160 unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
12161 a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
12162 behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
12163 be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
12164 simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
12165 Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
12166 correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
12167
12168 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
12169 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
12170 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
12171 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
12172 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
12173 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
12174 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
12175 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
12176 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
12177 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
12178 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
12179 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
12180 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
12181 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
12182 @c
12183 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
12184 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
12185 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
12186
12187 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
12188 @kindex D e (Draft)
12189 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
12190 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
12191 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
12192
12193 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
12194 Articles}).
12195
12196 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
12197 @kindex D s (Draft)
12198 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
12199 @kindex D S (Draft)
12200 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
12201 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
12202 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
12203 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
12204 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
12205 in the buffer.
12206
12207 @findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
12208 @kindex D t (Draft)
12209 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
12210 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
12211 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
12212
12213
12214 @node Rejected Articles
12215 @section Rejected Articles
12216 @cindex rejected articles
12217
12218 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12219 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12220 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12221 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
12222
12223 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12224 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12225 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
12226 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
12227 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
12228
12229 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
12230 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
12231 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
12232
12233 @node Signing and encrypting
12234 @section Signing and encrypting
12235 @cindex using gpg
12236 @cindex using s/mime
12237 @cindex using smime
12238
12239 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
12240 @acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
12241 decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
12242 @code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
12243
12244 @vindex gnus-message-replysign
12245 @vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
12246 @vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
12247 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
12248 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
12249 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
12250 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
12251 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
12252 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
12253 automatically encrypted messages.
12254
12255 Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
12256 @acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
12257 signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
12258
12259 @table @kbd
12260
12261 @item C-c C-m s s
12262 @kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
12263 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
12264
12265 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12266
12267 @item C-c C-m s o
12268 @kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
12269 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12270
12271 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12272
12273 @item C-c C-m s p
12274 @kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
12275 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12276
12277 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12278
12279 @item C-c C-m c s
12280 @kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
12281 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
12282
12283 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12284
12285 @item C-c C-m c o
12286 @kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
12287 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
12288
12289 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12290
12291 @item C-c C-m c p
12292 @kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
12293 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
12294
12295 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12296
12297 @item C-c C-m C-n
12298 @kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
12299 @findex mml-unsecure-message
12300 Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
12301
12302 @end table
12303
12304 @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
12305
12306 @node Select Methods
12307 @chapter Select Methods
12308 @cindex foreign groups
12309 @cindex select methods
12310
12311 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
12312 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
12313 @acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
12314 personal mail group.
12315
12316 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
12317 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
12318 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g. @code{nntp},
12319 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
12320 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
12321 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
12322
12323 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
12324 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
12325
12326 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
12327 group as.
12328
12329 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
12330 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
12331 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
12332 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
12333 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
12334
12335 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
12336
12337 @menu
12338 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
12339 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
12340 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
12341 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
12342 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
12343 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
12344 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
12345 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
12346 @end menu
12347
12348
12349 @node Server Buffer
12350 @section Server Buffer
12351
12352 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
12353 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
12354 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
12355 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
12356 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
12357 back end represents a virtual server.
12358
12359 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
12360 different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
12361 on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
12362 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
12363
12364 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
12365 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
12366 @acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
12367 hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
12368 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
12369 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
12370 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
12371
12372 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
12373 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
12374
12375 @menu
12376 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
12377 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
12378 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
12379 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
12380 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
12381 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
12382 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
12383 @end menu
12384
12385 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
12386 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
12387
12388
12389 @node Server Buffer Format
12390 @subsection Server Buffer Format
12391 @cindex server buffer format
12392
12393 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
12394 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
12395 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
12396 variable, with some simple extensions:
12397
12398 @table @samp
12399
12400 @item h
12401 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
12402
12403 @item n
12404 The name of this server.
12405
12406 @item w
12407 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
12408
12409 @item s
12410 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
12411
12412 @item a
12413 Whether this server is agentized.
12414 @end table
12415
12416 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
12417 The mode line can also be customized by using the
12418 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
12419 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
12420
12421 @table @samp
12422 @item S
12423 Server name.
12424
12425 @item M
12426 Server method.
12427 @end table
12428
12429 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
12430
12431
12432 @node Server Commands
12433 @subsection Server Commands
12434 @cindex server commands
12435
12436 @table @kbd
12437
12438 @item v
12439 @kindex v (Server)
12440 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Server)
12441 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it key to some
12442 function or better use it as a prefix key.
12443
12444 @item a
12445 @kindex a (Server)
12446 @findex gnus-server-add-server
12447 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
12448
12449 @item e
12450 @kindex e (Server)
12451 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
12452 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
12453
12454 @item SPACE
12455 @kindex SPACE (Server)
12456 @findex gnus-server-read-server
12457 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
12458
12459 @item q
12460 @kindex q (Server)
12461 @findex gnus-server-exit
12462 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
12463
12464 @item k
12465 @kindex k (Server)
12466 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
12467 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
12468
12469 @item y
12470 @kindex y (Server)
12471 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
12472 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
12473
12474 @item c
12475 @kindex c (Server)
12476 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
12477 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
12478
12479 @item l
12480 @kindex l (Server)
12481 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
12482 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
12483
12484 @item s
12485 @kindex s (Server)
12486 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
12487 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
12488 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
12489 servers.
12490
12491 @item g
12492 @kindex g (Server)
12493 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
12494 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
12495 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
12496 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
12497
12498 @end table
12499
12500
12501 @node Example Methods
12502 @subsection Example Methods
12503
12504 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
12505
12506 @lisp
12507 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
12508 @end lisp
12509
12510 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
12511
12512 @lisp
12513 (nnspool "")
12514 @end lisp
12515
12516 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
12517 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
12518 will.
12519
12520 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
12521 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
12522
12523 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
12524 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
12525 look like then:
12526
12527 @lisp
12528 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
12529 @end lisp
12530
12531 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
12532 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
12533
12534 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
12535 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
12536 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
12537 your private mail:
12538
12539 @lisp
12540 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
12541 @end lisp
12542
12543 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
12544 that.)
12545
12546 Here's the method for a public spool:
12547
12548 @lisp
12549 (nnmh "public"
12550 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
12551 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
12552 @end lisp
12553
12554 @cindex proxy
12555 @cindex firewall
12556
12557 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
12558 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
12559 on the firewall machine and telnet from there to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12560 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
12561 should probably look something like this:
12562
12563 @lisp
12564 (nntp "firewall"
12565 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
12566 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
12567 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host")
12568 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12569 @end lisp
12570
12571 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
12572 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
12573 configuration to the example above:
12574
12575 @lisp
12576 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
12577 @end lisp
12578
12579 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}.
12580
12581 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
12582 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
12583 telnet connection to the news server as follows:
12584
12585 @lisp
12586 (nntp "outside"
12587 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
12588 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-telnet)
12589 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
12590 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12591 @end lisp
12592
12593 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
12594 provide automatic authorization, of course. And to get a compressed
12595 connection, you have to have the @samp{Compression} option in the
12596 @code{ssh} @file{config} file.
12597
12598
12599 @node Creating a Virtual Server
12600 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
12601
12602 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
12603 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
12604
12605 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
12606 would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
12607 could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
12608
12609 Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
12610
12611 You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
12612 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
12613 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
12614 will contain the following:
12615
12616 @lisp
12617 (nnml "cache")
12618 @end lisp
12619
12620 Change that to:
12621
12622 @lisp
12623 (nnml "cache"
12624 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
12625 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
12626 @end lisp
12627
12628 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
12629 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
12630 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
12631
12632
12633 @node Server Variables
12634 @subsection Server Variables
12635 @cindex server variables
12636 @cindex server parameters
12637
12638 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
12639 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
12640 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
12641 change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
12642 won't change the ``derived'' variables.
12643
12644 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
12645 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
12646 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
12647 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
12648 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
12649 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
12650 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
12651 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
12652 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
12653
12654 @lisp
12655 (nnml "public"
12656 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
12657 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
12658 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
12659 @end lisp
12660
12661 Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
12662
12663 @node Servers and Methods
12664 @subsection Servers and Methods
12665
12666 Wherever you would normally use a select method
12667 (e.g. @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
12668 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
12669 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
12670 over.
12671
12672
12673 @node Unavailable Servers
12674 @subsection Unavailable Servers
12675
12676 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
12677 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
12678 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
12679 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
12680 actually the case or not.
12681
12682 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
12683 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
12684 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
12685 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
12686 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
12687 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
12688 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
12689 it will regard that server as ``down''.
12690
12691 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
12692 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
12693
12694 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
12695 with the following commands:
12696
12697 @table @kbd
12698
12699 @item O
12700 @kindex O (Server)
12701 @findex gnus-server-open-server
12702 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
12703 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
12704
12705 @item C
12706 @kindex C (Server)
12707 @findex gnus-server-close-server
12708 Close the connection (if any) to the server
12709 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
12710
12711 @item D
12712 @kindex D (Server)
12713 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
12714 Mark the current server as unreachable
12715 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
12716
12717 @item M-o
12718 @kindex M-o (Server)
12719 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
12720 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
12721 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
12722
12723 @item M-c
12724 @kindex M-c (Server)
12725 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
12726 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
12727 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
12728
12729 @item R
12730 @kindex R (Server)
12731 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
12732 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
12733 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
12734
12735 @item L
12736 @kindex L (Server)
12737 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
12738 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
12739
12740 @end table
12741
12742
12743 @node Getting News
12744 @section Getting News
12745 @cindex reading news
12746 @cindex news back ends
12747
12748 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
12749 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
12750 or it can read from a local spool.
12751
12752 @menu
12753 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12754 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
12755 @end menu
12756
12757
12758 @node NNTP
12759 @subsection NNTP
12760 @cindex nntp
12761
12762 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
12763 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
12764 server as the, uhm, address.
12765
12766 If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
12767 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
12768 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
12769 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
12770
12771 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
12772 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
12773 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
12774
12775 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
12776 server:
12777
12778 @table @code
12779
12780 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
12781 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
12782 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
12783 @cindex authinfo
12784 @cindex authentication
12785 @cindex nntp authentication
12786 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12787 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
12788 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
12789 commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
12790 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
12791 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
12792 present in this hook.
12793
12794 @item nntp-authinfo-function
12795 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
12796 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12797 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
12798 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
12799 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
12800 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
12801 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
12802 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
12803 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
12804 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
12805 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
12806
12807 @enumerate
12808 @item
12809 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
12810
12811 @item
12812 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
12813
12814 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
12815 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
12816 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
12817 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
12818 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
12819 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
12820 @samp{force} is explained below.
12821
12822 @end enumerate
12823
12824 Here's an example file:
12825
12826 @example
12827 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
12828 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
12829 @end example
12830
12831 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
12832 have to be first, for instance.
12833
12834 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
12835 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
12836 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
12837 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
12838 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
12839 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
12840 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
12841
12842 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
12843 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
12844
12845 @example
12846 default force yes
12847 @end example
12848
12849 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
12850 previously mentioned.
12851
12852 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
12853
12854 @item nntp-server-action-alist
12855 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
12856 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
12857 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
12858 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
12859
12860 @lisp
12861 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
12862 '(("innd" (ding))))
12863 @end lisp
12864
12865 You probably don't want to do that, though.
12866
12867 The default value is
12868
12869 @lisp
12870 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
12871 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
12872 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
12873 @end lisp
12874
12875 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
12876 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
12877
12878 @item nntp-maximum-request
12879 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
12880 If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
12881 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
12882 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
12883 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
12884 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
12885 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
12886
12887 @item nntp-connection-timeout
12888 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
12889 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
12890 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
12891 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
12892 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
12893 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
12894 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
12895 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
12896 no timeouts are done.
12897
12898 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
12899 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
12900 If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
12901 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
12902 can be used.
12903
12904 @item nntp-xover-commands
12905 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
12906 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
12907 @cindex XOVER
12908 List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
12909 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
12910 "XOVERVIEW")}.
12911
12912 @item nntp-nov-gap
12913 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
12914 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
12915 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
12916 if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
12917 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
12918 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
12919 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
12920 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
12921 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
12922 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
12923 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
12924
12925 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
12926 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
12927 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12928
12929 @item nntp-record-commands
12930 @vindex nntp-record-commands
12931 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
12932 @acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
12933 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
12934 that doesn't seem to work.
12935
12936 @item nntp-open-connection-function
12937 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
12938 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
12939 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
12940 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
12941 Six pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped in
12942 two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
12943 indirect ones (two pre-made).
12944
12945 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
12946 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
12947 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
12948 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
12949 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
12950 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
12951 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
12952
12953 @lisp
12954 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
12955 @end lisp
12956
12957 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID. This works for
12958 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
12959
12960 @end table
12961
12962 @menu
12963 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
12964 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
12965 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
12966 @end menu
12967
12968
12969 @node Direct Functions
12970 @subsubsection Direct Functions
12971 @cindex direct connection functions
12972
12973 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
12974 between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
12975 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
12976 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
12977
12978 @table @code
12979 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
12980 @item nntp-open-network-stream
12981 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
12982 remote system.
12983
12984 @findex nntp-open-tls-stream
12985 @item nntp-open-tls-stream
12986 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
12987 this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GNUTLS}
12988 installed. You then define a server as follows:
12989
12990 @lisp
12991 ;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
12992 ;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
12993 ;;
12994 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
12995 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
12996 (nntp-port-number )
12997 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
12998 @end lisp
12999
13000 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
13001 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
13002 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13003 this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL} or
13004 @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay} installed. You
13005 then define a server as follows:
13006
13007 @lisp
13008 ;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13009 ;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
13010 ;;
13011 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13012 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
13013 (nntp-port-number 563)
13014 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13015 @end lisp
13016
13017 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
13018 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
13019 Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server by simply @samp{telnet}'ing
13020 it. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have the
13021 default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
13022 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
13023 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
13024 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
13025
13026 @lisp
13027 (nntp "socksified"
13028 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13029 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
13030 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13031 @end lisp
13032
13033 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
13034 session, which is not a good idea.
13035 @end table
13036
13037
13038 @node Indirect Functions
13039 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
13040 @cindex indirect connection functions
13041
13042 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
13043 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13044 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
13045 the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
13046 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
13047 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13048
13049 @table @code
13050 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13051 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13052 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then does a @samp{telnet}
13053 to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
13054 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
13055
13056 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13057
13058 @table @code
13059 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13060 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13061 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13062 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13063
13064 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13065 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13066 List of strings to be used as the switches to
13067 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
13068 @samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
13069 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections, otherwise set
13070 this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
13071 the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
13072 host.
13073 @end table
13074
13075 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13076 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13077 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
13078 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
13079
13080 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13081
13082 @table @code
13083 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
13084 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
13085 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
13086 @samp{telnet}.
13087
13088 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
13089 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
13090 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13091 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
13092
13093 @item nntp-via-user-password
13094 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
13095 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
13096
13097 @item nntp-via-envuser
13098 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
13099 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
13100 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
13101 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
13102
13103 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
13104 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
13105 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
13106 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
13107
13108 @end table
13109
13110 @end table
13111
13112
13113 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
13114 functions:
13115
13116 @table @code
13117
13118 @item nntp-via-user-name
13119 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
13120 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
13121
13122 @item nntp-via-address
13123 @vindex nntp-via-address
13124 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
13125
13126 @end table
13127
13128
13129 @node Common Variables
13130 @subsubsection Common Variables
13131
13132 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
13133 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
13134 affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
13135 default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
13136 variables individually).
13137
13138 @table @code
13139
13140 @item nntp-pre-command
13141 @vindex nntp-pre-command
13142 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
13143 connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
13144 @code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
13145 where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
13146
13147 @item nntp-address
13148 @vindex nntp-address
13149 The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13150
13151 @item nntp-port-number
13152 @vindex nntp-port-number
13153 Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
13154 @samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
13155 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
13156 than named ports (i.e, use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
13157 @samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
13158 not work with named ports.
13159
13160 @item nntp-end-of-line
13161 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
13162 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
13163 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
13164 using a non native connection function.
13165
13166 @item nntp-telnet-command
13167 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
13168 Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
13169 @samp{telnet}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
13170 just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
13171 @samp{telnet}.
13172
13173 @item nntp-telnet-switches
13174 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
13175 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-telnet-command}. The default
13176 is @samp{("-8")}.
13177
13178 @end table
13179
13180
13181 @node News Spool
13182 @subsection News Spool
13183 @cindex nnspool
13184 @cindex news spool
13185
13186 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
13187 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
13188 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
13189 instance.
13190
13191 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
13192 anything else) as the address.
13193
13194 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
13195 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
13196 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
13197 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
13198
13199 @table @code
13200
13201 @item nnspool-inews-program
13202 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
13203 Program used to post an article.
13204
13205 @item nnspool-inews-switches
13206 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
13207 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
13208
13209 @item nnspool-spool-directory
13210 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
13211 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
13212 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
13213
13214 @item nnspool-nov-directory
13215 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
13216 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
13217 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
13218
13219 @item nnspool-lib-dir
13220 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
13221 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
13222
13223 @item nnspool-active-file
13224 @vindex nnspool-active-file
13225 The name of the active file.
13226
13227 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
13228 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
13229 The name of the group descriptions file.
13230
13231 @item nnspool-history-file
13232 @vindex nnspool-history-file
13233 The name of the news history file.
13234
13235 @item nnspool-active-times-file
13236 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
13237 The name of the active date file.
13238
13239 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
13240 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
13241 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
13242 that it finds.
13243
13244 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13245 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13246 @cindex sed
13247 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
13248 relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
13249 @code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
13250 there.
13251
13252 @end table
13253
13254
13255 @node Getting Mail
13256 @section Getting Mail
13257 @cindex reading mail
13258 @cindex mail
13259
13260 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD? But of
13261 course.
13262
13263 @menu
13264 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
13265 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
13266 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
13267 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
13268 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
13269 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
13270 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
13271 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
13272 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
13273 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
13274 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
13275 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
13276 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
13277 @end menu
13278
13279
13280 @node Mail in a Newsreader
13281 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
13282
13283 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
13284 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
13285 of a culture shock.
13286
13287 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
13288 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
13289
13290 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
13291 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
13292 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
13293 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
13294
13295 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
13296
13297 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
13298 deleted? How awful!
13299
13300 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
13301 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
13302 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
13303 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
13304 Mail}.
13305
13306 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
13307 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
13308 they want to treat a message.
13309
13310 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
13311 via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
13312 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
13313 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
13314 archived somewhere else.
13315
13316 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
13317 These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
13318 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
13319 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
13320 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
13321
13322 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
13323 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
13324 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
13325
13326 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
13327 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
13328 differently.
13329
13330 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
13331 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
13332 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
13333 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
13334 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
13335
13336 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
13337 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
13338 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
13339 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
13340 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
13341 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
13342 You Do.)
13343
13344
13345 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
13346 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
13347
13348 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
13349 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
13350 and things will happen automatically.
13351
13352 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
13353 mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
13354
13355 @lisp
13356 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
13357 @end lisp
13358
13359 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
13360 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
13361 directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
13362 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
13363 like any other group.
13364
13365 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
13366
13367 @lisp
13368 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13369 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13370 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13371 ("other" "")))
13372 @end lisp
13373
13374 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
13375 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
13376 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
13377 last group.
13378
13379 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
13380 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
13381 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
13382
13383
13384 @node Splitting Mail
13385 @subsection Splitting Mail
13386 @cindex splitting mail
13387 @cindex mail splitting
13388 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
13389
13390 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
13391 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
13392 to be split into groups.
13393
13394 @lisp
13395 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13396 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13397 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13398 ("mail.other" "")))
13399 @end lisp
13400
13401 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
13402 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
13403 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
13404 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
13405 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
13406 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
13407 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
13408
13409 @lisp
13410 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
13411 @end lisp
13412
13413 @noindent
13414 In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
13415 the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
13416
13417 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
13418 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
13419 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
13420 mail belongs in that group.
13421
13422 @cindex @samp{bogus} group
13423 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
13424 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
13425 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
13426 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
13427 to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
13428 that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
13429 will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
13430 splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
13431 see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
13432
13433 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
13434 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
13435 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
13436 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
13437 thinks should carry this mail message.
13438
13439 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
13440 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
13441 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
13442 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
13443
13444 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
13445 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
13446 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
13447 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
13448 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
13449
13450 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
13451 @cindex crosspost
13452 @cindex links
13453 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
13454 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
13455 links. If that's the case for you, set
13456 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
13457 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
13458
13459 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
13460 @findex nnmail-split-history
13461 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
13462 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
13463 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
13464 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
13465 Group Commands}).
13466
13467 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
13468 Header lines longer than the value of
13469 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
13470 function.
13471
13472 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
13473 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
13474 By default the splitting codes @acronym{MIME} decodes headers so you
13475 can match on non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. The
13476 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset} variable specifies the default
13477 charset for decoding. The behavior can be turned off completely by
13478 binding @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} to @code{nil}, which is
13479 useful if you want to match articles based on the raw header data.
13480
13481 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13482 By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
13483 specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
13484 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
13485 @emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
13486 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
13487 splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
13488 other kinds of entries.)
13489
13490 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
13491 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
13492 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
13493 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
13494 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
13495 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
13496 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
13497 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
13498 month's rent money.
13499
13500
13501 @node Mail Sources
13502 @subsection Mail Sources
13503
13504 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
13505 a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
13506 maildir, for instance.
13507
13508 @menu
13509 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
13510 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
13511 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
13512 @end menu
13513
13514
13515 @node Mail Source Specifiers
13516 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
13517 @cindex POP
13518 @cindex mail server
13519 @cindex procmail
13520 @cindex mail spool
13521 @cindex mail source
13522
13523 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
13524 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
13525
13526 Here's an example:
13527
13528 @lisp
13529 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
13530 @end lisp
13531
13532 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
13533 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
13534 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
13535 default values.
13536
13537 The following mail source types are available:
13538
13539 @table @code
13540 @item file
13541 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
13542
13543 Keywords:
13544
13545 @table @code
13546 @item :path
13547 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
13548 environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
13549 (usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
13550
13551 @item :prescript
13552 @itemx :postscript
13553 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13554 @end table
13555
13556 An example file mail source:
13557
13558 @lisp
13559 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
13560 @end lisp
13561
13562 Or using the default file name:
13563
13564 @lisp
13565 (file)
13566 @end lisp
13567
13568 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
13569 to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
13570 You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
13571 mail spool while moving the mail.
13572
13573 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
13574
13575 @lisp
13576 (setq mail-sources
13577 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
13578 @end lisp
13579
13580 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
13581
13582 @example
13583 #!/bin/sh
13584 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
13585 # flu@@iki.fi
13586
13587 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
13588 TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
13589 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
13590 @end example
13591
13592 Alter this script to fit find the @samp{movemail} you want to use.
13593
13594
13595 @item directory
13596 @vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
13597 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
13598 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
13599 That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
13600 directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
13601 will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
13602 to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
13603 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
13604 Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
13605 if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
13606
13607 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13608 There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
13609 that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
13610 applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
13611
13612 Keywords:
13613
13614 @table @code
13615 @item :path
13616 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
13617 value.
13618
13619 @item :suffix
13620 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
13621 @samp{.spool}.
13622
13623 @item :predicate
13624 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
13625 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
13626 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
13627 predicate are considered.
13628
13629 @item :prescript
13630 @itemx :postscript
13631 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13632
13633 @end table
13634
13635 An example directory mail source:
13636
13637 @lisp
13638 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
13639 :suffix ".prcml")
13640 @end lisp
13641
13642 @item pop
13643 Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
13644
13645 Keywords:
13646
13647 @table @code
13648 @item :server
13649 The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
13650 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13651
13652 @item :port
13653 The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (eg,
13654 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (eg, @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
13655 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
13656 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
13657 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
13658
13659 @item :user
13660 The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
13661 name.
13662
13663 @item :password
13664 The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
13665 the user is prompted.
13666
13667 @item :program
13668 The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
13669 should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
13670
13671 @example
13672 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
13673 @end example
13674
13675 The valid format specifier characters are:
13676
13677 @table @samp
13678 @item t
13679 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
13680 included in this string.
13681
13682 @item s
13683 The name of the server.
13684
13685 @item P
13686 The port number of the server.
13687
13688 @item u
13689 The user name to use.
13690
13691 @item p
13692 The password to use.
13693 @end table
13694
13695 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13696 corresponding keywords.
13697
13698 @item :prescript
13699 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13700 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13701
13702 @item :postscript
13703 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13704 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13705
13706 @item :function
13707 The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
13708 function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
13709 mail should be moved to.
13710
13711 @item :authentication
13712 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
13713 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
13714 @code{password}.
13715
13716 @end table
13717
13718 @vindex pop3-movemail
13719 @vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
13720 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
13721 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used. If @code{pop3-leave-mail-on-server}
13722 is non-@code{nil} the mail is to be left on the @acronym{POP} server
13723 after fetching when using @code{pop3-movemail}. Note that POP servers
13724 maintain no state information between sessions, so what the client
13725 believes is there and what is actually there may not match up. If they
13726 do not, then you may get duplicate mails or the whole thing can fall
13727 apart and leave you with a corrupt mailbox.
13728
13729 Here are some examples for getting mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
13730 Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server, using the default user
13731 name, and default fetcher:
13732
13733 @lisp
13734 (pop)
13735 @end lisp
13736
13737 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
13738
13739 @lisp
13740 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
13741 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
13742 @end lisp
13743
13744 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
13745
13746 @lisp
13747 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
13748 @end lisp
13749
13750 @item maildir
13751 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
13752 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
13753 contains exactly one mail.
13754
13755 Keywords:
13756
13757 @table @code
13758 @item :path
13759 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
13760 taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
13761 @file{~/Maildir/}.
13762 @item :subdirs
13763 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
13764 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
13765
13766 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
13767 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
13768 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
13769 @c below.
13770
13771 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
13772 from locking problems).
13773
13774 @end table
13775
13776 Two example maildir mail sources:
13777
13778 @lisp
13779 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
13780 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
13781 @end lisp
13782
13783 @lisp
13784 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
13785 :subdirs ("new"))
13786 @end lisp
13787
13788 @item imap
13789 Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
13790 @acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (ie
13791 with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
13792 to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
13793 @acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{IMAP}, for more information.
13794
13795 Note that for the Kerberos, GSSAPI, @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} and STARTTLS support you
13796 may need external programs and libraries, @xref{IMAP}.
13797
13798 Keywords:
13799
13800 @table @code
13801 @item :server
13802 The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
13803 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13804
13805 @item :port
13806 The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
13807 @samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
13808
13809 @item :user
13810 The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
13811 name.
13812
13813 @item :password
13814 The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
13815 prompted.
13816
13817 @item :stream
13818 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
13819 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
13820 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
13821 @samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
13822
13823 @item :authentication
13824 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
13825 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
13826 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
13827 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
13828
13829 @item :program
13830 When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
13831 mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
13832 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
13833
13834 @example
13835 ssh %s imapd
13836 @end example
13837
13838 The valid format specifier characters are:
13839
13840 @table @samp
13841 @item s
13842 The name of the server.
13843
13844 @item l
13845 User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
13846
13847 @item p
13848 The port number of the server.
13849 @end table
13850
13851 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13852 corresponding keywords.
13853
13854 @item :mailbox
13855 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
13856 which normally is the mailbox which receive incoming mail.
13857
13858 @item :predicate
13859 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
13860 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
13861 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
13862 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
13863 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
13864 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
13865
13866 @item :fetchflag
13867 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
13868 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
13869 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
13870 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
13871
13872 @item :dontexpunge
13873 If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
13874 mailbox after finishing the fetch.
13875
13876 @end table
13877
13878 An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
13879
13880 @lisp
13881 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
13882 :stream kerberos4
13883 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
13884 @end lisp
13885
13886 @item webmail
13887 Get mail from a webmail server, such as @uref{http://www.hotmail.com/},
13888 @uref{http://webmail.netscape.com/}, @uref{http://www.netaddress.com/},
13889 @uref{http://mail.yahoo.com/}.
13890
13891 NOTE: Webmail largely depends on cookies. A "one-line-cookie" patch is
13892 required for url "4.0pre.46".
13893
13894 WARNING: Mails may be lost. NO WARRANTY.
13895
13896 Keywords:
13897
13898 @table @code
13899 @item :subtype
13900 The type of the webmail server. The default is @code{hotmail}. The
13901 alternatives are @code{netscape}, @code{netaddress}, @code{my-deja}.
13902
13903 @item :user
13904 The user name to give to the webmail server. The default is the login
13905 name.
13906
13907 @item :password
13908 The password to give to the webmail server. If not specified, the user is
13909 prompted.
13910
13911 @item :dontexpunge
13912 If non-@code{nil}, only fetch unread articles and don't move them to
13913 trash folder after finishing the fetch.
13914
13915 @end table
13916
13917 An example webmail source:
13918
13919 @lisp
13920 (webmail :subtype 'hotmail
13921 :user "user-name"
13922 :password "secret")
13923 @end lisp
13924 @end table
13925
13926 @table @dfn
13927 @item Common Keywords
13928 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
13929
13930 Keywords:
13931
13932 @table @code
13933 @item :plugged
13934 If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
13935 use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
13936 example:
13937
13938 @lisp
13939 (setq mail-sources
13940 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
13941 :suffix ""
13942 :plugged t)))
13943 @end lisp
13944
13945 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
13946 useful when you use local mail and news.
13947
13948 @end table
13949 @end table
13950
13951 @subsubsection Function Interface
13952
13953 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
13954 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
13955 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
13956 consider the following mail-source setting:
13957
13958 @lisp
13959 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
13960 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
13961 @end lisp
13962
13963 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
13964 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
13965 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
13966 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
13967 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
13968
13969 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
13970
13971
13972 @node Mail Source Customization
13973 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
13974
13975 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
13976 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
13977 variables.
13978
13979 @table @code
13980 @item mail-source-crash-box
13981 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
13982 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
13983 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
13984
13985 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
13986 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
13987 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
13988 @code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
13989 files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
13990 (This will only happen, when receiving new mail). You may also set
13991 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
13992 @code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
13993
13994 @item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
13995 @vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
13996 If non-@code{nil}, ask for for confirmation before deleting old incoming
13997 files. This variable only applies when
13998 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
13999
14000 @item mail-source-ignore-errors
14001 @vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
14002 If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
14003
14004 @item mail-source-directory
14005 @vindex mail-source-directory
14006 Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
14007 default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
14008 is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
14009 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
14010
14011 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
14012 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
14013 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
14014 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
14015 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
14016 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
14017 number.
14018
14019 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
14020 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
14021 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is 384.
14022
14023 @item mail-source-movemail-program
14024 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
14025 If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
14026 @code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
14027
14028 @end table
14029
14030
14031 @node Fetching Mail
14032 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
14033
14034 @vindex mail-sources
14035 @vindex nnmail-spool-file
14036 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
14037 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
14038 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
14039
14040 If this variable (and the obsolescent @code{nnmail-spool-file}) is
14041 @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to fetch mail by
14042 themselves.
14043
14044 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
14045 @acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
14046
14047 @lisp
14048 (setq mail-sources
14049 '((file)
14050 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
14051 :password "secret")))
14052 @end lisp
14053
14054 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
14055
14056 @lisp
14057 (setq mail-sources
14058 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
14059 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
14060 :user "user-name"
14061 :port "pop3"
14062 :password "secret")))
14063 @end lisp
14064
14065
14066 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
14067 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
14068 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
14069 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
14070 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
14071 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
14072
14073
14074
14075 @node Mail Back End Variables
14076 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
14077
14078 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
14079 mail back ends.
14080
14081 @table @code
14082 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
14083 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
14084 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
14085 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
14086
14087 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
14088 @item nnmail-split-hook
14089 @findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
14090 @cindex RFC 1522 decoding
14091 @cindex RFC 2047 decoding
14092 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
14093 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
14094 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
14095 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
14096 in the buffer will show up in any files.
14097 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
14098 to this hook.
14099
14100 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
14101 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
14102 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
14103 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
14104 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
14105 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
14106 starting to handle the new mail) and
14107 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
14108 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
14109 default file modes the new mail files get:
14110
14111 @lisp
14112 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
14113 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 511)))
14114
14115 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
14116 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 551)))
14117 @end lisp
14118
14119 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
14120 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
14121 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
14122 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
14123 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
14124 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
14125 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
14126
14127 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
14128 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
14129 @findex delete-file
14130 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
14131
14132 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14133 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14134 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
14135 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
14136 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
14137
14138 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
14139 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
14140 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
14141 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
14142 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
14143
14144 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
14145 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
14146 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
14147
14148 @end table
14149
14150
14151 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
14152 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
14153 @cindex mail splitting
14154 @cindex fancy mail splitting
14155
14156 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
14157 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
14158 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
14159 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
14160 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
14161 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
14162
14163 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
14164
14165 @lisp
14166 ;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
14167 ;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
14168 ;; @r{from real errors.}
14169 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
14170 "mail.misc"))
14171 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
14172 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
14173 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
14174 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
14175 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
14176 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
14177 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
14178 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
14179 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
14180 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
14181 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
14182 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
14183 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
14184 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
14185 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
14186 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
14187 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
14188 "misc.misc")
14189 @end lisp
14190
14191 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
14192 (possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
14193 splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
14194
14195 @table @code
14196
14197 @item group
14198 If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
14199 regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
14200
14201 @c Don't fold this line.
14202 @item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split} [@var{invert-partial}])
14203 The split can be a list containing at least three elements. If the
14204 first element @var{field} (a regexp matching a header) contains
14205 @var{value} (also a regexp) then store the message as specified by
14206 @var{split}.
14207
14208 If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp) matches some string after
14209 @var{field} and before the end of the matched @var{value}, the
14210 @var{split} is ignored. If none of the @var{restrict} clauses match,
14211 @var{split} is processed.
14212
14213 The last element @var{invert-partial} is optional. If it is
14214 non-@code{nil}, the match-partial-words behavior controlled by the
14215 variable @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} (see below) is
14216 be inverted. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
14217
14218 @item (| @var{split} @dots{})
14219 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
14220 bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
14221 @var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
14222 stored in one or more groups.
14223
14224 @item (& @var{split} @dots{})
14225 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
14226 process all @var{split}s in the list.
14227
14228 @item junk
14229 If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
14230 this message. Use with extreme caution.
14231
14232 @item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
14233 If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
14234 second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
14235 arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
14236
14237 @cindex body split
14238 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
14239 body of the messages:
14240
14241 @lisp
14242 (defun split-on-body ()
14243 (save-excursion
14244 (save-restriction
14245 (widen)
14246 (goto-char (point-min))
14247 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
14248 "string.group"))))
14249 @end lisp
14250
14251 The buffer is narrowed to the message in question when @var{function}
14252 is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called after
14253 @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
14254 above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
14255 not be downloaded by default. You need to set
14256 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
14257 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
14258
14259 @item (! @var{func} @var{split})
14260 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
14261 @var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
14262 function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
14263 should return a split.
14264
14265 @item nil
14266 If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
14267
14268 @end table
14269
14270 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
14271
14272 Normally, @var{value} in these splits must match a complete @emph{word}
14273 according to the fundamental mode syntax table. In other words, all
14274 @var{value}'s will be implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers,
14275 which are word delimiters. Therefore, if you use the following split,
14276 for example,
14277
14278 @example
14279 (any "joe" "joemail")
14280 @end example
14281
14282 @noindent
14283 messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will normally not be filed
14284 in @samp{joemail}. If you want to alter this behavior, you can use any
14285 of the following three ways:
14286
14287 @enumerate
14288 @item
14289 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
14290 You can set the @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} variable
14291 to non-@code{nil} in order to ignore word boundaries and instead the
14292 match becomes more like a grep. This variable controls whether partial
14293 words are matched during fancy splitting. The default value is
14294 @code{nil}.
14295
14296 Note that it influences all @var{value}'s in your split rules.
14297
14298 @item
14299 @var{value} beginning with @code{.*} ignores word boundaries in front of
14300 a word. Similarly, if @var{value} ends with @code{.*}, word boundaries
14301 in the rear of a word will be ignored. For example, the @var{value}
14302 @code{"@@example\\.com"} does not match @samp{foo@@example.com} but
14303 @code{".*@@example\\.com"} does.
14304
14305 @item
14306 You can set the @var{invert-partial} flag in your split rules of the
14307 @samp{(@var{field} @var{value} @dots{})} types, aforementioned in this
14308 section. If the flag is set, word boundaries on both sides of a word
14309 are ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
14310 @code{nil}. Contrarily, if the flag is set, word boundaries are not
14311 ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
14312 non-@code{nil}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
14313 @end enumerate
14314
14315 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
14316 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
14317 they are expanded as specified by the variable
14318 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
14319 where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
14320 contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
14321 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
14322
14323 @table @code
14324 @item from
14325 Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
14326 @item to
14327 Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
14328 @samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
14329 @item any
14330 Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
14331 @end table
14332
14333 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
14334 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
14335 when all this splitting is performed.
14336
14337 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
14338 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
14339 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
14340
14341 @example
14342 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
14343 @end example
14344
14345 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
14346 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
14347
14348 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
14349 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
14350 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
14351 groupings 1 through 9.
14352
14353 @vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
14354 Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
14355 lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
14356 Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
14357 groups when users send to an address using different case
14358 (i.e. mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
14359 is @code{t}.
14360
14361 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
14362 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
14363 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
14364 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
14365 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
14366 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
14367 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
14368 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
14369 it once per thread.
14370
14371 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
14372 and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
14373 value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
14374 using the colon feature, like so:
14375 @lisp
14376 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
14377 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
14378 nnmail-split-fancy
14379 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
14380 ;; @r{other splits go here}
14381 ))
14382 @end lisp
14383
14384 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
14385 non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
14386 in the file specified by the variable
14387 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
14388 (the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
14389 invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
14390 at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
14391 and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
14392 for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
14393 corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
14394 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
14395 recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
14396 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
14397 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
14398 300 kBytes in size.)
14399 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14400 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
14401 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
14402 messages goes into the new group.
14403
14404 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
14405 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
14406 outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
14407 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
14408 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
14409 ``outgoing'' group.
14410
14411
14412 @node Group Mail Splitting
14413 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
14414 @cindex mail splitting
14415 @cindex group mail splitting
14416
14417 @findex gnus-group-split
14418 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
14419 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
14420 You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
14421 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
14422 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
14423 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
14424 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
14425 @code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
14426
14427 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
14428 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
14429 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
14430 rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
14431
14432 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
14433 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
14434 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
14435 @code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
14436 matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
14437 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
14438 @code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
14439
14440 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
14441 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
14442 parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
14443 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
14444 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
14445 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
14446 @code{gnus-group-split}.
14447
14448 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
14449 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
14450 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
14451 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
14452 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
14453 some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
14454 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
14455 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
14456 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
14457 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
14458 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
14459 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
14460 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
14461
14462 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
14463 been defined:
14464
14465 @example
14466 nnml:mail.bar:
14467 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
14468 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
14469 nnml:mail.foo:
14470 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
14471 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
14472 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
14473 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
14474 nnml:mail.others:
14475 ((split-spec . catch-all))
14476 @end example
14477
14478 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
14479 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
14480 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
14481
14482 @lisp
14483 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
14484 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
14485 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
14486 "mail.others")
14487 @end lisp
14488
14489 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
14490 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
14491 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
14492 splits like this:
14493
14494 @lisp
14495 (: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
14496 @end lisp
14497
14498 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
14499 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
14500 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
14501 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
14502 fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
14503 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
14504 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
14505 Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
14506 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
14507
14508 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
14509 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
14510 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
14511 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
14512 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
14513 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
14514 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
14515 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
14516 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
14517
14518 @findex gnus-group-split-update
14519 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
14520 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
14521 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
14522 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
14523 you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
14524
14525 @lisp
14526 (gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
14527 @end lisp
14528
14529 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
14530 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
14531 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
14532 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
14533 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
14534 value.
14535
14536 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
14537 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
14538 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
14539 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
14540
14541 @node Incorporating Old Mail
14542 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
14543 @cindex incorporating old mail
14544 @cindex import old mail
14545
14546 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
14547 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
14548 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
14549 your mail groups.
14550
14551 Doing so can be quite easy.
14552
14553 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
14554 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
14555 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
14556 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
14557 your @code{nnml} groups.
14558
14559 Here's how:
14560
14561 @enumerate
14562 @item
14563 Go to the group buffer.
14564
14565 @item
14566 Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
14567 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
14568
14569 @item
14570 Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
14571
14572 @item
14573 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
14574 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
14575
14576 @item
14577 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
14578 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
14579 @end enumerate
14580
14581 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
14582 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
14583 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
14584 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
14585 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
14586
14587 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
14588 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
14589 using the new mail back end.
14590
14591
14592 @node Expiring Mail
14593 @subsection Expiring Mail
14594 @cindex article expiry
14595 @cindex expiring mail
14596
14597 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
14598 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
14599 different approach to mail reading.
14600
14601 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
14602 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
14603 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
14604 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
14605 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
14606 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
14607 course.
14608
14609 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
14610 articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
14611 that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
14612 will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
14613 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
14614 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
14615 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
14616 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
14617 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
14618
14619 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
14620 two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
14621 with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
14622 for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
14623 considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
14624 the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
14625 @samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} and so on are considered
14626 expirable.
14627
14628 When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
14629 who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
14630 and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
14631 (@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
14632 into its own group.)
14633
14634 Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
14635 answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
14636 advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
14637 the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
14638 between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
14639 only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
14640 total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
14641 Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
14642 scoring.
14643
14644 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14645 Groups that match the regular expression
14646 @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
14647 read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
14648 expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
14649
14650 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
14651 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
14652 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
14653 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
14654 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14655
14656 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
14657 @lisp
14658 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
14659 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
14660 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
14661 @end lisp
14662
14663 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
14664 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
14665 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
14666 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
14667 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
14668
14669 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
14670 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
14671
14672 @lisp
14673 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14674 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
14675 @end lisp
14676
14677 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
14678 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
14679
14680 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
14681 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
14682 don't really mix very well.
14683
14684 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
14685 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
14686 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
14687 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
14688 days.
14689
14690 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
14691 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
14692 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
14693 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
14694 everywhere else:
14695
14696 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14697 @lisp
14698 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14699 (lambda (group)
14700 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
14701 31)
14702 ((string= group "mail.junk")
14703 1)
14704 ((string= group "important")
14705 'never)
14706 (t
14707 6))))
14708 @end lisp
14709
14710 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
14711 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
14712
14713 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
14714 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
14715 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
14716 @code{never}.
14717
14718 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
14719 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
14720
14721 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
14722 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
14723 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
14724 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
14725 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
14726 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
14727 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
14728 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
14729 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
14730 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
14731 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
14732 from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
14733 name or @code{delete}.
14734
14735 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
14736 @lisp
14737 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
14738 @end lisp
14739
14740 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14741 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14742 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
14743 expire mail to groups according to the variable
14744 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
14745
14746 @lisp
14747 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14748 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14749 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
14750 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
14751 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
14752 @end lisp
14753
14754 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
14755 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
14756 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
14757 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
14758 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
14759 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
14760
14761 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
14762 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
14763 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
14764 easier for procmail users.
14765
14766 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
14767 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
14768 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
14769 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
14770 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
14771 caution. Even more dangerous is the
14772 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
14773 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
14774 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
14775 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
14776 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
14777 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
14778 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
14779 with! So there!
14780
14781 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
14782
14783 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
14784 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
14785 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
14786 auto-expire turned on.
14787
14788
14789 @node Washing Mail
14790 @subsection Washing Mail
14791 @cindex mail washing
14792 @cindex list server brain damage
14793 @cindex incoming mail treatment
14794
14795 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
14796 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
14797 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
14798 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
14799 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
14800 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
14801
14802 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
14803 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
14804 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
14805 laugh.
14806
14807 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
14808 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
14809 storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
14810 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
14811
14812 @table @code
14813 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14814 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14815 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
14816 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
14817 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
14818
14819 @table @code
14820 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14821 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14822 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
14823 Emacs running on MS machines.
14824
14825 @end table
14826
14827 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14828 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14829 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
14830 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
14831
14832 @table @code
14833 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14834 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14835 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
14836 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
14837
14838 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
14839 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
14840 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
14841 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
14842 into a feature by documenting it.)
14843
14844 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14845 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14846 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
14847 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
14848 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
14849 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
14850 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
14851 @code{\\(..\\)}.
14852
14853 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
14854 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
14855
14856 @lisp
14857 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
14858 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
14859 @end lisp
14860
14861 This can also be done non-destructively with
14862 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
14863
14864 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
14865 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
14866 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
14867
14868 @item nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14869 @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14870 @cindex Eudora
14871 Eudora produces broken @code{References} headers, but OK
14872 @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This function will get rid of the
14873 @code{References} headers.
14874
14875 @end table
14876
14877 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14878 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14879 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
14880 include:
14881
14882 @table @code
14883 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
14884 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
14885 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
14886
14887 @end table
14888 @end table
14889
14890
14891 @node Duplicates
14892 @subsection Duplicates
14893
14894 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
14895 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
14896 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
14897 @cindex duplicate mails
14898 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
14899 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
14900 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
14901 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
14902 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
14903 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
14904 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
14905 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
14906 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
14907 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
14908 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
14909 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
14910 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
14911
14912 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
14913 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
14914 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
14915 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
14916
14917 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
14918 @code{nil}.
14919
14920 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
14921 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
14922 methods:
14923
14924 @lisp
14925 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
14926 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
14927 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
14928 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
14929 (any mail "mail.misc")
14930 ;; @r{Other rules.}
14931 [...] ))
14932 @end lisp
14933 @noindent
14934 Or something like:
14935 @lisp
14936 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14937 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
14938 ;; @r{Other rules.}
14939 [...]))
14940 @end lisp
14941
14942 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
14943 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
14944 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
14945 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
14946 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
14947
14948
14949 @node Not Reading Mail
14950 @subsection Not Reading Mail
14951
14952 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
14953 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
14954 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
14955
14956 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
14957 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
14958 mail, which should help.
14959
14960 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14961 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
14962 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
14963 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
14964 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
14965 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
14966 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old Rmail
14967 file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
14968 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
14969 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
14970 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
14971
14972 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
14973 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
14974 incoming mail.
14975
14976
14977 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
14978 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
14979
14980 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
14981 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
14982 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
14983
14984 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
14985 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
14986 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
14987 Spool}).
14988
14989 @menu
14990 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
14991 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
14992 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
14993 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
14994 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
14995 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
14996 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
14997 @end menu
14998
14999
15000 @node Unix Mail Box
15001 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
15002 @cindex nnmbox
15003 @cindex unix mail box
15004
15005 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
15006 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
15007 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
15008 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
15009 which group it belongs in.
15010
15011 Virtual server settings:
15012
15013 @table @code
15014 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
15015 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
15016 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
15017 @file{~/mbox}.
15018
15019 @item nnmbox-active-file
15020 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
15021 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
15022 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
15023
15024 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
15025 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
15026 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
15027 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
15028 @end table
15029
15030
15031 @node Rmail Babyl
15032 @subsubsection Rmail Babyl
15033 @cindex nnbabyl
15034 @cindex Rmail mbox
15035
15036 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
15037 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
15038 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box (aka. @dfn{Rmail
15039 mbox}) to store mail. @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each
15040 mail article to say which group it belongs in.
15041
15042 Virtual server settings:
15043
15044 @table @code
15045 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
15046 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
15047 The name of the Rmail mbox file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
15048
15049 @item nnbabyl-active-file
15050 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
15051 The name of the active file for the rmail box. The default is
15052 @file{~/.rmail-active}
15053
15054 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
15055 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
15056 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
15057 @code{t}
15058 @end table
15059
15060
15061 @node Mail Spool
15062 @subsubsection Mail Spool
15063 @cindex nnml
15064 @cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
15065
15066 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
15067 format. It should be used with some caution.
15068
15069 @vindex nnml-directory
15070 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
15071 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
15072 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
15073 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
15074
15075 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
15076 care of all that.
15077
15078 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
15079 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
15080 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
15081 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
15082 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
15083 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
15084 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
15085 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
15086
15087 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
15088 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
15089 @acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
15090 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
15091
15092 @cindex self contained nnml servers
15093 @cindex marks
15094 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnml}
15095 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
15096 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
15097 proper @code{nnml} server) and have all your marks be preserved. Marks
15098 for a group is usually stored in the @code{.marks} file (but see
15099 @code{nnml-marks-file-name}) within each @code{nnml} group's directory.
15100 Individual @code{nnml} groups are also possible to backup, use @kbd{G m}
15101 to restore the group (after restoring the backup into the nnml
15102 directory).
15103
15104 If for some reason you believe your @file{.marks} files are screwed
15105 up, you can just delete them all. Gnus will then correctly regenerate
15106 them next time it starts.
15107
15108 Virtual server settings:
15109
15110 @table @code
15111 @item nnml-directory
15112 @vindex nnml-directory
15113 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
15114 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
15115 is @file{~/Mail}).
15116
15117 @item nnml-active-file
15118 @vindex nnml-active-file
15119 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
15120 @file{~/Mail/active}.
15121
15122 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
15123 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
15124 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
15125 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
15126
15127 @item nnml-get-new-mail
15128 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
15129 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
15130 @code{t}.
15131
15132 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
15133 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
15134 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
15135 default is @code{nil}.
15136
15137 @item nnml-nov-file-name
15138 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
15139 The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
15140
15141 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
15142 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
15143 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
15144
15145 @item nnml-marks-is-evil
15146 @vindex nnml-marks-is-evil
15147 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
15148 default is @code{nil}.
15149
15150 @item nnml-marks-file-name
15151 @vindex nnml-marks-file-name
15152 The name of the @dfn{marks} files. The default is @file{.marks}.
15153
15154 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
15155 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
15156 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
15157 files.
15158
15159 @end table
15160
15161 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
15162 If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
15163 whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
15164 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
15165 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
15166 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
15167 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
15168 Commands}).
15169
15170
15171 @node MH Spool
15172 @subsubsection MH Spool
15173 @cindex nnmh
15174 @cindex mh-e mail spool
15175
15176 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
15177 @acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
15178 file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
15179 @code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
15180 for.
15181
15182 Virtual server settings:
15183
15184 @table @code
15185 @item nnmh-directory
15186 @vindex nnmh-directory
15187 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
15188 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
15189 @file{~/Mail})
15190
15191 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
15192 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
15193 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
15194 @code{t}.
15195
15196 @item nnmh-be-safe
15197 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
15198 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
15199 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
15200 they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
15201 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
15202 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
15203 have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
15204 @end table
15205
15206
15207 @node Maildir
15208 @subsubsection Maildir
15209 @cindex nnmaildir
15210 @cindex maildir
15211
15212 @code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
15213 corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
15214 @uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
15215 @uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
15216 also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
15217 within a maildir.
15218
15219 Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
15220 reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
15221 your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
15222 configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
15223 can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
15224 configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
15225 that appear as group in Gnus.
15226
15227 @code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
15228 never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
15229 corrupt its data in the filesystem.
15230
15231 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
15232 maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
15233 another, and you will keep your marks.
15234
15235 Virtual server settings:
15236
15237 @table @code
15238 @item directory
15239 For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
15240 you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
15241 it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
15242 choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
15243 will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
15244 filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
15245 in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
15246 scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
15247 the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
15248 @code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
15249
15250 The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
15251 which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
15252 the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
15253 only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
15254 server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
15255 don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
15256 optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
15257 @code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
15258 use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
15259 if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
15260 value.
15261
15262 @item target-prefix
15263 This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
15264 @code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
15265 server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
15266 closed.
15267
15268 When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
15269 created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
15270 pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
15271 So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
15272 @code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
15273 the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
15274 @file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
15275 @file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
15276 @file{../maildirs/foo}.
15277
15278 You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
15279 create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
15280 this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
15281 with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
15282 symlinks pointing to them will be).
15283
15284 As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
15285 then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
15286 @code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
15287 cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
15288 @code{force} argument.
15289
15290 @item directory-files
15291 This should be a function with the same interface as
15292 @code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
15293 used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
15294 parameter is optional; the default is
15295 @code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
15296 @code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
15297 @code{directory-files} otherwise.
15298 (@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
15299 server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
15300 scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
15301
15302 @item get-new-mail
15303 If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
15304 maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
15305 the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
15306 @code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
15307 value is @code{nil}.
15308
15309 Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
15310 an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
15311 that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
15312 different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
15313 remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
15314 @end table
15315
15316 @subsubsection Group parameters
15317
15318 @code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
15319 all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
15320 default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
15321 one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
15322 functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
15323 you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
15324 another back end.
15325
15326 If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
15327 is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
15328 original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
15329 evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
15330 different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
15331 back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
15332 numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
15333 @code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
15334 quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
15335
15336 @table @code
15337 @item expire-age
15338 An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
15339 before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
15340 articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
15341 @code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
15342 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
15343 @code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
15344 and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
15345 wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
15346 60 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
15347 An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
15348 modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
15349 delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
15350 article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
15351
15352 @item expire-group
15353 If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
15354 @example
15355 "backend+server.address.string:group.name"
15356 @end example
15357 and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
15358 to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
15359 before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
15360 group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
15361 was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
15362 destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
15363 the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
15364 you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
15365 article. So that form can refer to
15366 @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
15367 article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
15368 does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
15369 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
15370
15371 @item read-only
15372 If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
15373 in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
15374 from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
15375 @file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
15376 cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
15377 @file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
15378 containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
15379 maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
15380 a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
15381 have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
15382 contain extra copies of the articles.
15383
15384 @item directory-files
15385 A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
15386 used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
15387 group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
15388 server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
15389
15390 @item distrust-Lines:
15391 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
15392 article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
15393 @code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
15394
15395 @item always-marks
15396 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
15397 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15398 say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
15399 marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
15400 feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
15401 in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15402
15403 @item never-marks
15404 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
15405 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15406 say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
15407 stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
15408 @code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
15409 probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
15410 abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15411
15412 @item nov-cache-size
15413 An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
15414 speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
15415 for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
15416 worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
15417 parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
15418 the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
15419 The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
15420 and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
15421 that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
15422 that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
15423 @code{read}, plus a little extra.
15424 @end table
15425
15426 @subsubsection Article identification
15427 Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
15428 Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
15429 contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
15430 @code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
15431 the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
15432 identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
15433 @file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
15434 about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
15435 available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
15436 request the article in the summary buffer.
15437
15438 @subsubsection NOV data
15439 An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
15440 to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
15441 @code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
15442 @code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
15443 need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
15444 when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
15445 force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
15446 single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
15447 file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
15448 assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
15449 with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
15450
15451 @subsubsection Article marks
15452 An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
15453 @code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
15454 When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15455 looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
15456 asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15457 creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
15458 rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
15459 links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
15460
15461 You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
15462 @file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
15463 your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
15464 remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
15465 this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
15466 it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
15467 type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
15468 @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
15469 pick up the changes, and might undo them.
15470
15471
15472 @node Mail Folders
15473 @subsubsection Mail Folders
15474 @cindex nnfolder
15475 @cindex mbox folders
15476 @cindex mail folders
15477
15478 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
15479 separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
15480 @code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
15481 numbers and arrival dates.
15482
15483 @cindex self contained nnfolder servers
15484 @cindex marks
15485 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnfolder}
15486 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
15487 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
15488 proper @code{nnfolder} server) and have all your marks be preserved.
15489 Marks for a group are usually stored in a file named as the mbox file
15490 with @code{.mrk} concatenated to it (but see
15491 @code{nnfolder-marks-file-suffix}) within the @code{nnfolder}
15492 directory. Individual @code{nnfolder} groups are also possible to
15493 backup, use @kbd{G m} to restore the group (after restoring the backup
15494 into the @code{nnfolder} directory).
15495
15496 Virtual server settings:
15497
15498 @table @code
15499 @item nnfolder-directory
15500 @vindex nnfolder-directory
15501 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
15502 directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
15503 (whose default is @file{~/Mail})
15504
15505 @item nnfolder-active-file
15506 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
15507 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
15508
15509 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15510 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15511 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
15512 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
15513
15514 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
15515 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
15516 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
15517 default is @code{t}
15518
15519 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15520 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15521 @cindex backup files
15522 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
15523 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
15524 you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
15525 following in your @file{.emacs} file:
15526
15527 @lisp
15528 (defun turn-off-backup ()
15529 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
15530
15531 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
15532 @end lisp
15533
15534 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15535 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15536 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
15537 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
15538 extract some information from it before removing it.
15539
15540 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15541 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15542 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
15543 default is @code{nil}.
15544
15545 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15546 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15547 The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
15548
15549 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
15550 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
15551 The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
15552 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15553
15554 @item nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15555 @vindex nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15556 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
15557 default is @code{nil}.
15558
15559 @item nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15560 @vindex nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15561 The extension for @sc{marks} files. The default is @file{.mrk}.
15562
15563 @item nnfolder-marks-directory
15564 @vindex nnfolder-marks-directory
15565 The directory where the @sc{marks} files should be stored. If
15566 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15567
15568 @end table
15569
15570
15571 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
15572 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
15573 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
15574 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
15575 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
15576 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
15577 though.
15578
15579 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
15580 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
15581
15582 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
15583 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
15584 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
15585 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
15586 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
15587
15588 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
15589 typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
15590 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
15591 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
15592 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
15593 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
15594 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
15595 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
15596 via NFS).
15597
15598 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
15599 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
15600 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
15601 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
15602
15603 @table @code
15604 @item nnmbox
15605
15606 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-
15607 defined format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
15608 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
15609 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
15610 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
15611 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
15612 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
15613 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
15614 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
15615 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
15616 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
15617 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
15618 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
15619 what's where.
15620
15621 @item nnbabyl
15622
15623 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
15624 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
15625 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
15626 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
15627 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
15628 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
15629 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
15630 Rmail was Emacs' first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
15631 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
15632 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
15633 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
15634 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
15635 headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
15636 course, and is still maintained by Stallman.
15637
15638 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
15639 file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
15640 look at your mail.
15641
15642 @item nnml
15643
15644 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
15645 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
15646 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
15647 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
15648 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
15649 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
15650 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
15651 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
15652 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
15653 @acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
15654 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
15655 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
15656 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
15657 provided by the active file and overviews.
15658
15659 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
15660 resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
15661 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
15662 tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
15663 the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
15664 wins big.
15665
15666 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
15667 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
15668 tiny files.
15669
15670 @item nnmh
15671
15672 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
15673 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
15674 individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
15675 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
15676 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
15677 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
15678 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
15679
15680 @item nnfolder
15681
15682 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
15683 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
15684 itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
15685 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
15686 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
15687 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
15688 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
15689 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
15690 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
15691
15692 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
15693 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
15694 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
15695 friendly mail back end all over.
15696
15697 @item nnmaildir
15698
15699 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
15700 incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
15701 mail back ends.
15702
15703 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
15704 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
15705 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
15706 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
15707 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}. (Use
15708 @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this slows
15709 you down or takes up very much space, consider switching to
15710 @uref{http://www.namesys.com/, ReiserFS} or another non-block-structured
15711 file system.
15712
15713 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
15714 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
15715 This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
15716 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
15717 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
15718 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
15719 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
15720 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
15721 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
15722 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
15723 undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
15724
15725 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
15726 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
15727 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
15728 else, and still have your marks. @code{nnml} also stores marks, but
15729 it's not as easy to work with them from outside Gnus as with
15730 @code{nnmaildir}.
15731
15732 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
15733 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
15734 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
15735 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
15736 parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
15737 would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
15738 removed in the future.
15739
15740 Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
15741 back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
15742 on your file system.
15743
15744 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
15745 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
15746
15747 @end table
15748
15749
15750 @node Browsing the Web
15751 @section Browsing the Web
15752 @cindex web
15753 @cindex browsing the web
15754 @cindex www
15755 @cindex http
15756
15757 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
15758 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
15759 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
15760 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
15761 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
15762 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
15763 even know what a news group is.
15764
15765 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
15766 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
15767 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
15768 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
15769 you mad in the end.
15770
15771 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
15772 to do it instead?
15773
15774 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
15775 interfaces to these sources.
15776
15777 @menu
15778 * Archiving Mail::
15779 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
15780 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
15781 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
15782 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
15783 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
15784 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
15785 @end menu
15786
15787 All the web sources require Emacs/W3 and the url library or those
15788 alternatives to work.
15789
15790 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
15791 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
15792 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
15793 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
15794 though, you should be ok.
15795
15796 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
15797 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
15798 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
15799 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
15800 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
15801
15802 @node Archiving Mail
15803 @subsection Archiving Mail
15804 @cindex archiving mail
15805 @cindex backup of mail
15806
15807 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
15808 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
15809 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
15810 marks is fairly simple.
15811
15812 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
15813 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
15814 though.)
15815
15816 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
15817 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
15818 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
15819 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
15820 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
15821 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
15822 might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
15823 before you restore the data.
15824
15825 It is also possible to archive individual @code{nnml},
15826 @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir} groups, while preserving marks.
15827 For @code{nnml} or @code{nnmaildir}, you copy all files in the group's
15828 directory. For @code{nnfolder} you need to copy both the base folder
15829 file itself (@file{FOO}, say), and the marks file (@file{FOO.mrk} in
15830 this example). Restoring the group is done with @kbd{G m} from the Group
15831 buffer. The last step makes Gnus notice the new directory.
15832 @code{nnmaildir} notices the new directory automatically, so @kbd{G m}
15833 is unnecessary in that case.
15834
15835 @node Web Searches
15836 @subsection Web Searches
15837 @cindex nnweb
15838 @cindex Google
15839 @cindex dejanews
15840 @cindex gmane
15841 @cindex Usenet searches
15842 @cindex searching the Usenet
15843
15844 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
15845 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
15846 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
15847 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
15848 searches without having to use a browser.
15849
15850 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
15851 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
15852 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
15853 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
15854 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
15855
15856 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
15857 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
15858 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
15859 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
15860 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
15861 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
15862 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
15863 engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
15864 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
15865 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
15866 group as read.
15867
15868 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
15869 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
15870 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'être} is to
15871 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
15872 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
15873 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
15874
15875 You must have the @code{url} and @code{W3} package or those alternatives
15876 (try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{mm-url} variable group)
15877 installed to be able to use @code{nnweb}.
15878
15879 Virtual server variables:
15880
15881 @table @code
15882 @item nnweb-type
15883 @vindex nnweb-type
15884 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
15885 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
15886 @code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
15887
15888 @item nnweb-search
15889 @vindex nnweb-search
15890 The search string to feed to the search engine.
15891
15892 @item nnweb-max-hits
15893 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
15894 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
15895 999.
15896
15897 @item nnweb-type-definition
15898 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
15899 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
15900 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
15901 present:
15902
15903 @table @code
15904 @item article
15905 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
15906 understands.
15907
15908 @item map
15909 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
15910
15911 @item search
15912 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
15913
15914 @item address
15915 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
15916 to.
15917
15918 @item id
15919 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
15920 @end table
15921
15922 @end table
15923
15924
15925 @node Slashdot
15926 @subsection Slashdot
15927 @cindex Slashdot
15928 @cindex nnslashdot
15929
15930 @uref{http://slashdot.org/, Slashdot} is a popular news site, with
15931 lively discussion following the news articles. @code{nnslashdot} will
15932 let you read this forum in a convenient manner.
15933
15934 The easiest way to read this source is to put something like the
15935 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
15936
15937 @lisp
15938 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
15939 '((nnslashdot "")))
15940 @end lisp
15941
15942 This will make Gnus query the @code{nnslashdot} back end for new comments
15943 and groups. The @kbd{F} command will subscribe each new news article as
15944 a new Gnus group, and you can read the comments by entering these
15945 groups. (Note that the default subscription method is to subscribe new
15946 groups as zombies. Other methods are available (@pxref{Subscription
15947 Methods}).
15948
15949 If you want to remove an old @code{nnslashdot} group, the @kbd{G DEL}
15950 command is the most handy tool (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
15951
15952 When following up to @code{nnslashdot} comments (or posting new
15953 comments), some light @acronym{HTML}izations will be performed. In
15954 particular, text quoted with @samp{> } will be quoted with
15955 @samp{blockquote} instead, and signatures will have @samp{br} added to
15956 the end of each line. Other than that, you can just write @acronym{HTML}
15957 directly into the message buffer. Note that Slashdot filters out some
15958 @acronym{HTML} forms.
15959
15960 The following variables can be altered to change its behavior:
15961
15962 @table @code
15963 @item nnslashdot-threaded
15964 Whether @code{nnslashdot} should display threaded groups or not. The
15965 default is @code{t}. To be able to display threads, @code{nnslashdot}
15966 has to retrieve absolutely all comments in a group upon entry. If a
15967 threaded display is not required, @code{nnslashdot} will only retrieve
15968 the comments that are actually wanted by the user. Threading is nicer,
15969 but much, much slower than unthreaded.
15970
15971 @item nnslashdot-login-name
15972 @vindex nnslashdot-login-name
15973 The login name to use when posting.
15974
15975 @item nnslashdot-password
15976 @vindex nnslashdot-password
15977 The password to use when posting.
15978
15979 @item nnslashdot-directory
15980 @vindex nnslashdot-directory
15981 Where @code{nnslashdot} will store its files. The default is
15982 @file{~/News/slashdot/}.
15983
15984 @item nnslashdot-active-url
15985 @vindex nnslashdot-active-url
15986 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the
15987 information on news articles and comments. The default is@*
15988 @samp{http://slashdot.org/search.pl?section=&min=%d}.
15989
15990 @item nnslashdot-comments-url
15991 @vindex nnslashdot-comments-url
15992 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch comments.
15993
15994 @item nnslashdot-article-url
15995 @vindex nnslashdot-article-url
15996 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the news
15997 article. The default is
15998 @samp{http://slashdot.org/article.pl?sid=%s&mode=nocomment}.
15999
16000 @item nnslashdot-threshold
16001 @vindex nnslashdot-threshold
16002 The score threshold. The default is -1.
16003
16004 @item nnslashdot-group-number
16005 @vindex nnslashdot-group-number
16006 The number of old groups, in addition to the ten latest, to keep
16007 updated. The default is 0.
16008
16009 @end table
16010
16011
16012
16013 @node Ultimate
16014 @subsection Ultimate
16015 @cindex nnultimate
16016 @cindex Ultimate Bulletin Board
16017
16018 @uref{http://www.ultimatebb.com/, The Ultimate Bulletin Board} is
16019 probably the most popular Web bulletin board system used. It has a
16020 quite regular and nice interface, and it's possible to get the
16021 information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
16022
16023 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnultimate} is to say
16024 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnultimate RET
16025 http://www.tcj.com/messboard/ubbcgi/ RET}. (Substitute the @acronym{URL}
16026 (not including @samp{Ultimate.cgi} or the like at the end) for a forum
16027 you're interested in; there's quite a list of them on the Ultimate web
16028 site.) Then subscribe to the groups you're interested in from the
16029 server buffer, and read them from the group buffer.
16030
16031 The following @code{nnultimate} variables can be altered:
16032
16033 @table @code
16034 @item nnultimate-directory
16035 @vindex nnultimate-directory
16036 The directory where @code{nnultimate} stores its files. The default is@*
16037 @file{~/News/ultimate/}.
16038 @end table
16039
16040
16041 @node Web Archive
16042 @subsection Web Archive
16043 @cindex nnwarchive
16044 @cindex Web Archive
16045
16046 Some mailing lists only have archives on Web servers, such as
16047 @uref{http://www.egroups.com/} and
16048 @uref{http://www.mail-archive.com/}. It has a quite regular and nice
16049 interface, and it's possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep
16050 groups updated.
16051
16052 @findex gnus-group-make-warchive-group
16053 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnwarchive} is to say
16054 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{M-x
16055 gnus-group-make-warchive-group RET @var{an_egroup} RET egroups RET
16056 www.egroups.com RET @var{your@@email.address} RET}. (Substitute the
16057 @var{an_egroup} with the mailing list you subscribed, the
16058 @var{your@@email.address} with your email address.), or to browse the
16059 back end by @kbd{B nnwarchive RET mail-archive RET}.
16060
16061 The following @code{nnwarchive} variables can be altered:
16062
16063 @table @code
16064 @item nnwarchive-directory
16065 @vindex nnwarchive-directory
16066 The directory where @code{nnwarchive} stores its files. The default is@*
16067 @file{~/News/warchive/}.
16068
16069 @item nnwarchive-login
16070 @vindex nnwarchive-login
16071 The account name on the web server.
16072
16073 @item nnwarchive-passwd
16074 @vindex nnwarchive-passwd
16075 The password for your account on the web server.
16076 @end table
16077
16078 @node RSS
16079 @subsection RSS
16080 @cindex nnrss
16081 @cindex RSS
16082
16083 Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
16084 @acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
16085 sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
16086 presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
16087 changes to a wiki (e.g. @url{http://cliki.net/recent-changes.rdf}).
16088
16089 @acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
16090 possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
16091
16092 Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
16093 system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
16094 text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
16095 group names.
16096
16097 @kindex G R (Group)
16098 Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
16099 prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
16100 The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
16101 and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
16102
16103 An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
16104 the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
16105 subscribe to groups.
16106
16107 The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
16108 @code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
16109 names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
16110 coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
16111 variable. If it is @code{nil}, in Emacs the coding system defaults to
16112 the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system}. If you are using
16113 XEmacs and want to use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names, you should set
16114 the value for the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} variable properly.
16115
16116 The @code{nnrss} back end generates @samp{multipart/alternative}
16117 @acronym{MIME} articles in which each contains a @samp{text/plain} part
16118 and a @samp{text/html} part.
16119
16120 @cindex OPML
16121 You can also use the following commands to import and export your
16122 subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
16123 Markup Language).
16124
16125 @defun nnrss-opml-import file
16126 Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
16127 file.
16128 @end defun
16129
16130 @defun nnrss-opml-export
16131 Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
16132 @acronym{OPML} format.
16133 @end defun
16134
16135 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
16136
16137 @table @code
16138 @item nnrss-directory
16139 @vindex nnrss-directory
16140 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
16141 @file{~/News/rss/}.
16142
16143 @item nnrss-file-coding-system
16144 @vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
16145 The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
16146 data files. The default is the value of
16147 @code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
16148 in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
16149
16150 @item nnrss-use-local
16151 @vindex nnrss-use-local
16152 @findex nnrss-generate-download-script
16153 If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
16154 the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
16155 the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
16156 download script using @command{wget}.
16157
16158 @item nnrss-wash-html-in-text-plain-parts
16159 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{nnrss} renders text in @samp{text/plain}
16160 parts as @acronym{HTML}. The function specified by the
16161 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} variable (@pxref{Display Customization,
16162 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) will be used
16163 to render text. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default, text will
16164 simply be folded. Leave it @code{nil} if you prefer to see
16165 @samp{text/html} parts.
16166 @end table
16167
16168 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
16169 the summary buffer.
16170
16171 @lisp
16172 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
16173 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
16174
16175 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
16176 (let ((descr
16177 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
16178 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
16179 @end lisp
16180
16181 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
16182 summary buffer.
16183
16184 @lisp
16185 (require 'browse-url)
16186
16187 (defun browse-nnrss-url( arg )
16188 (interactive "p")
16189 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
16190 (mail-header-extra
16191 (gnus-data-header
16192 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
16193 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
16194 (if url
16195 (progn
16196 (browse-url (cdr url))
16197 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
16198 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
16199
16200 (eval-after-load "gnus"
16201 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
16202 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
16203 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
16204 @end lisp
16205
16206 Even if you have added @code{"text/html"} to the
16207 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} variable (@pxref{Display
16208 Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME
16209 Manual}) since you don't want to see @acronym{HTML} parts, it might be
16210 more useful especially in @code{nnrss} groups to display
16211 @samp{text/html} parts. Here's an example of setting
16212 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} as a group parameter (@pxref{Group
16213 Parameters}) in order to display @samp{text/html} parts only in
16214 @code{nnrss} groups:
16215
16216 @lisp
16217 ;; @r{Set the default value of @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}.}
16218 (eval-after-load "gnus-sum"
16219 '(add-to-list
16220 'gnus-newsgroup-variables
16221 '(mm-discouraged-alternatives
16222 . '("text/html" "image/.*"))))
16223
16224 ;; @r{Display @samp{text/html} parts in @code{nnrss} groups.}
16225 (add-to-list
16226 'gnus-parameters
16227 '("\\`nnrss:" (mm-discouraged-alternatives nil)))
16228 @end lisp
16229
16230
16231 @node Customizing W3
16232 @subsection Customizing W3
16233 @cindex W3
16234 @cindex html
16235 @cindex url
16236 @cindex Netscape
16237
16238 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/W3 (or those
16239 alternatives) to display web pages. Emacs/W3 is documented in its own
16240 manual, but there are some things that may be more relevant for Gnus
16241 users.
16242
16243 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/W3 follow links
16244 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
16245 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
16246
16247 @lisp
16248 (eval-after-load "w3"
16249 '(progn
16250 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
16251 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
16252 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
16253 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
16254 (browse-url url)
16255 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
16256 @end lisp
16257
16258 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in W3-rendered
16259 @acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
16260 follow the link.
16261
16262
16263 @node IMAP
16264 @section IMAP
16265 @cindex nnimap
16266 @cindex @acronym{IMAP}
16267
16268 @acronym{IMAP} is a network protocol for reading mail (or news, or @dots{}),
16269 think of it as a modernized @acronym{NNTP}. Connecting to a @acronym{IMAP}
16270 server is much similar to connecting to a news server, you just
16271 specify the network address of the server.
16272
16273 @acronym{IMAP} has two properties. First, @acronym{IMAP} can do
16274 everything that @acronym{POP} can, it can hence be viewed as a
16275 @acronym{POP++}. Secondly, @acronym{IMAP} is a mail storage protocol,
16276 similar to @acronym{NNTP} being a news storage protocol---however,
16277 @acronym{IMAP} offers more features than @acronym{NNTP} because news
16278 is more or less read-only whereas mail is read-write.
16279
16280 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a @acronym{POP++}, use an imap
16281 entry in @code{mail-sources}. With this, Gnus will fetch mails from
16282 the @acronym{IMAP} server and store them on the local disk. This is
16283 not the usage described in this section---@xref{Mail Sources}.
16284
16285 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a mail storage protocol, use an nnimap
16286 entry in @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}. With this, Gnus will
16287 manipulate mails stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server. This is the kind of
16288 usage explained in this section.
16289
16290 A server configuration in @file{~/.gnus.el} with a few @acronym{IMAP}
16291 servers might look something like the following. (Note that for
16292 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you need external programs and libraries,
16293 see below.)
16294
16295 @lisp
16296 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
16297 '((nnimap "simpleserver") ; @r{no special configuration}
16298 ; @r{perhaps a ssh port forwarded server:}
16299 (nnimap "dolk"
16300 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16301 (nnimap-server-port 1430))
16302 ; @r{a UW server running on localhost}
16303 (nnimap "barbar"
16304 (nnimap-server-port 143)
16305 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16306 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "mail/*")))
16307 ; @r{anonymous public cyrus server:}
16308 (nnimap "cyrus.andrew.cmu.edu"
16309 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous)
16310 (nnimap-list-pattern "archive.*")
16311 (nnimap-stream network))
16312 ; @r{a ssl server on a non-standard port:}
16313 (nnimap "vic20"
16314 (nnimap-address "vic20.somewhere.com")
16315 (nnimap-server-port 9930)
16316 (nnimap-stream ssl))))
16317 @end lisp
16318
16319 After defining the new server, you can subscribe to groups on the
16320 server using normal Gnus commands such as @kbd{U} in the Group Buffer
16321 (@pxref{Subscription Commands}) or via the Server Buffer
16322 (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
16323
16324 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nnimap}
16325 server:
16326
16327 @table @code
16328
16329 @item nnimap-address
16330 @vindex nnimap-address
16331
16332 The address of the remote @acronym{IMAP} server. Defaults to the virtual
16333 server name if not specified.
16334
16335 @item nnimap-server-port
16336 @vindex nnimap-server-port
16337 Port on server to contact. Defaults to port 143, or 993 for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}.
16338
16339 Note that this should be an integer, example server specification:
16340
16341 @lisp
16342 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16343 (nnimap-server-port 4711))
16344 @end lisp
16345
16346 @item nnimap-list-pattern
16347 @vindex nnimap-list-pattern
16348 String or list of strings of mailboxes to limit available groups to.
16349 This is used when the server has very many mailboxes and you're only
16350 interested in a few---some servers export your home directory via
16351 @acronym{IMAP}, you'll probably want to limit the mailboxes to those in
16352 @file{~/Mail/*} then.
16353
16354 The string can also be a cons of REFERENCE and the string as above, what
16355 REFERENCE is used for is server specific, but on the University of
16356 Washington server it's a directory that will be concatenated with the
16357 mailbox.
16358
16359 Example server specification:
16360
16361 @lisp
16362 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16363 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "Mail/*" "alt.sex.*"
16364 ("~friend/Mail/" . "list/*"))))
16365 @end lisp
16366
16367 @item nnimap-stream
16368 @vindex nnimap-stream
16369 The type of stream used to connect to your server. By default, nnimap
16370 will detect and automatically use all of the below, with the exception
16371 of @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}. (@acronym{IMAP} over
16372 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is being replaced by STARTTLS, which can
16373 be automatically detected, but it's not widely deployed yet.)
16374
16375 Example server specification:
16376
16377 @lisp
16378 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16379 (nnimap-stream ssl))
16380 @end lisp
16381
16382 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-stream} is a symbol!
16383
16384 @itemize @bullet
16385 @item
16386 @dfn{gssapi:} Connect with GSSAPI (usually Kerberos 5). Requires the
16387 @samp{gsasl} or @samp{imtest} program.
16388 @item
16389 @dfn{kerberos4:} Connect with Kerberos 4. Requires the @samp{imtest} program.
16390 @item
16391 @dfn{starttls:} Connect via the STARTTLS extension (similar to
16392 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}). Requires the external library @samp{starttls.el} and program
16393 @samp{starttls}.
16394 @item
16395 @dfn{tls:} Connect through @acronym{TLS}. Requires GNUTLS (the program
16396 @samp{gnutls-cli}).
16397 @item
16398 @dfn{ssl:} Connect through @acronym{SSL}. Requires OpenSSL (the program
16399 @samp{openssl}) or SSLeay (@samp{s_client}).
16400 @item
16401 @dfn{shell:} Use a shell command to start @acronym{IMAP} connection.
16402 @item
16403 @dfn{network:} Plain, TCP/IP network connection.
16404 @end itemize
16405
16406 @vindex imap-kerberos4-program
16407 The @samp{imtest} program is shipped with Cyrus IMAPD. If you're
16408 using @samp{imtest} from Cyrus IMAPD < 2.0.14 (which includes version
16409 1.5.x and 1.6.x) you need to frob @code{imap-process-connection-type}
16410 to make @code{imap.el} use a pty instead of a pipe when communicating
16411 with @samp{imtest}. You will then suffer from a line length
16412 restrictions on @acronym{IMAP} commands, which might make Gnus seem to hang
16413 indefinitely if you have many articles in a mailbox. The variable
16414 @code{imap-kerberos4-program} contain parameters to pass to the imtest
16415 program.
16416
16417 For @acronym{TLS} connection, the @code{gnutls-cli} program from GNUTLS is
16418 needed. It is available from
16419 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/}.
16420
16421 @vindex imap-gssapi-program
16422 This parameter specifies a list of command lines that invoke a GSSAPI
16423 authenticated @acronym{IMAP} stream in a subshell. They are tried
16424 sequentially until a connection is made, or the list has been
16425 exhausted. By default, @samp{gsasl} from GNU SASL, available from
16426 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gsasl/}, and the @samp{imtest}
16427 program from Cyrus IMAPD (see @code{imap-kerberos4-program}), are
16428 tried.
16429
16430 @vindex imap-ssl-program
16431 For @acronym{SSL} connections, the OpenSSL program is available from
16432 @uref{http://www.openssl.org/}. OpenSSL was formerly known as SSLeay,
16433 and nnimap support it too---although the most recent versions of
16434 SSLeay, 0.9.x, are known to have serious bugs making it
16435 useless. Earlier versions, especially 0.8.x, of SSLeay are known to
16436 work. The variable @code{imap-ssl-program} contain parameters to pass
16437 to OpenSSL/SSLeay.
16438
16439 @vindex imap-shell-program
16440 @vindex imap-shell-host
16441 For @acronym{IMAP} connections using the @code{shell} stream, the variable
16442 @code{imap-shell-program} specify what program to call.
16443
16444 @item nnimap-authenticator
16445 @vindex nnimap-authenticator
16446
16447 The authenticator used to connect to the server. By default, nnimap
16448 will use the most secure authenticator your server is capable of.
16449
16450 Example server specification:
16451
16452 @lisp
16453 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16454 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous))
16455 @end lisp
16456
16457 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-authenticator} is a symbol!
16458
16459 @itemize @bullet
16460 @item
16461 @dfn{gssapi:} GSSAPI (usually kerberos 5) authentication. Requires
16462 external program @code{gsasl} or @code{imtest}.
16463 @item
16464 @dfn{kerberos4:} Kerberos 4 authentication. Requires external program
16465 @code{imtest}.
16466 @item
16467 @dfn{digest-md5:} Encrypted username/password via DIGEST-MD5. Requires
16468 external library @code{digest-md5.el}.
16469 @item
16470 @dfn{cram-md5:} Encrypted username/password via CRAM-MD5.
16471 @item
16472 @dfn{login:} Plain-text username/password via LOGIN.
16473 @item
16474 @dfn{anonymous:} Login as ``anonymous'', supplying your email address as password.
16475 @end itemize
16476
16477 @item nnimap-expunge-on-close
16478 @cindex expunging
16479 @vindex nnimap-expunge-on-close
16480 Unlike Parmenides the @acronym{IMAP} designers have decided things that
16481 don't exist actually do exist. More specifically, @acronym{IMAP} has
16482 this concept of marking articles @code{Deleted} which doesn't actually
16483 delete them, and this (marking them @code{Deleted}, that is) is what
16484 nnimap does when you delete an article in Gnus (with @kbd{B DEL} or
16485 similar).
16486
16487 Since the articles aren't really removed when we mark them with the
16488 @code{Deleted} flag we'll need a way to actually delete them. Feel like
16489 running in circles yet?
16490
16491 Traditionally, nnimap has removed all articles marked as @code{Deleted}
16492 when closing a mailbox but this is now configurable by this server
16493 variable.
16494
16495 The possible options are:
16496
16497 @table @code
16498
16499 @item always
16500 The default behavior, delete all articles marked as ``Deleted'' when
16501 closing a mailbox.
16502 @item never
16503 Never actually delete articles. Currently there is no way of showing
16504 the articles marked for deletion in nnimap, but other @acronym{IMAP} clients
16505 may allow you to do this. If you ever want to run the EXPUNGE command
16506 manually, @xref{Expunging mailboxes}.
16507 @item ask
16508 When closing mailboxes, nnimap will ask if you wish to expunge deleted
16509 articles or not.
16510
16511 @end table
16512
16513 @item nnimap-importantize-dormant
16514 @vindex nnimap-importantize-dormant
16515
16516 If non-@code{nil} (the default), marks dormant articles as ticked (as
16517 well), for other @acronym{IMAP} clients. Within Gnus, dormant articles will
16518 naturally still (only) be marked as dormant. This is to make dormant
16519 articles stand out, just like ticked articles, in other @acronym{IMAP}
16520 clients. (In other words, Gnus has two ``Tick'' marks and @acronym{IMAP}
16521 has only one.)
16522
16523 Probably the only reason for frobbing this would be if you're trying
16524 enable per-user persistent dormant flags, using something like:
16525
16526 @lisp
16527 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-flag-alist)
16528 (format "gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16529 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-predicate-alist)
16530 (format "KEYWORD gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16531 @end lisp
16532
16533 In this case, you would not want the per-user dormant flag showing up
16534 as ticked for other users.
16535
16536 @item nnimap-expunge-search-string
16537 @cindex expunging
16538 @vindex nnimap-expunge-search-string
16539 @cindex expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail
16540
16541 This variable contain the @acronym{IMAP} search command sent to server when
16542 searching for articles eligible for expiring. The default is
16543 @code{"UID %s NOT SINCE %s"}, where the first @code{%s} is replaced by
16544 UID set and the second @code{%s} is replaced by a date.
16545
16546 Probably the only useful value to change this to is
16547 @code{"UID %s NOT SENTSINCE %s"}, which makes nnimap use the Date: in
16548 messages instead of the internal article date. See section 6.4.4 of
16549 RFC 2060 for more information on valid strings.
16550
16551 However, if @code{nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil}
16552 is true, this variable has no effect since the search logic
16553 is reversed, as described below.
16554
16555 @item nnimap-authinfo-file
16556 @vindex nnimap-authinfo-file
16557
16558 A file containing credentials used to log in on servers. The format is
16559 (almost) the same as the @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file. See the
16560 variable @code{nntp-authinfo-file} for exact syntax; also see
16561 @ref{NNTP}. An example of an .authinfo line for an IMAP server, is:
16562
16563 @example
16564 machine students.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis port imap
16565 @end example
16566
16567 Note that it should be @code{port imap}, or @code{port 143}, if you
16568 use a @code{nnimap-stream} of @code{tls} or @code{ssl}, even if the
16569 actual port number used is port 993 for secured IMAP. For
16570 convenience, Gnus will accept @code{port imaps} as a synonym of
16571 @code{port imap}.
16572
16573 @item nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16574 @vindex nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16575
16576 Unselect mailboxes before looking for new mail in them. Some servers
16577 seem to need this under some circumstances; it was reported that
16578 Courier 1.7.1 did.
16579
16580 @item nnimap-nov-is-evil
16581 @vindex nnimap-nov-is-evil
16582 @cindex Courier @acronym{IMAP} server
16583 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
16584
16585 Never generate or use a local @acronym{NOV} database. Defaults to the
16586 value of @code{gnus-agent}.
16587
16588 Using a @acronym{NOV} database usually makes header fetching much
16589 faster, but it uses the @code{UID SEARCH UID} command, which is very
16590 slow on some servers (notably some versions of Courier). Since the Gnus
16591 Agent caches the information in the @acronym{NOV} database without using
16592 the slow command, this variable defaults to true if the Agent is in use,
16593 and false otherwise.
16594
16595 @item nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil
16596 @vindex nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil
16597 @cindex Courier @acronym{IMAP} server
16598 @cindex expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail
16599
16600 Avoid the @code{UID SEARCH UID @var{message numbers} NOT SINCE
16601 @var{date}} command, which is slow on some @acronym{IMAP} servers
16602 (notably, some versions of Courier). Instead, use @code{UID SEARCH SINCE
16603 @var{date}} and prune the list of expirable articles within Gnus.
16604
16605 When Gnus expires your mail (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), it starts with a
16606 list of expirable articles and asks the IMAP server questions like ``Of
16607 these articles, which ones are older than a week?'' While this seems
16608 like a perfectly reasonable question, some IMAP servers take a long time
16609 to answer it, since they seemingly go looking into every old article to
16610 see if it is one of the expirable ones. Curiously, the question ``Of
16611 @emph{all} articles, which ones are newer than a week?'' seems to be
16612 much faster to answer, so setting this variable causes Gnus to ask this
16613 question and figure out the answer to the real question itself.
16614
16615 This problem can really sneak up on you: when you first configure Gnus,
16616 everything works fine, but once you accumulate a couple thousand
16617 messages, you start cursing Gnus for being so slow. On the other hand,
16618 if you get a lot of email within a week, setting this variable will
16619 cause a lot of network traffic between Gnus and the IMAP server.
16620
16621 @end table
16622
16623 @menu
16624 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
16625 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
16626 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
16627 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
16628 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
16629 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
16630 @end menu
16631
16632
16633
16634 @node Splitting in IMAP
16635 @subsection Splitting in IMAP
16636 @cindex splitting imap mail
16637
16638 Splitting is something Gnus users have loved and used for years, and now
16639 the rest of the world is catching up. Yeah, dream on, not many
16640 @acronym{IMAP} servers have server side splitting and those that have
16641 splitting seem to use some non-standard protocol. This means that
16642 @acronym{IMAP} support for Gnus has to do its own splitting.
16643
16644 And it does.
16645
16646 (Incidentally, people seem to have been dreaming on, and Sieve has
16647 gaining a market share and is supported by several IMAP servers.
16648 Fortunately, Gnus support it too, @xref{Sieve Commands}.)
16649
16650 Here are the variables of interest:
16651
16652 @table @code
16653
16654 @item nnimap-split-crosspost
16655 @cindex splitting, crosspost
16656 @cindex crosspost
16657 @vindex nnimap-split-crosspost
16658
16659 If non-@code{nil}, do crossposting if several split methods match the
16660 mail. If @code{nil}, the first match in @code{nnimap-split-rule}
16661 found will be used.
16662
16663 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-crosspost}.
16664
16665 @item nnimap-split-inbox
16666 @cindex splitting, inbox
16667 @cindex inbox
16668 @vindex nnimap-split-inbox
16669
16670 A string or a list of strings that gives the name(s) of @acronym{IMAP}
16671 mailboxes to split from. Defaults to @code{nil}, which means that
16672 splitting is disabled!
16673
16674 @lisp
16675 (setq nnimap-split-inbox
16676 '("INBOX" ("~/friend/Mail" . "lists/*") "lists.imap"))
16677 @end lisp
16678
16679 No nnmail equivalent.
16680
16681 @item nnimap-split-rule
16682 @cindex splitting, rules
16683 @vindex nnimap-split-rule
16684
16685 New mail found in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be split according to
16686 this variable.
16687
16688 This variable contains a list of lists, where the first element in the
16689 sublist gives the name of the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox to move articles
16690 matching the regexp in the second element in the sublist. Got that?
16691 Neither did I, we need examples.
16692
16693 @lisp
16694 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16695 '(("INBOX.nnimap"
16696 "^Sender: owner-nnimap@@vic20.globalcom.se")
16697 ("INBOX.junk" "^Subject:.*MAKE MONEY")
16698 ("INBOX.private" "")))
16699 @end lisp
16700
16701 This will put all articles from the nnimap mailing list into mailbox
16702 INBOX.nnimap, all articles containing MAKE MONEY in the Subject: line
16703 into INBOX.junk and everything else in INBOX.private.
16704
16705 The first string may contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by
16706 replace-match to insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For
16707 instance:
16708
16709 @lisp
16710 ("INBOX.lists.\\1" "^Sender: owner-\\([a-z-]+\\)@@")
16711 @end lisp
16712
16713 The first element can also be the symbol @code{junk} to indicate that
16714 matching messages should simply be deleted. Use with care.
16715
16716 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
16717 called with the first element of the rule as the argument, in a buffer
16718 containing the headers of the article. It should return a
16719 non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the mail belongs in that group.
16720
16721 Nnmail users might recollect that the last regexp had to be empty to
16722 match all articles (like in the example above). This is not required in
16723 nnimap. Articles not matching any of the regexps will not be moved out
16724 of your inbox. (This might affect performance if you keep lots of
16725 unread articles in your inbox, since the splitting code would go over
16726 them every time you fetch new mail.)
16727
16728 These rules are processed from the beginning of the alist toward the
16729 end. The first rule to make a match will ``win'', unless you have
16730 crossposting enabled. In that case, all matching rules will ``win''.
16731
16732 This variable can also have a function as its value, the function will
16733 be called with the headers narrowed and should return a group where it
16734 thinks the article should be split to. See @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16735
16736 The splitting code tries to create mailboxes if it needs to.
16737
16738 To allow for different split rules on different virtual servers, and
16739 even different split rules in different inboxes on the same server,
16740 the syntax of this variable have been extended along the lines of:
16741
16742 @lisp
16743 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16744 '(("my1server" (".*" (("ding" "ding@@gnus.org")
16745 ("junk" "From:.*Simon"))))
16746 ("my2server" ("INBOX" nnimap-split-fancy))
16747 ("my[34]server" (".*" (("private" "To:.*Simon")
16748 ("junk" my-junk-func))))))
16749 @end lisp
16750
16751 The virtual server name is in fact a regexp, so that the same rules
16752 may apply to several servers. In the example, the servers
16753 @code{my3server} and @code{my4server} both use the same rules.
16754 Similarly, the inbox string is also a regexp. The actual splitting
16755 rules are as before, either a function, or a list with group/regexp or
16756 group/function elements.
16757
16758 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
16759
16760 @item nnimap-split-predicate
16761 @cindex splitting
16762 @vindex nnimap-split-predicate
16763
16764 Mail matching this predicate in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be
16765 split, it is a string and the default is @samp{UNSEEN UNDELETED}.
16766
16767 This might be useful if you use another @acronym{IMAP} client to read mail in
16768 your inbox but would like Gnus to split all articles in the inbox
16769 regardless of readedness. Then you might change this to
16770 @samp{UNDELETED}.
16771
16772 @item nnimap-split-fancy
16773 @cindex splitting, fancy
16774 @findex nnimap-split-fancy
16775 @vindex nnimap-split-fancy
16776
16777 It's possible to set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16778 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} if you want to use fancy
16779 splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
16780
16781 However, to be able to have different fancy split rules for nnmail and
16782 nnimap back ends you can set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16783 @code{nnimap-split-fancy} and define the nnimap specific fancy split
16784 rule in @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16785
16786 Example:
16787
16788 @lisp
16789 (setq nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
16790 nnimap-split-fancy ...)
16791 @end lisp
16792
16793 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
16794
16795 @item nnimap-split-download-body
16796 @findex nnimap-split-download-body
16797 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
16798
16799 Set to non-@code{nil} to download entire articles during splitting.
16800 This is generally not required, and will slow things down
16801 considerably. You may need it if you want to use an advanced
16802 splitting function that analyzes the body to split the article.
16803
16804 @end table
16805
16806 @node Expiring in IMAP
16807 @subsection Expiring in IMAP
16808 @cindex expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail
16809
16810 Even though @code{nnimap} is not a proper @code{nnmail} derived back
16811 end, it supports most features in regular expiring (@pxref{Expiring
16812 Mail}). Unlike splitting in @acronym{IMAP} (@pxref{Splitting in
16813 IMAP}) it does not clone the @code{nnmail} variables (i.e., creating
16814 @var{nnimap-expiry-wait}) but reuse the @code{nnmail} variables. What
16815 follows below are the variables used by the @code{nnimap} expiry
16816 process.
16817
16818 A note on how the expire mark is stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server is
16819 appropriate here as well. The expire mark is translated into a
16820 @code{imap} client specific mark, @code{gnus-expire}, and stored on the
16821 message. This means that likely only Gnus will understand and treat
16822 the @code{gnus-expire} mark properly, although other clients may allow
16823 you to view client specific flags on the message. It also means that
16824 your server must support permanent storage of client specific flags on
16825 messages. Most do, fortunately.
16826
16827 If expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail seems very slow, try setting the server
16828 variable @code{nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil}.
16829
16830 @table @code
16831
16832 @item nnmail-expiry-wait
16833 @item nnmail-expiry-wait-function
16834
16835 These variables are fully supported. The expire value can be a
16836 number, the symbol @code{immediate} or @code{never}.
16837
16838 @item nnmail-expiry-target
16839
16840 This variable is supported, and internally implemented by calling the
16841 @code{nnmail} functions that handle this. It contains an optimization
16842 that if the destination is a @acronym{IMAP} group on the same server, the
16843 article is copied instead of appended (that is, uploaded again).
16844
16845 @end table
16846
16847 @node Editing IMAP ACLs
16848 @subsection Editing IMAP ACLs
16849 @cindex editing imap acls
16850 @cindex Access Control Lists
16851 @cindex Editing @acronym{IMAP} ACLs
16852 @kindex G l (Group)
16853 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-edit-acl
16854
16855 ACL stands for Access Control List. ACLs are used in @acronym{IMAP} for
16856 limiting (or enabling) other users access to your mail boxes. Not all
16857 @acronym{IMAP} servers support this, this function will give an error if it
16858 doesn't.
16859
16860 To edit an ACL for a mailbox, type @kbd{G l}
16861 (@code{gnus-group-edit-nnimap-acl}) and you'll be presented with an ACL
16862 editing window with detailed instructions.
16863
16864 Some possible uses:
16865
16866 @itemize @bullet
16867 @item
16868 Giving ``anyone'' the ``lrs'' rights (lookup, read, keep seen/unseen flags)
16869 on your mailing list mailboxes enables other users on the same server to
16870 follow the list without subscribing to it.
16871 @item
16872 At least with the Cyrus server, you are required to give the user
16873 ``anyone'' posting ("p") capabilities to have ``plussing'' work (that is,
16874 mail sent to user+mailbox@@domain ending up in the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox
16875 INBOX.mailbox).
16876 @end itemize
16877
16878 @node Expunging mailboxes
16879 @subsection Expunging mailboxes
16880 @cindex expunging
16881
16882 @cindex expunge
16883 @cindex manual expunging
16884 @kindex G x (Group)
16885 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-expunge
16886
16887 If you're using the @code{never} setting of @code{nnimap-expunge-on-close},
16888 you may want the option of expunging all deleted articles in a mailbox
16889 manually. This is exactly what @kbd{G x} does.
16890
16891 Currently there is no way of showing deleted articles, you can just
16892 delete them.
16893
16894 @node A note on namespaces
16895 @subsection A note on namespaces
16896 @cindex IMAP namespace
16897 @cindex namespaces
16898
16899 The @acronym{IMAP} protocol has a concept called namespaces, described
16900 by the following text in the RFC2060:
16901
16902 @display
16903 5.1.2. Mailbox Namespace Naming Convention
16904
16905 By convention, the first hierarchical element of any mailbox name
16906 which begins with "#" identifies the "namespace" of the remainder of
16907 the name. This makes it possible to disambiguate between different
16908 types of mailbox stores, each of which have their own namespaces.
16909
16910 For example, implementations which offer access to USENET
16911 newsgroups MAY use the "#news" namespace to partition the USENET
16912 newsgroup namespace from that of other mailboxes. Thus, the
16913 comp.mail.misc newsgroup would have an mailbox name of
16914 "#news.comp.mail.misc", and the name "comp.mail.misc" could refer
16915 to a different object (e.g. a user's private mailbox).
16916 @end display
16917
16918 While there is nothing in this text that warrants concern for the
16919 @acronym{IMAP} implementation in Gnus, some servers use namespace
16920 prefixes in a way that does not work with how Gnus uses mailbox names.
16921
16922 Specifically, University of Washington's @acronym{IMAP} server uses
16923 mailbox names like @code{#driver.mbx/read-mail} which are valid only
16924 in the @sc{create} and @sc{append} commands. After the mailbox is
16925 created (or a messages is appended to a mailbox), it must be accessed
16926 without the namespace prefix, i.e. @code{read-mail}. Since Gnus do
16927 not make it possible for the user to guarantee that user entered
16928 mailbox names will only be used with the CREATE and APPEND commands,
16929 you should simply not use the namespace prefixed mailbox names in
16930 Gnus.
16931
16932 See the UoW IMAPD documentation for the @code{#driver.*/} prefix
16933 for more information on how to use the prefixes. They are a power
16934 tool and should be used only if you are sure what the effects are.
16935
16936 @node Debugging IMAP
16937 @subsection Debugging IMAP
16938 @cindex IMAP debugging
16939 @cindex protocol dump (IMAP)
16940
16941 @acronym{IMAP} is a complex protocol, more so than @acronym{NNTP} or
16942 @acronym{POP3}. Implementation bugs are not unlikely, and we do our
16943 best to fix them right away. If you encounter odd behavior, chances
16944 are that either the server or Gnus is buggy.
16945
16946 If you are familiar with network protocols in general, you will
16947 probably be able to extract some clues from the protocol dump of the
16948 exchanges between Gnus and the server. Even if you are not familiar
16949 with network protocols, when you include the protocol dump in
16950 @acronym{IMAP}-related bug reports you are helping us with data
16951 critical to solving the problem. Therefore, we strongly encourage you
16952 to include the protocol dump when reporting IMAP bugs in Gnus.
16953
16954
16955 @vindex imap-log
16956 Because the protocol dump, when enabled, generates lots of data, it is
16957 disabled by default. You can enable it by setting @code{imap-log} as
16958 follows:
16959
16960 @lisp
16961 (setq imap-log t)
16962 @end lisp
16963
16964 This instructs the @code{imap.el} package to log any exchanges with
16965 the server. The log is stored in the buffer @samp{*imap-log*}. Look
16966 for error messages, which sometimes are tagged with the keyword
16967 @code{BAD}---but when submitting a bug, make sure to include all the
16968 data.
16969
16970 @node Other Sources
16971 @section Other Sources
16972
16973 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
16974 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
16975 newsgroups.
16976
16977 @menu
16978 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
16979 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
16980 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
16981 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
16982 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
16983 @end menu
16984
16985
16986 @node Directory Groups
16987 @subsection Directory Groups
16988 @cindex nndir
16989 @cindex directory groups
16990
16991 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
16992 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
16993 names, of course.
16994
16995 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
16996 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
16997 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
16998 back end to read directories. Big deal.
16999
17000 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
17001 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
17002 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
17003 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
17004 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
17005
17006 @code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
17007
17008 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
17009 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
17010 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
17011 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
17012
17013
17014 @node Anything Groups
17015 @subsection Anything Groups
17016 @cindex nneething
17017
17018 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
17019 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
17020 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
17021 true.
17022
17023 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
17024 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
17025 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
17026 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
17027 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
17028 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
17029 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
17030 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g. a C source file),
17031 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
17032 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
17033 elements.
17034
17035 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
17036 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
17037 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
17038 in the article buffer, just as usual.
17039
17040 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
17041 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
17042 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
17043 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
17044
17045 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
17046 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
17047 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
17048 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
17049 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
17050 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
17051 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
17052 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
17053
17054 Some variables:
17055
17056 @table @code
17057 @item nneething-map-file-directory
17058 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
17059 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
17060 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
17061
17062 @item nneething-exclude-files
17063 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
17064 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
17065 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
17066
17067 @item nneething-include-files
17068 @vindex nneething-include-files
17069 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
17070 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
17071
17072 @item nneething-map-file
17073 @vindex nneething-map-file
17074 Name of the map files.
17075 @end table
17076
17077
17078 @node Document Groups
17079 @subsection Document Groups
17080 @cindex nndoc
17081 @cindex documentation group
17082 @cindex help group
17083
17084 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
17085 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
17086
17087 @table @code
17088 @cindex Babyl
17089 @cindex Rmail mbox
17090 @item babyl
17091 The Babyl (Rmail) mail box.
17092
17093 @cindex mbox
17094 @cindex Unix mbox
17095 @item mbox
17096 The standard Unix mbox file.
17097
17098 @cindex MMDF mail box
17099 @item mmdf
17100 The MMDF mail box format.
17101
17102 @item news
17103 Several news articles appended into a file.
17104
17105 @cindex rnews batch files
17106 @item rnews
17107 The rnews batch transport format.
17108
17109 @item nsmail
17110 Netscape mail boxes.
17111
17112 @item mime-parts
17113 @acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
17114
17115 @item standard-digest
17116 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
17117
17118 @item mime-digest
17119 A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
17120
17121 @item lanl-gov-announce
17122 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
17123
17124 @cindex forwarded messages
17125 @item rfc822-forward
17126 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
17127
17128 @item outlook
17129 The Outlook mail box.
17130
17131 @item oe-dbx
17132 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
17133
17134 @item exim-bounce
17135 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
17136
17137 @item forward
17138 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
17139
17140 @item rfc934
17141 An RFC934-forwarded message.
17142
17143 @item mailman
17144 A mailman digest.
17145
17146 @item clari-briefs
17147 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
17148
17149 @item slack-digest
17150 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
17151
17152 @item mail-in-mail
17153 The last resort.
17154 @end table
17155
17156 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
17157 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
17158 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
17159 file is.
17160
17161 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
17162 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
17163 group. And that's it.
17164
17165 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
17166 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
17167 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
17168 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
17169 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
17170 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
17171 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
17172 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
17173 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
17174 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
17175
17176 Virtual server variables:
17177
17178 @table @code
17179 @item nndoc-article-type
17180 @vindex nndoc-article-type
17181 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
17182 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
17183 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
17184 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
17185 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
17186
17187 @item nndoc-post-type
17188 @vindex nndoc-post-type
17189 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
17190 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
17191 and @code{news}.
17192 @end table
17193
17194 @menu
17195 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
17196 @end menu
17197
17198
17199 @node Document Server Internals
17200 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
17201
17202 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
17203 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
17204 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
17205 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
17206
17207 First, here's an example document type definition:
17208
17209 @example
17210 (mmdf
17211 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
17212 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
17213 @end example
17214
17215 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
17216 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
17217 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
17218 types can be defined with very few settings:
17219
17220 @table @code
17221 @item first-article
17222 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
17223 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
17224 totally ignored.
17225
17226 @item article-begin
17227 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
17228 says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
17229 complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
17230 use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
17231
17232 @item article-begin-function
17233 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
17234 of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
17235
17236 @item head-begin
17237 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
17238 article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
17239 simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
17240
17241 @item head-begin-function
17242 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
17243 the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
17244
17245 @item head-end
17246 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
17247 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
17248
17249 @item body-begin
17250 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
17251 to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
17252 a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
17253
17254 @item body-begin-function
17255 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
17256 of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
17257
17258 @item body-end
17259 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
17260 more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
17261 can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
17262
17263 @item body-end-function
17264 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
17265 the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
17266
17267 @item file-begin
17268 If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
17269 before this regexp will be totally ignored.
17270
17271 @item file-end
17272 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
17273 regexp will be totally ignored.
17274
17275 @end table
17276
17277 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
17278 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
17279 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
17280 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
17281 something that's palatable for Gnus:
17282
17283 @table @code
17284 @item prepare-body-function
17285 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
17286 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
17287 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
17288
17289 @item article-transform-function
17290 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
17291 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
17292 body of the article.
17293
17294 @item generate-head-function
17295 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
17296 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
17297 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
17298 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
17299
17300 @item generate-article-function
17301 If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
17302 Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
17303 parameter when requesting all articles.
17304
17305 @item dissection-function
17306 If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
17307 overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
17308 @code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
17309 @code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
17310 @code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
17311 @code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
17312
17313 @end table
17314
17315 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
17316 digests:
17317
17318 @example
17319 (standard-digest
17320 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17321 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17322 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
17323 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
17324 (head-end . "^ ?$")
17325 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
17326 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
17327 (subtype digest guess))
17328 @end example
17329
17330 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
17331 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
17332 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
17333 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
17334 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
17335
17336 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
17337 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
17338 is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
17339 where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
17340 The alist is traversed sequentially, and
17341 @code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
17342 So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
17343 @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
17344 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
17345 is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
17346 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
17347 means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
17348
17349
17350 @node SOUP
17351 @subsection SOUP
17352 @cindex SOUP
17353 @cindex offline
17354
17355 In the PC world people often talk about ``offline'' newsreaders. These
17356 are thingies that are combined reader/news transport monstrosities.
17357 With built-in modem programs. Yecchh!
17358
17359 Of course, us Unix Weenie types of human beans use things like
17360 @code{uucp} and, like, @code{nntpd} and set up proper news and mail
17361 transport things like Ghod intended. And then we just use normal
17362 newsreaders.
17363
17364 However, it can sometimes be convenient to do something that's a bit
17365 easier on the brain if you have a very slow modem, and you're not really
17366 that interested in doing things properly.
17367
17368 A file format called @sc{soup} has been developed for transporting news
17369 and mail from servers to home machines and back again. It can be a bit
17370 fiddly.
17371
17372 First some terminology:
17373
17374 @table @dfn
17375
17376 @item server
17377 This is the machine that is connected to the outside world and where you
17378 get news and/or mail from.
17379
17380 @item home machine
17381 This is the machine that you want to do the actual reading and responding
17382 on. It is typically not connected to the rest of the world in any way.
17383
17384 @item packet
17385 Something that contains messages and/or commands. There are two kinds
17386 of packets:
17387
17388 @table @dfn
17389 @item message packets
17390 These are packets made at the server, and typically contain lots of
17391 messages for you to read. These are called @file{SoupoutX.tgz} by
17392 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17393
17394 @item response packets
17395 These are packets made at the home machine, and typically contains
17396 replies that you've written. These are called @file{SoupinX.tgz} by
17397 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17398
17399 @end table
17400
17401 @end table
17402
17403
17404 @enumerate
17405
17406 @item
17407 You log in on the server and create a @sc{soup} packet. You can either
17408 use a dedicated @sc{soup} thingie (like the @code{awk} program), or you
17409 can use Gnus to create the packet with its @sc{soup} commands (@kbd{O
17410 s} and/or @kbd{G s b}; and then @kbd{G s p}) (@pxref{SOUP Commands}).
17411
17412 @item
17413 You transfer the packet home. Rail, boat, car or modem will do fine.
17414
17415 @item
17416 You put the packet in your home directory.
17417
17418 @item
17419 You fire up Gnus on your home machine using the @code{nnsoup} back end as
17420 the native or secondary server.
17421
17422 @item
17423 You read articles and mail and answer and followup to the things you
17424 want (@pxref{SOUP Replies}).
17425
17426 @item
17427 You do the @kbd{G s r} command to pack these replies into a @sc{soup}
17428 packet.
17429
17430 @item
17431 You transfer this packet to the server.
17432
17433 @item
17434 You use Gnus to mail this packet out with the @kbd{G s s} command.
17435
17436 @item
17437 You then repeat until you die.
17438
17439 @end enumerate
17440
17441 So you basically have a bipartite system---you use @code{nnsoup} for
17442 reading and Gnus for packing/sending these @sc{soup} packets.
17443
17444 @menu
17445 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
17446 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
17447 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
17448 @end menu
17449
17450
17451 @node SOUP Commands
17452 @subsubsection SOUP Commands
17453
17454 These are commands for creating and manipulating @sc{soup} packets.
17455
17456 @table @kbd
17457 @item G s b
17458 @kindex G s b (Group)
17459 @findex gnus-group-brew-soup
17460 Pack all unread articles in the current group
17461 (@code{gnus-group-brew-soup}). This command understands the
17462 process/prefix convention.
17463
17464 @item G s w
17465 @kindex G s w (Group)
17466 @findex gnus-soup-save-areas
17467 Save all @sc{soup} data files (@code{gnus-soup-save-areas}).
17468
17469 @item G s s
17470 @kindex G s s (Group)
17471 @findex gnus-soup-send-replies
17472 Send all replies from the replies packet
17473 (@code{gnus-soup-send-replies}).
17474
17475 @item G s p
17476 @kindex G s p (Group)
17477 @findex gnus-soup-pack-packet
17478 Pack all files into a @sc{soup} packet (@code{gnus-soup-pack-packet}).
17479
17480 @item G s r
17481 @kindex G s r (Group)
17482 @findex nnsoup-pack-replies
17483 Pack all replies into a replies packet (@code{nnsoup-pack-replies}).
17484
17485 @item O s
17486 @kindex O s (Summary)
17487 @findex gnus-soup-add-article
17488 This summary-mode command adds the current article to a @sc{soup} packet
17489 (@code{gnus-soup-add-article}). It understands the process/prefix
17490 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
17491
17492 @end table
17493
17494
17495 There are a few variables to customize where Gnus will put all these
17496 thingies:
17497
17498 @table @code
17499
17500 @item gnus-soup-directory
17501 @vindex gnus-soup-directory
17502 Directory where Gnus will save intermediate files while composing
17503 @sc{soup} packets. The default is @file{~/SoupBrew/}.
17504
17505 @item gnus-soup-replies-directory
17506 @vindex gnus-soup-replies-directory
17507 This is what Gnus will use as a temporary directory while sending our
17508 reply packets. @file{~/SoupBrew/SoupReplies/} is the default.
17509
17510 @item gnus-soup-prefix-file
17511 @vindex gnus-soup-prefix-file
17512 Name of the file where Gnus stores the last used prefix. The default is
17513 @samp{gnus-prefix}.
17514
17515 @item gnus-soup-packer
17516 @vindex gnus-soup-packer
17517 A format string command for packing a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17518 @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupout%d.tgz}.
17519
17520 @item gnus-soup-unpacker
17521 @vindex gnus-soup-unpacker
17522 Format string command for unpacking a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17523 @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17524
17525 @item gnus-soup-packet-directory
17526 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-directory
17527 Where Gnus will look for reply packets. The default is @file{~/}.
17528
17529 @item gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17530 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17531 Regular expression matching @sc{soup} reply packets in
17532 @code{gnus-soup-packet-directory}.
17533
17534 @end table
17535
17536
17537 @node SOUP Groups
17538 @subsubsection SOUP Groups
17539 @cindex nnsoup
17540
17541 @code{nnsoup} is the back end for reading @sc{soup} packets. It will
17542 read incoming packets, unpack them, and put them in a directory where
17543 you can read them at leisure.
17544
17545 These are the variables you can use to customize its behavior:
17546
17547 @table @code
17548
17549 @item nnsoup-tmp-directory
17550 @vindex nnsoup-tmp-directory
17551 When @code{nnsoup} unpacks a @sc{soup} packet, it does it in this
17552 directory. (@file{/tmp/} by default.)
17553
17554 @item nnsoup-directory
17555 @vindex nnsoup-directory
17556 @code{nnsoup} then moves each message and index file to this directory.
17557 The default is @file{~/SOUP/}.
17558
17559 @item nnsoup-replies-directory
17560 @vindex nnsoup-replies-directory
17561 All replies will be stored in this directory before being packed into a
17562 reply packet. The default is @file{~/SOUP/replies/}.
17563
17564 @item nnsoup-replies-format-type
17565 @vindex nnsoup-replies-format-type
17566 The @sc{soup} format of the replies packets. The default is @samp{?n}
17567 (rnews), and I don't think you should touch that variable. I probably
17568 shouldn't even have documented it. Drats! Too late!
17569
17570 @item nnsoup-replies-index-type
17571 @vindex nnsoup-replies-index-type
17572 The index type of the replies packet. The default is @samp{?n}, which
17573 means ``none''. Don't fiddle with this one either!
17574
17575 @item nnsoup-active-file
17576 @vindex nnsoup-active-file
17577 Where @code{nnsoup} stores lots of information. This is not an ``active
17578 file'' in the @code{nntp} sense; it's an Emacs Lisp file. If you lose
17579 this file or mess it up in any way, you're dead. The default is
17580 @file{~/SOUP/active}.
17581
17582 @item nnsoup-packer
17583 @vindex nnsoup-packer
17584 Format string command for packing a reply @sc{soup} packet. The default
17585 is @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupin%d.tgz}.
17586
17587 @item nnsoup-unpacker
17588 @vindex nnsoup-unpacker
17589 Format string command for unpacking incoming @sc{soup} packets. The
17590 default is @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17591
17592 @item nnsoup-packet-directory
17593 @vindex nnsoup-packet-directory
17594 Where @code{nnsoup} will look for incoming packets. The default is
17595 @file{~/}.
17596
17597 @item nnsoup-packet-regexp
17598 @vindex nnsoup-packet-regexp
17599 Regular expression matching incoming @sc{soup} packets. The default is
17600 @samp{Soupout}.
17601
17602 @item nnsoup-always-save
17603 @vindex nnsoup-always-save
17604 If non-@code{nil}, save the replies buffer after each posted message.
17605
17606 @end table
17607
17608
17609 @node SOUP Replies
17610 @subsubsection SOUP Replies
17611
17612 Just using @code{nnsoup} won't mean that your postings and mailings end
17613 up in @sc{soup} reply packets automagically. You have to work a bit
17614 more for that to happen.
17615
17616 @findex nnsoup-set-variables
17617 The @code{nnsoup-set-variables} command will set the appropriate
17618 variables to ensure that all your followups and replies end up in the
17619 @sc{soup} system.
17620
17621 In specific, this is what it does:
17622
17623 @lisp
17624 (setq message-send-news-function 'nnsoup-request-post)
17625 (setq message-send-mail-function 'nnsoup-request-mail)
17626 @end lisp
17627
17628 And that's it, really. If you only want news to go into the @sc{soup}
17629 system you just use the first line. If you only want mail to be
17630 @sc{soup}ed you use the second.
17631
17632
17633 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
17634 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17635 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
17636 @cindex gateways
17637
17638 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17639 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17640 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
17641
17642 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17643 used to post with.
17644
17645 Server variables:
17646
17647 @table @code
17648 @item nngateway-address
17649 @vindex nngateway-address
17650 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
17651
17652 @item nngateway-header-transformation
17653 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17654 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17655 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17656 transformation should be called, and defaults to
17657 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17658 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17659 gateway address.
17660
17661 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17662 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17663 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
17664
17665 @example
17666 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17667 @end example
17668
17669 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
17670
17671 @example
17672 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17673 @end example
17674
17675 The following pre-defined functions exist:
17676
17677 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17678 @table @code
17679
17680 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17681 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17682 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
17683
17684 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17685
17686 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17687 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17688 @code{nngateway-address}.
17689 @end table
17690
17691 @end table
17692
17693 Here's an example:
17694
17695 @lisp
17696 (setq gnus-post-method
17697 '(nngateway
17698 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17699 (nngateway-header-transformation
17700 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17701 @end lisp
17702
17703 So, to use this, simply say something like:
17704
17705 @lisp
17706 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17707 @end lisp
17708
17709
17710
17711 @node Combined Groups
17712 @section Combined Groups
17713
17714 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17715 groups.
17716
17717 @menu
17718 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
17719 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
17720 @end menu
17721
17722
17723 @node Virtual Groups
17724 @subsection Virtual Groups
17725 @cindex nnvirtual
17726 @cindex virtual groups
17727 @cindex merging groups
17728
17729 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17730 other groups.
17731
17732 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17733 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17734 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
17735
17736 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17737 regexp to match component groups.
17738
17739 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17740 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17741 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17742 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17743 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17744 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17745 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17746 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
17747
17748 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17749 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
17750
17751 @lisp
17752 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17753 @end lisp
17754
17755 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17756 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
17757
17758 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17759 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17760 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17761 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
17762
17763 @example
17764 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17765 @end example
17766
17767 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17768 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17769 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
17770
17771 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17772 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17773 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17774 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17775 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
17776
17777 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17778 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17779 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
17780
17781 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17782 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} variable is non-@code{nil} (which
17783 is the default), @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread
17784 articles when entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil}
17785 and you read articles in a component group after the virtual group has
17786 been activated, the read articles from the component group will show up
17787 when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this effect if you
17788 have two virtual groups that have a component group in common. If
17789 that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}. Or you can
17790 just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before you enter
17791 it---it'll have much the same effect.
17792
17793 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17794 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17795 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17796 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17797 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17798 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17799 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
17800
17801 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17802 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
17803
17804 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17805 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17806 inherited.
17807
17808
17809 @node Kibozed Groups
17810 @subsection Kibozed Groups
17811 @cindex nnkiboze
17812 @cindex kibozing
17813
17814 @dfn{Kibozing} is defined by the @acronym{OED} as ``grepping through
17815 (parts of) the news feed''. @code{nnkiboze} is a back end that will
17816 do this for you. Oh joy! Now you can grind any @acronym{NNTP} server
17817 down to a halt with useless requests! Oh happiness!
17818
17819 @kindex G k (Group)
17820 To create a kibozed group, use the @kbd{G k} command in the group
17821 buffer.
17822
17823 The address field of the @code{nnkiboze} method is, as with
17824 @code{nnvirtual}, a regexp to match groups to be ``included'' in the
17825 @code{nnkiboze} group. That's where most similarities between
17826 @code{nnkiboze} and @code{nnvirtual} end.
17827
17828 In addition to this regexp detailing component groups, an
17829 @code{nnkiboze} group must have a score file to say what articles are
17830 to be included in the group (@pxref{Scoring}).
17831
17832 @kindex M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups
17833 @findex nnkiboze-generate-groups
17834 You must run @kbd{M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups} after creating the
17835 @code{nnkiboze} groups you want to have. This command will take time.
17836 Lots of time. Oodles and oodles of time. Gnus has to fetch the
17837 headers from all the articles in all the component groups and run them
17838 through the scoring process to determine if there are any articles in
17839 the groups that are to be part of the @code{nnkiboze} groups.
17840
17841 Please limit the number of component groups by using restrictive
17842 regexps. Otherwise your sysadmin may become annoyed with you, and the
17843 @acronym{NNTP} site may throw you off and never let you back in again.
17844 Stranger things have happened.
17845
17846 @code{nnkiboze} component groups do not have to be alive---they can be dead,
17847 and they can be foreign. No restrictions.
17848
17849 @vindex nnkiboze-directory
17850 The generation of an @code{nnkiboze} group means writing two files in
17851 @code{nnkiboze-directory}, which is @file{~/News/kiboze/} by default.
17852 One contains the @acronym{NOV} header lines for all the articles in
17853 the group, and the other is an additional @file{.newsrc} file to store
17854 information on what groups have been searched through to find
17855 component articles.
17856
17857 Articles marked as read in the @code{nnkiboze} group will have
17858 their @acronym{NOV} lines removed from the @acronym{NOV} file.
17859
17860
17861 @node Gnus Unplugged
17862 @section Gnus Unplugged
17863 @cindex offline
17864 @cindex unplugged
17865 @cindex agent
17866 @cindex Gnus agent
17867 @cindex Gnus unplugged
17868
17869 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
17870 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
17871 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
17872 read news. Believe it or not.
17873
17874 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
17875 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
17876 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
17877 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
17878 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
17879
17880 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
17881 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
17882 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
17883 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
17884 reading news on a machine.
17885
17886 Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
17887 fact, you don't even have to configure anything.
17888
17889 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
17890
17891 @menu
17892 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
17893 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
17894 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
17895 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
17896 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
17897 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
17898 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
17899 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
17900 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
17901 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
17902 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
17903 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
17904 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
17905 @end menu
17906
17907
17908 @node Agent Basics
17909 @subsection Agent Basics
17910
17911 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
17912
17913 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
17914 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
17915 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
17916 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
17917
17918 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
17919 connected to the net continuously.
17920
17921 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
17922 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
17923
17924 You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
17925 shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
17926 is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
17927 say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
17928 you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
17929
17930 Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
17931 that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
17932 can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
17933 servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
17934 they're kinda like plugged always).
17935
17936 So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
17937 connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
17938 servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
17939 the culprit.
17940
17941 Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
17942 reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
17943 server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
17944 server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
17945 will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
17946
17947 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
17948
17949 @itemize @bullet
17950
17951 @item
17952 @findex gnus-unplugged
17953 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
17954 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
17955 already fetched while in this mode.
17956
17957 @item
17958 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
17959 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
17960 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
17961 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
17962 Source Specifiers}).
17963
17964 @item
17965 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
17966 news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
17967 @kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
17968 all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
17969 articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
17970
17971 @item
17972 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
17973 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
17974 then you read the news offline.
17975
17976 @item
17977 And then you go to step 2.
17978 @end itemize
17979
17980 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
17981 the Agent.
17982
17983 @itemize @bullet
17984
17985 @item
17986 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
17987 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
17988 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
17989 @kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
17990 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
17991 added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
17992 all @code{nntp} and @code{nnimap} servers in @code{gnus-select-method} and
17993 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} are agentized.
17994
17995 @item
17996 Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
17997 you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
17998 parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
17999 is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
18000
18001 Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
18002 (@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
18003 to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
18004 parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
18005 to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
18006 your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
18007 configure them.
18008
18009 @item
18010 Uhm@dots{} that's it.
18011 @end itemize
18012
18013
18014 @node Agent Categories
18015 @subsection Agent Categories
18016
18017 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
18018 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
18019 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
18020 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
18021 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
18022 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
18023 you're interested in the articles anyway.
18024
18025 One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
18026 downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
18027 groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
18028 category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
18029 buffer for creating and managing categories.
18030
18031 If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
18032 Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
18033 alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
18034 difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
18035 less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
18036 sink.
18037
18038 Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
18039 a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
18040 the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
18041 parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
18042 variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
18043 of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
18044 your settings.
18045
18046 @menu
18047 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
18048 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
18049 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
18050 @end menu
18051
18052
18053 @node Category Syntax
18054 @subsubsection Category Syntax
18055
18056 A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
18057 category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
18058 customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
18059 listed below.
18060
18061 @cindex Agent Parameters
18062 @table @code
18063 @item gnus-agent-cat-name
18064 The name of the category.
18065
18066 @item gnus-agent-cat-groups
18067 The list of groups that are in this category.
18068
18069 @item gnus-agent-cat-predicate
18070 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
18071 are eligible for downloading; and
18072
18073 @item gnus-agent-cat-score-file
18074 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
18075 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
18076 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
18077
18078 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-expiration
18079 a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
18080 this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
18081 fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
18082 only groups that should not be expired.
18083
18084 @item gnus-agent-cat-days-until-old
18085 an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
18086 before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
18087
18088 @item gnus-agent-cat-low-score
18089 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
18090
18091 @item gnus-agent-cat-high-score
18092 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
18093
18094 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-short
18095 an integer that overrides the value of
18096 @code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
18097
18098 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-long
18099 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
18100
18101 @c @item gnus-agent-cat-disable-undownloaded-faces
18102 @c a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should @emph{not} display
18103 @c undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
18104 @c faces. The symbol nil will enable the use of undownloaded faces while
18105 @c all other symbols disable them.
18106
18107 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-undownloaded-faces
18108 a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
18109 undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
18110 faces. The symbol nil will disable the use of undownloaded faces while
18111 all other symbols enable them.
18112 @end table
18113
18114 The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
18115 created.
18116
18117 Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
18118 that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
18119 group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
18120 category.
18121
18122 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
18123 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
18124 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
18125 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
18126
18127 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
18128 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
18129 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
18130
18131 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
18132 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
18133 operators sprinkled in between.
18134
18135 Perhaps some examples are in order.
18136
18137 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
18138 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
18139
18140 @lisp
18141 short
18142 @end lisp
18143
18144 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
18145 short (for some value of ``short'').
18146
18147 Here's a more complex predicate:
18148
18149 @lisp
18150 (or high
18151 (and
18152 (not low)
18153 (not long)))
18154 @end lisp
18155
18156 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
18157 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
18158 drift.
18159
18160 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
18161 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
18162 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
18163
18164 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
18165 you want to do, you can write your own.
18166
18167 When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
18168 bound to the value determined by calling
18169 @code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
18170 example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
18171 @code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
18172 means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
18173 predicate to individual groups.
18174
18175 @table @code
18176 @item short
18177 True iff the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
18178 lines; default 100.
18179
18180 @item long
18181 True iff the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
18182 lines; default 200.
18183
18184 @item low
18185 True iff the article has a download score less than
18186 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
18187
18188 @item high
18189 True iff the article has a download score greater than
18190 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
18191
18192 @item spam
18193 True iff the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
18194 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
18195 checksum and sees whether articles match.
18196
18197 @item true
18198 Always true.
18199
18200 @item false
18201 Always false.
18202 @end table
18203
18204 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
18205 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
18206 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
18207 useful values.
18208
18209 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
18210 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g. posted
18211 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
18212 something along the lines of the following:
18213
18214 @lisp
18215 (defun my-article-old-p ()
18216 "Say whether an article is old."
18217 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
18218 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
18219 @end lisp
18220
18221 with the predicate then defined as:
18222
18223 @lisp
18224 (not my-article-old-p)
18225 @end lisp
18226
18227 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
18228 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
18229 wherever.
18230
18231 @lisp
18232 (require 'gnus-agent)
18233 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
18234 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
18235 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
18236 @end lisp
18237
18238 and simply specify your predicate as:
18239
18240 @lisp
18241 (not old)
18242 @end lisp
18243
18244 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
18245 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
18246 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
18247 just don't give a damn.
18248
18249 The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
18250 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
18251 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
18252 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
18253 parameters like so:
18254
18255 @lisp
18256 (agent-predicate . short)
18257 @end lisp
18258
18259 This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
18260 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
18261 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
18262
18263 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
18264
18265 @lisp
18266 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
18267 @end lisp
18268
18269 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
18270 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
18271 predicate is assumed to be a list.
18272
18273
18274 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
18275 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
18276 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
18277 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
18278 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
18279 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
18280
18281 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
18282 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
18283 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
18284 if it's to be specific to that group.
18285
18286 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
18287 three forms:
18288
18289 @enumerate
18290 @item
18291 Score rule
18292
18293 This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
18294 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
18295
18296 example:
18297
18298 @itemize @bullet
18299 @item
18300 Category specification
18301
18302 @lisp
18303 (("from"
18304 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18305 ("lines"
18306 (500 -100 nil <)))
18307 @end lisp
18308
18309 @item
18310 Group/Topic Parameter specification
18311
18312 @lisp
18313 (agent-score ("from"
18314 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18315 ("lines"
18316 (500 -100 nil <)))
18317 @end lisp
18318
18319 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
18320 @end itemize
18321
18322 @item
18323 Agent score file
18324
18325 These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
18326 keywords stated above.
18327
18328 example:
18329
18330 @itemize @bullet
18331 @item
18332 Category specification
18333
18334 @lisp
18335 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
18336 @end lisp
18337
18338 or perhaps
18339
18340 @lisp
18341 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
18342 @end lisp
18343
18344 @item
18345 Group Parameter specification
18346
18347 @lisp
18348 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
18349 @end lisp
18350
18351 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
18352 about parenthesis?
18353 @end itemize
18354
18355 @item
18356 Use @code{normal} score files
18357
18358 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
18359 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
18360 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
18361 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
18362
18363 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
18364 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
18365 files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
18366 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
18367
18368 @itemize @bullet
18369 @item
18370 Category Specification
18371
18372 @lisp
18373 file
18374 @end lisp
18375
18376 @item
18377 Group Parameter specification
18378
18379 @lisp
18380 (agent-score . file)
18381 @end lisp
18382 @end itemize
18383 @end enumerate
18384
18385 @node Category Buffer
18386 @subsubsection Category Buffer
18387
18388 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
18389 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
18390 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
18391
18392 The following commands are available in this buffer:
18393
18394 @table @kbd
18395 @item q
18396 @kindex q (Category)
18397 @findex gnus-category-exit
18398 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
18399
18400 @item e
18401 @kindex e (Category)
18402 @findex gnus-category-customize-category
18403 Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
18404 parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
18405
18406 @item k
18407 @kindex k (Category)
18408 @findex gnus-category-kill
18409 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
18410
18411 @item c
18412 @kindex c (Category)
18413 @findex gnus-category-copy
18414 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
18415
18416 @item a
18417 @kindex a (Category)
18418 @findex gnus-category-add
18419 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
18420
18421 @item p
18422 @kindex p (Category)
18423 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
18424 Edit the predicate of the current category
18425 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
18426
18427 @item g
18428 @kindex g (Category)
18429 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18430 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18431 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
18432
18433 @item s
18434 @kindex s (Category)
18435 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
18436 Edit the download score rule of the current category
18437 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
18438
18439 @item l
18440 @kindex l (Category)
18441 @findex gnus-category-list
18442 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18443 @end table
18444
18445
18446 @node Category Variables
18447 @subsubsection Category Variables
18448
18449 @table @code
18450 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
18451 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18452 Hook run in category buffers.
18453
18454 @item gnus-category-line-format
18455 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
18456 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18457 Variables}). Valid elements are:
18458
18459 @table @samp
18460 @item c
18461 The name of the category.
18462
18463 @item g
18464 The number of groups in the category.
18465 @end table
18466
18467 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18468 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18469 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
18470
18471 @item gnus-agent-short-article
18472 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18473 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
18474
18475 @item gnus-agent-long-article
18476 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18477 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
18478
18479 @item gnus-agent-low-score
18480 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18481 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
18482 0.
18483
18484 @item gnus-agent-high-score
18485 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18486 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
18487 0.
18488
18489 @item gnus-agent-expire-days
18490 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18491 The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18492 local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18493 the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18494 just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18495 important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18496 article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18497 read.
18498 Default 7.
18499
18500 @item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18501 @vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18502 Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18503 retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18504 you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18505 you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18506 have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18507
18508 @end table
18509
18510
18511 @node Agent Commands
18512 @subsection Agent Commands
18513 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18514 @kindex J j (Agent)
18515
18516 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18517 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
18518 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
18519
18520
18521 @menu
18522 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
18523 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
18524 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
18525 @end menu
18526
18527
18528
18529
18530 @node Group Agent Commands
18531 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
18532
18533 @table @kbd
18534 @item J u
18535 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
18536 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
18537 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
18538 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
18539
18540 @item J c
18541 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
18542 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
18543 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
18544
18545 @item J s
18546 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
18547 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
18548 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
18549 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
18550
18551 @item J S
18552 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
18553 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
18554 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
18555 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
18556
18557 @item J a
18558 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
18559 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
18560 Add the current group to an Agent category
18561 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
18562 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18563
18564 @item J r
18565 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
18566 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
18567 Remove the current group from its category, if any
18568 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
18569 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18570
18571 @item J Y
18572 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
18573 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18574 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
18575
18576
18577 @end table
18578
18579
18580 @node Summary Agent Commands
18581 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
18582
18583 @table @kbd
18584 @item J #
18585 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
18586 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
18587 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
18588
18589 @item J M-#
18590 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
18591 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
18592 Remove the downloading mark from the article
18593 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
18594
18595 @cindex %
18596 @item @@
18597 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
18598 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
18599 Toggle whether to download the article
18600 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
18601 default.
18602
18603 @item J c
18604 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
18605 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
18606 Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
18607
18608 @item J S
18609 @kindex J S (Agent Summary)
18610 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
18611 Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
18612 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
18613
18614 @item J s
18615 @kindex J s (Agent Summary)
18616 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-series
18617 Download all processable articles in this group.
18618 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-series}).
18619
18620 @item J u
18621 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
18622 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
18623 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
18624 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
18625
18626 @end table
18627
18628
18629 @node Server Agent Commands
18630 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
18631
18632 @table @kbd
18633 @item J a
18634 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
18635 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
18636 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
18637 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
18638
18639 @item J r
18640 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
18641 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
18642 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
18643 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
18644
18645 @end table
18646
18647
18648 @node Agent Visuals
18649 @subsection Agent Visuals
18650
18651 If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
18652 active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
18653 stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
18654 something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
18655 placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
18656 there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
18657 When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
18658 placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
18659 You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
18660 placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
18661
18662 While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
18663 available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
18664 fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
18665 way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
18666 less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
18667 adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
18668 the download status of each article so that you always know which
18669 articles will be available when unplugged.
18670
18671 The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
18672 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
18673 a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
18674 Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
18675 will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
18676 other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
18677 @samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
18678 (@samp{ }) will be displayed.
18679
18680 The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
18681 are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
18682 result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
18683 that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
18684 face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
18685 tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
18686 conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
18687 that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
18688 to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
18689
18690 If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
18691 each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
18692 undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
18693 being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
18694 downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear.
18695
18696 For occasional Agent users, the undownloaded faces may appear to be an
18697 absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since most of their
18698 articles have not been fetched into the Agent, most of the normal
18699 faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces. If this is your
18700 situation, you have two choices available. First, you can completely
18701 disable the undownload faces by customizing
18702 @code{gnus-summary-highlight} to delete the three cons-cells that
18703 refer to the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face} faces. Second,
18704 if you prefer to take a more fine-grained approach, you may set the
18705 @code{agent-disable-undownloaded-faces} group parameter to @code{t}.
18706 This parameter, like all other agent parameters, may be set on an
18707 Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}), a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic
18708 Parameters}), or an individual group (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
18709
18710 @node Agent as Cache
18711 @subsection Agent as Cache
18712
18713 When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
18714 articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
18715 Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
18716 in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
18717 buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
18718 are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
18719 consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
18720 article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
18721 server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
18722
18723 If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
18724 @pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
18725 plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
18726 synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
18727 sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
18728
18729 @node Agent Expiry
18730 @subsection Agent Expiry
18731
18732 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18733 @findex gnus-agent-expire
18734 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
18735 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
18736 @findex gnus-agent-expire-group
18737 @cindex agent expiry
18738 @cindex Gnus agent expiry
18739 @cindex expiry, in Gnus agent
18740
18741 The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
18742 least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
18743 special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
18744 commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
18745 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
18746 that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
18747 efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
18748 @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
18749
18750 Note that other functions, e.g. @code{gnus-request-expire-articles},
18751 might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you to keep the agent
18752 synchronized with the group.
18753
18754 The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
18755 prevent expiration in selected groups.
18756
18757 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
18758 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
18759 expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
18760 and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
18761 are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
18762 be kept indefinitely.
18763
18764 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
18765 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
18766 commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
18767 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
18768
18769 @node Agent Regeneration
18770 @subsection Agent Regeneration
18771
18772 @cindex agent regeneration
18773 @cindex Gnus agent regeneration
18774 @cindex regeneration
18775
18776 The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
18777 due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
18778 @code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
18779 to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
18780 internal inconsistencies.
18781
18782 For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
18783 downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
18784 know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
18785 failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
18786 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
18787 such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
18788
18789 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
18790 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
18791 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
18792 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
18793 you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
18794 recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
18795
18796 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18797 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18798 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
18799 of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
18800 then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
18801 are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
18802 agent as unread.
18803
18804 @node Agent and IMAP
18805 @subsection Agent and IMAP
18806
18807 The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
18808 since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
18809 @acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
18810 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
18811
18812 The first thing to keep in mind is that all flags (read, ticked, etc)
18813 are kept on the @acronym{IMAP} server, rather than in @file{.newsrc} as is the
18814 case for nntp. Thus Gnus need to remember flag changes when
18815 disconnected, and synchronize these flags when you plug back in.
18816
18817 Gnus keeps track of flag changes when reading nnimap groups under the
18818 Agent. When you plug back in, Gnus will check if you have any changed
18819 any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the server.
18820 The behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
18821
18822 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18823 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
18824 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
18825 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
18826 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
18827 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
18828
18829 If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
18830 re-connect, you can do it manually with the
18831 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
18832 in the group buffer.
18833
18834 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
18835 expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
18836
18837 @itemize @bullet
18838
18839 @item
18840 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
18841
18842 @item
18843 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
18844
18845 @end itemize
18846
18847 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
18848 all local flags to the server, but rather incrementally update the
18849 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
18850 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group and
18851 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
18852 removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
18853 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
18854 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
18855
18856
18857 @node Outgoing Messages
18858 @subsection Outgoing Messages
18859
18860 When Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail and news) are
18861 stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}). You can view
18862 them there after posting, and edit them at will.
18863
18864 When Gnus is plugged again, you can send the messages either from the
18865 draft group with the special commands available there, or you can use
18866 the @kbd{J S} command in the group buffer to send all the sendable
18867 messages in the draft group.
18868
18869
18870
18871 @node Agent Variables
18872 @subsection Agent Variables
18873
18874 @table @code
18875 @item gnus-agent-directory
18876 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
18877 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
18878 @file{~/News/agent/}.
18879
18880 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
18881 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
18882 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
18883 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
18884 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
18885 by default.
18886
18887 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
18888 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
18889 Hook run when connecting to the network.
18890
18891 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
18892 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
18893 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
18894
18895 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
18896 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
18897 Hook run when finished fetching articles.
18898
18899 @item gnus-agent-cache
18900 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
18901 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
18902 articles when plugged, e.g. essentially using the Agent as a cache.
18903 The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
18904
18905 @item gnus-agent-go-online
18906 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
18907 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
18908 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
18909 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
18910 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
18911 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
18912 online status.
18913
18914 @item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
18915 @vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
18916 If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
18917 mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
18918 thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
18919 read. The default is @code{t}.
18920
18921 @item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
18922 @vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
18923 If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
18924 agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
18925 downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
18926 the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
18927 are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
18928 into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
18929 the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
18930 over and over again.
18931
18932 @item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
18933 @vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
18934 The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
18935 them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
18936 the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
18937 have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
18938 limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
18939 performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
18940 connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
18941 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
18942 However, all articles parsed prior to loosing the connection will be
18943 available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
18944 see any cycling.
18945
18946 @item gnus-server-unopen-status
18947 @vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
18948 Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
18949 variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
18950 Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
18951 whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
18952 Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
18953 for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
18954 is only valid if the Agent is used.
18955
18956 @item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
18957 @vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
18958 Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
18959 that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
18960 buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
18961 agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
18962
18963 The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
18964 @code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
18965 have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
18966 ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
18967 (maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
18968
18969 @item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
18970 @vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
18971 If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
18972 @file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
18973 automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
18974 which backends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
18975 to agentize remote backends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
18976 as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
18977 If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
18978 removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
18979 start Gnus. The default is @samp{(nntp nnimap)}.
18980
18981 @end table
18982
18983
18984 @node Example Setup
18985 @subsection Example Setup
18986
18987 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
18988 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
18989 @file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
18990
18991 @lisp
18992 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
18993 ;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
18994 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
18995
18996 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
18997 ;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
18998 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
18999
19000 ;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
19001 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
19002
19003 ;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
19004 ;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
19005 ;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
19006 @end lisp
19007
19008 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
19009 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
19010 gnus}.
19011
19012 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
19013 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
19014 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
19015 @acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
19016 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
19017 once.
19018
19019 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
19020 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
19021 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
19022 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
19023 back all the killed groups.)
19024
19025 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
19026 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
19027 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
19028
19029
19030 @node Batching Agents
19031 @subsection Batching Agents
19032 @findex gnus-agent-batch
19033
19034 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
19035 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
19036 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
19037
19038 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
19039 following incantation:
19040
19041 @example
19042 #!/bin/sh
19043 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
19044 @end example
19045
19046
19047 @node Agent Caveats
19048 @subsection Agent Caveats
19049
19050 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
19051 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
19052 may ask:
19053
19054 @table @dfn
19055 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
19056
19057 @strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
19058 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
19059 @code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
19060
19061 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
19062 the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
19063
19064 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
19065
19066 @end table
19067
19068 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
19069 articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
19070 locally stored articles.
19071
19072
19073 @node Scoring
19074 @chapter Scoring
19075 @cindex scoring
19076
19077 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
19078 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
19079 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
19080 attention!
19081
19082 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
19083 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
19084 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
19085 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
19086 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
19087
19088 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
19089 before generating the summary buffer.
19090
19091 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
19092 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
19093 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
19094
19095 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
19096 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
19097 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
19098 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
19099
19100 @menu
19101 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
19102 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
19103 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
19104 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
19105 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
19106 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
19107 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
19108 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
19109 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
19110 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
19111 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
19112 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
19113 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
19114 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
19115 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
19116 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
19117 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
19118 @end menu
19119
19120
19121 @node Summary Score Commands
19122 @section Summary Score Commands
19123 @cindex score commands
19124
19125 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
19126 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
19127 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
19128 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
19129 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
19130
19131 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
19132 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
19133 some other score file (e.g. @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
19134 score file the current one.
19135
19136 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
19137
19138 @table @kbd
19139
19140 @item V s
19141 @kindex V s (Summary)
19142 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
19143 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
19144
19145 @item V S
19146 @kindex V S (Summary)
19147 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
19148 Display the score of the current article
19149 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
19150
19151 @item V t
19152 @kindex V t (Summary)
19153 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
19154 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
19155 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
19156 may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
19157 current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
19158 score file and edit it.
19159
19160 @item V w
19161 @kindex V w (Summary)
19162 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
19163 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
19164
19165 @item V R
19166 @kindex V R (Summary)
19167 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
19168 Run the current summary through the scoring process
19169 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
19170 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
19171 effect you're having.
19172
19173 @item V c
19174 @kindex V c (Summary)
19175 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
19176 Make a different score file the current
19177 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
19178
19179 @item V e
19180 @kindex V e (Summary)
19181 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
19182 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
19183 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
19184 File Editing}).
19185
19186 @item V f
19187 @kindex V f (Summary)
19188 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
19189 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
19190 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
19191
19192 @item V F
19193 @kindex V F (Summary)
19194 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19195 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
19196 after editing score files.
19197
19198 @item V C
19199 @kindex V C (Summary)
19200 @findex gnus-score-customize
19201 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
19202 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
19203
19204 @end table
19205
19206 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
19207
19208 @table @kbd
19209
19210 @item V m
19211 @kindex V m (Summary)
19212 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
19213 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
19214 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
19215
19216 @item V x
19217 @kindex V x (Summary)
19218 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
19219 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
19220 expunge all articles below this score
19221 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
19222 @end table
19223
19224 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
19225 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
19226 them.)
19227
19228 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
19229 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
19230
19231 @enumerate
19232 @item
19233 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
19234 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
19235 @item
19236 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
19237 keys are available:
19238 @table @kbd
19239
19240 @item a
19241 Score on the author name.
19242
19243 @item s
19244 Score on the subject line.
19245
19246 @item x
19247 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
19248
19249 @item r
19250 Score on the @code{References} line.
19251
19252 @item d
19253 Score on the date.
19254
19255 @item l
19256 Score on the number of lines.
19257
19258 @item i
19259 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
19260
19261 @item e
19262 Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
19263 if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
19264
19265 @item f
19266 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
19267 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
19268 @file{ADAPT} files.)
19269
19270 @item b
19271 Score on the body.
19272
19273 @item h
19274 Score on the head.
19275
19276 @item t
19277 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
19278 files.)
19279
19280 @end table
19281
19282 @item
19283 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
19284 what headers you are scoring on.
19285
19286 @table @code
19287
19288 @item strings
19289
19290 @table @kbd
19291
19292 @item e
19293 Exact matching.
19294
19295 @item s
19296 Substring matching.
19297
19298 @item f
19299 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
19300
19301 @item r
19302 Regexp matching
19303 @end table
19304
19305 @item date
19306 @table @kbd
19307
19308 @item b
19309 Before date.
19310
19311 @item a
19312 After date.
19313
19314 @item n
19315 This date.
19316 @end table
19317
19318 @item number
19319 @table @kbd
19320
19321 @item <
19322 Less than number.
19323
19324 @item =
19325 Equal to number.
19326
19327 @item >
19328 Greater than number.
19329 @end table
19330 @end table
19331
19332 @item
19333 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
19334 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
19335 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
19336 file.
19337 @table @kbd
19338
19339 @item t
19340 Temporary score entry.
19341
19342 @item p
19343 Permanent score entry.
19344
19345 @item i
19346 Immediately scoring.
19347 @end table
19348
19349 @item
19350 If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
19351 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
19352 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
19353
19354 @end enumerate
19355
19356 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
19357 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
19358 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
19359 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
19360
19361 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
19362 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
19363 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
19364 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
19365 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
19366
19367 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
19368 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
19369 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
19370 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
19371 current score file.
19372
19373 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
19374 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
19375 pretend they are keymaps or not.
19376
19377
19378 @node Group Score Commands
19379 @section Group Score Commands
19380 @cindex group score commands
19381
19382 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
19383
19384 @table @kbd
19385
19386 @item W f
19387 @kindex W f (Group)
19388 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19389 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
19390 all the time. This command will flush the cache
19391 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
19392
19393 @end table
19394
19395 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
19396
19397 @findex gnus-batch-score
19398 @cindex batch scoring
19399 @example
19400 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
19401 @end example
19402
19403
19404 @node Score Variables
19405 @section Score Variables
19406 @cindex score variables
19407
19408 @table @code
19409
19410 @item gnus-use-scoring
19411 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
19412 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
19413 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
19414
19415 @item gnus-kill-killed
19416 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
19417 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
19418 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
19419 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
19420 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
19421 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
19422 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
19423
19424 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
19425 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19426 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19427 initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19428 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
19429
19430 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
19431 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19432 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19433 (@file{SCORE} by default.)
19434
19435 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19436 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19437 @cindex score cache
19438 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19439 score files. However, if this might make your Emacs grow big and
19440 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19441 to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19442 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19443 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19444 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19445 be cached.
19446
19447 @item gnus-save-score
19448 @vindex gnus-save-score
19449 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19450 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19451 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
19452
19453 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19454 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19455 across group visits.
19456
19457 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19458 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19459 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19460 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19461 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19462 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19463 manually entered data.
19464
19465 @item gnus-summary-default-score
19466 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19467 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
19468
19469 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19470 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19471 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19472 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19473 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19474 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
19475
19476 @item gnus-score-over-mark
19477 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19478 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19479 default. Default is @samp{+}.
19480
19481 @item gnus-score-below-mark
19482 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19483 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19484 default. Default is @samp{-}.
19485
19486 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19487 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19488 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19489 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
19490
19491 Predefined functions available are:
19492 @table @code
19493
19494 @item gnus-score-find-single
19495 @findex gnus-score-find-single
19496 Only apply the group's own score file.
19497
19498 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
19499 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19500 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19501 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19502 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19503 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19504 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19505 then a regexp match is done.
19506
19507 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19508 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
19509
19510 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19511 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19512 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19513 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
19514
19515 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19516 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19517 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
19518 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
19519 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
19520 server.
19521
19522 @end table
19523 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
19524 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
19525 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
19526 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
19527 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
19528 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
19529 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
19530 Phu.
19531
19532 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
19533 overall score file, you could use the value
19534 @example
19535 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
19536 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
19537 @end example
19538
19539 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
19540 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
19541 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
19542 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
19543 are expired. It's 7 by default.
19544
19545 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19546 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19547 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
19548 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
19549 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
19550 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
19551 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
19552 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
19553
19554 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19555 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19556 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
19557
19558 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
19559 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
19560 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
19561 simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
19562 threading---according to the current value of
19563 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
19564 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
19565 simplified in this manner.
19566
19567 @end table
19568
19569
19570 @node Score File Format
19571 @section Score File Format
19572 @cindex score file format
19573
19574 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
19575 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
19576 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
19577
19578 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
19579
19580 @lisp
19581 (("from"
19582 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
19583 ("Per Abrahamsen")
19584 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
19585 ("subject"
19586 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
19587 ("xref"
19588 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
19589 ("lines"
19590 (2 -100 nil <))
19591 (mark 0)
19592 (expunge -1000)
19593 (mark-and-expunge -10)
19594 (read-only nil)
19595 (orphan -10)
19596 (adapt t)
19597 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
19598 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
19599 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
19600 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
19601 (eval (ding)))
19602 @end lisp
19603
19604 This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
19605 Scoring}, for a different approach.
19606
19607 Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
19608 @code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
19609 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
19610
19611 Six keys are supported by this alist:
19612
19613 @table @code
19614
19615 @item STRING
19616 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
19617 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
19618 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
19619 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
19620 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
19621 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
19622 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
19623 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
19624 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
19625 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
19626 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
19627 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
19628 to articles that matches these score entries.
19629
19630 Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
19631 score entry has one to four elements.
19632 @enumerate
19633
19634 @item
19635 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
19636 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
19637 integer.
19638
19639 @item
19640 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
19641 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
19642 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
19643 is successful. If this element is not present, the
19644 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
19645 instead. This is 1000 by default.
19646
19647 @item
19648 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
19649 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
19650 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
19651 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
19652 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
19653
19654 @item
19655 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
19656 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
19657 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
19658 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
19659 @table @dfn
19660
19661 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
19662 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
19663 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
19664 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
19665 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
19666 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
19667 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
19668 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
19669 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
19670 instead, if you feel like.
19671
19672 @item Extra
19673 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
19674 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
19675 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
19676 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
19677 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
19678 host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
19679 overviews:
19680
19681 @lisp
19682 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
19683 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
19684 @end lisp
19685
19686 @item Lines, Chars
19687 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
19688 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
19689
19690 These predicates are true if
19691
19692 @example
19693 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
19694 @end example
19695
19696 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
19697 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
19698 following form:
19699
19700 @lisp
19701 (< header-value 4)
19702 @end lisp
19703
19704 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
19705 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
19706 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
19707 it's not. I think.)
19708
19709 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
19710 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
19711 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
19712 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
19713
19714 @item Date
19715 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
19716 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
19717 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
19718 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
19719 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
19720 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
19721 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
19722
19723 @cindex ISO8601
19724 @cindex date
19725 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
19726 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
19727 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
19728 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
19729 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
19730 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
19731 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
19732 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
19733 whole family, eh?)
19734
19735 @item Head, Body, All
19736 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
19737 header uses.
19738
19739 @item Followup
19740 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
19741 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
19742 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
19743 you e.g. increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
19744 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
19745 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
19746 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
19747 files.)
19748
19749 @item Thread
19750 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
19751 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
19752 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
19753 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
19754 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
19755 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
19756 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
19757 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
19758 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
19759 undeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
19760 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
19761 @end table
19762 @end enumerate
19763
19764 @cindex score file atoms
19765 @item mark
19766 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19767 lower than this number will be marked as read.
19768
19769 @item expunge
19770 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19771 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
19772
19773 @item mark-and-expunge
19774 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19775 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
19776 summary buffer.
19777
19778 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
19779 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
19780 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
19781 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
19782 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
19783
19784 @item files
19785 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
19786 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
19787 this one was.
19788
19789 @item exclude-files
19790 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
19791 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
19792 other.
19793
19794 @item eval
19795 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}el. This element will be
19796 ignored when handling global score files.
19797
19798 @item read-only
19799 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
19800 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
19801 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
19802 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
19803
19804 @item orphan
19805 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
19806 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
19807 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
19808 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
19809
19810 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
19811
19812 @example
19813 (orphan -500)
19814 (mark-and-expunge -100)
19815 @end example
19816
19817 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
19818 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
19819 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{C y}) the
19820 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
19821 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
19822
19823 I.e.---the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
19824 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
19825 scoring rules exist.
19826
19827 @item adapt
19828 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
19829 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
19830 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
19831 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
19832 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
19833 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
19834 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
19835 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
19836 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
19837 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
19838 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
19839 it.
19840
19841 @item adapt-file
19842 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
19843 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
19844 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
19845 file for a number of groups.
19846
19847 @item local
19848 @cindex local variables
19849 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
19850 @var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
19851 current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
19852 convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
19853 groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
19854 be evaluated.
19855 @end table
19856
19857
19858 @node Score File Editing
19859 @section Score File Editing
19860
19861 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
19862 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
19863 with a mode for that.
19864
19865 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
19866 additional commands:
19867
19868 @table @kbd
19869
19870 @item C-c C-c
19871 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
19872 @findex gnus-score-edit-done
19873 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
19874 (@code{gnus-score-edit-done}).
19875
19876 @item C-c C-d
19877 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
19878 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
19879 Insert the current date in numerical format
19880 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
19881 you were wondering.
19882
19883 @item C-c C-p
19884 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
19885 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
19886 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
19887 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
19888 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
19889 you.
19890
19891 @end table
19892
19893 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
19894
19895 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
19896 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
19897
19898 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
19899 @kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
19900
19901
19902 @node Adaptive Scoring
19903 @section Adaptive Scoring
19904 @cindex adaptive scoring
19905
19906 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
19907 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
19908 stupidity, to be precise.
19909
19910 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
19911 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
19912 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
19913 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
19914 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
19915 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
19916 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
19917 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
19918 variable to @code{(word line)}.
19919
19920 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
19921 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
19922 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
19923 might look something like this:
19924
19925 @lisp
19926 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
19927 '((gnus-unread-mark)
19928 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
19929 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
19930 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
19931 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
19932 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
19933 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
19934 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
19935 (gnus-ancient-mark)
19936 (gnus-low-score-mark)
19937 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
19938 @end lisp
19939
19940 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
19941 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
19942 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
19943 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
19944 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
19945 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
19946 entries.
19947
19948 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
19949 will be applied to each article.
19950
19951 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
19952 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
19953 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
19954 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
19955
19956 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
19957 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
19958 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
19959 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
19960
19961 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
19962 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
19963 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
19964 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
19965
19966 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
19967 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
19968 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
19969 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
19970 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
19971 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
19972
19973 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
19974 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
19975 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
19976
19977 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
19978 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
19979 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
19980
19981 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
19982 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
19983 let you use different rules in different groups.
19984
19985 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
19986 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
19987 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
19988 is @file{ADAPT}.
19989
19990 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
19991 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
19992 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
19993 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
19994 the length of the match is less than
19995 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
19996 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
19997 this problem.
19998
19999 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20000 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
20001 headers. If you adapt on words, the
20002 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
20003 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
20004
20005 @lisp
20006 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20007 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
20008 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
20009 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
20010 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
20011 @end lisp
20012
20013 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
20014 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
20015 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
20016 score with 30 points.
20017
20018 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
20019 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
20020 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
20021 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
20022 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
20023
20024 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
20025 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
20026 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
20027 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
20028 variable defaults to @code{nil}.
20029
20030 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
20031 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
20032 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
20033 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
20034
20035 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
20036 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
20037 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
20038 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
20039
20040 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
20041 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
20042 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
20043 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
20044 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
20045
20046 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
20047 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
20048 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
20049
20050 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
20051 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
20052 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
20053 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
20054
20055
20056 @node Home Score File
20057 @section Home Score File
20058
20059 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
20060 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
20061 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
20062 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
20063
20064 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
20065 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
20066 could perhaps use the same home score file.
20067
20068 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
20069 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
20070 be:
20071
20072 @enumerate
20073 @item
20074 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
20075 groups.
20076
20077 @item
20078 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
20079 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
20080 parameter.
20081
20082 @item
20083 A list. The elements in this list can be:
20084
20085 @enumerate
20086 @item
20087 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
20088 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
20089
20090 @item
20091 A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
20092 be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
20093 name of the group as the parameter.
20094
20095 @item
20096 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
20097 @end enumerate
20098
20099 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
20100 for matches.
20101
20102 @end enumerate
20103
20104 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
20105
20106 @lisp
20107 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20108 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
20109 @end lisp
20110
20111 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
20112 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
20113
20114 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
20115 @lisp
20116 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20117 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
20118 @end lisp
20119
20120 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
20121 Other functions include
20122
20123 @table @code
20124 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
20125 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
20126 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
20127 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
20128
20129 @end table
20130
20131 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
20132 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
20133 their own home score files:
20134
20135 @lisp
20136 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20137 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
20138 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
20139 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
20140 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
20141 @end lisp
20142
20143 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
20144 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
20145 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
20146 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
20147 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
20148
20149 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
20150 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
20151 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
20152 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
20153 precedence over this variable.
20154
20155
20156 @node Followups To Yourself
20157 @section Followups To Yourself
20158
20159 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
20160 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
20161 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
20162 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
20163 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
20164 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
20165
20166 @table @code
20167
20168 @item gnus-score-followup-article
20169 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
20170 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
20171 article.
20172
20173 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
20174 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
20175 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
20176 your own article.
20177 @end table
20178
20179 @vindex message-sent-hook
20180 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
20181 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
20182 @lisp
20183 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
20184 @end lisp
20185
20186
20187 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
20188 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
20189 mine:
20190
20191 @example
20192 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20193 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20194 @end example
20195
20196 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
20197 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
20198 myself:
20199
20200 @lisp
20201 ("references"
20202 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
20203 1000 nil r))
20204 @end lisp
20205
20206 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
20207 is system-dependent.
20208
20209
20210 @node Scoring On Other Headers
20211 @section Scoring On Other Headers
20212 @cindex scoring on other headers
20213
20214 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
20215 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
20216 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
20217 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
20218 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
20219
20220 Now, there's not much you can do about this for news groups, but for
20221 mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
20222 it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
20223 a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
20224 @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
20225
20226 Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
20227
20228 @lisp
20229 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
20230 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
20231 @end lisp
20232
20233 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
20234 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
20235 time if you have much mail.
20236
20237 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
20238 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
20239
20240 See? Simple.
20241
20242
20243 @node Scoring Tips
20244 @section Scoring Tips
20245 @cindex scoring tips
20246
20247 @table @dfn
20248
20249 @item Crossposts
20250 @cindex crossposts
20251 @cindex scoring crossposts
20252 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
20253 the @code{Xref} header.
20254 @lisp
20255 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
20256 @end lisp
20257
20258 @item Multiple crossposts
20259 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
20260 more than, say, 3 groups:
20261 @lisp
20262 ("xref"
20263 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
20264 -1000 nil r))
20265 @end lisp
20266
20267 @item Matching on the body
20268 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
20269 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
20270 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
20271 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
20272 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
20273 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
20274 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
20275 the matches.
20276
20277 @item Marking as read
20278 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
20279 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
20280 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
20281 @lisp
20282 ((mark -100))
20283 @end lisp
20284 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
20285
20286 @item Negated character classes
20287 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
20288 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
20289 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
20290 @end table
20291
20292
20293 @node Reverse Scoring
20294 @section Reverse Scoring
20295 @cindex reverse scoring
20296
20297 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
20298 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
20299 like this in your score file:
20300
20301 @lisp
20302 (("subject"
20303 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
20304 (mark 1)
20305 (expunge 1))
20306 @end lisp
20307
20308 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
20309 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
20310
20311
20312 @node Global Score Files
20313 @section Global Score Files
20314 @cindex global score files
20315
20316 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
20317 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
20318 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
20319
20320 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
20321 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
20322 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
20323
20324 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
20325 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
20326 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
20327 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
20328 files are applicable to which group.
20329
20330 To use the score file
20331 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
20332 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
20333 say this:
20334
20335 @lisp
20336 (setq gnus-global-score-files
20337 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
20338 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
20339 @end lisp
20340
20341 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
20342 @noindent
20343 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
20344 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
20345 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
20346 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
20347
20348 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
20349 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
20350
20351 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
20352 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
20353 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
20354 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
20355 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
20356 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
20357
20358 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
20359 head:
20360
20361 @itemize @bullet
20362
20363 @item
20364 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
20365 @item
20366 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
20367 @item
20368 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
20369 @item
20370 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
20371 lowered out of existence.
20372 @item
20373 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
20374 articles completely.
20375
20376 @item
20377 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
20378 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
20379 old articles for a long time.
20380 @end itemize
20381
20382 @dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
20383 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
20384 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
20385 holding our breath yet?
20386
20387
20388 @node Kill Files
20389 @section Kill Files
20390 @cindex kill files
20391
20392 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
20393 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
20394 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
20395
20396 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
20397 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
20398 files into score files.
20399
20400 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
20401 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
20402 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
20403 that isn't a very good idea.
20404
20405 Normal kill files look like this:
20406
20407 @lisp
20408 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20409 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
20410 (gnus-expunge "X")
20411 @end lisp
20412
20413 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
20414 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
20415
20416 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
20417 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
20418 interpreting it.
20419
20420 Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
20421
20422 @table @kbd
20423
20424 @item M-k
20425 @kindex M-k (Summary)
20426 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20427 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
20428
20429 @item M-K
20430 @kindex M-K (Summary)
20431 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20432 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20433 @end table
20434
20435 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
20436
20437 @table @kbd
20438
20439 @item M-k
20440 @kindex M-k (Group)
20441 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20442 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
20443
20444 @item M-K
20445 @kindex M-K (Group)
20446 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20447 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
20448 @end table
20449
20450 Kill file variables:
20451
20452 @table @code
20453 @item gnus-kill-file-name
20454 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20455 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20456 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20457 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20458 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20459 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
20460
20461 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20462 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20463 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20464 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20465 kills.
20466
20467 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20468 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20469 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20470 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20471 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20472 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20473 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20474 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20475 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
20476
20477 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20478 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20479 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
20480
20481 @end table
20482
20483
20484 @node Converting Kill Files
20485 @section Converting Kill Files
20486 @cindex kill files
20487 @cindex converting kill files
20488
20489 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20490 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20491 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20492 by hand.
20493
20494 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Gnus by default.
20495 You can fetch it from
20496 @uref{http://www.stud.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
20497
20498 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20499 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20500 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20501 before.
20502
20503
20504 @node GroupLens
20505 @section GroupLens
20506 @cindex GroupLens
20507
20508 @sc{Note:} Unfortunately the GroupLens system seems to have shut down,
20509 so this section is mostly of historical interest.
20510
20511 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/, GroupLens} is a
20512 collaborative filtering system that helps you work together with other
20513 people to find the quality news articles out of the huge volume of
20514 news articles generated every day.
20515
20516 To accomplish this the GroupLens system combines your opinions about
20517 articles you have already read with the opinions of others who have done
20518 likewise and gives you a personalized prediction for each unread news
20519 article. Think of GroupLens as a matchmaker. GroupLens watches how you
20520 rate articles, and finds other people that rate articles the same way.
20521 Once it has found some people you agree with it tells you, in the form
20522 of a prediction, what they thought of the article. You can use this
20523 prediction to help you decide whether or not you want to read the
20524 article.
20525
20526 @menu
20527 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
20528 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
20529 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
20530 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
20531 @end menu
20532
20533
20534 @node Using GroupLens
20535 @subsection Using GroupLens
20536
20537 To use GroupLens you must register a pseudonym with your local
20538 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/bbb.html, Better Bit
20539 Bureau (BBB)} is the only better bit in town at the moment.
20540
20541 Once you have registered you'll need to set a couple of variables.
20542
20543 @table @code
20544
20545 @item gnus-use-grouplens
20546 @vindex gnus-use-grouplens
20547 Setting this variable to a non-@code{nil} value will make Gnus hook into
20548 all the relevant GroupLens functions.
20549
20550 @item grouplens-pseudonym
20551 @vindex grouplens-pseudonym
20552 This variable should be set to the pseudonym you got when registering
20553 with the Better Bit Bureau.
20554
20555 @item grouplens-newsgroups
20556 @vindex grouplens-newsgroups
20557 A list of groups that you want to get GroupLens predictions for.
20558
20559 @end table
20560
20561 That's the minimum of what you need to get up and running with GroupLens.
20562 Once you've registered, GroupLens will start giving you scores for
20563 articles based on the average of what other people think. But, to get
20564 the real benefit of GroupLens you need to start rating articles
20565 yourself. Then the scores GroupLens gives you will be personalized for
20566 you, based on how the people you usually agree with have already rated.
20567
20568
20569 @node Rating Articles
20570 @subsection Rating Articles
20571
20572 In GroupLens, an article is rated on a scale from 1 to 5, inclusive.
20573 Where 1 means something like this article is a waste of bandwidth and 5
20574 means that the article was really good. The basic question to ask
20575 yourself is, ``on a scale from 1 to 5 would I like to see more articles
20576 like this one?''
20577
20578 There are four ways to enter a rating for an article in GroupLens.
20579
20580 @table @kbd
20581
20582 @item r
20583 @kindex r (GroupLens)
20584 @findex bbb-summary-rate-article
20585 This function will prompt you for a rating on a scale of one to five.
20586
20587 @item k
20588 @kindex k (GroupLens)
20589 @findex grouplens-score-thread
20590 This function will prompt you for a rating, and rate all the articles in
20591 the thread. This is really useful for some of those long running giant
20592 threads in rec.humor.
20593
20594 @end table
20595
20596 The next two commands, @kbd{n} and @kbd{,} take a numerical prefix to be
20597 the score of the article you're reading.
20598
20599 @table @kbd
20600
20601 @item 1-5 n
20602 @kindex n (GroupLens)
20603 @findex grouplens-next-unread-article
20604 Rate the article and go to the next unread article.
20605
20606 @item 1-5 ,
20607 @kindex , (GroupLens)
20608 @findex grouplens-best-unread-article
20609 Rate the article and go to the next unread article with the highest score.
20610
20611 @end table
20612
20613 If you want to give the current article a score of 4 and then go to the
20614 next article, just type @kbd{4 n}.
20615
20616
20617 @node Displaying Predictions
20618 @subsection Displaying Predictions
20619
20620 GroupLens makes a prediction for you about how much you will like a
20621 news article. The predictions from GroupLens are on a scale from 1 to
20622 5, where 1 is the worst and 5 is the best. You can use the predictions
20623 from GroupLens in one of three ways controlled by the variable
20624 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring}.
20625
20626 @vindex gnus-grouplens-override-scoring
20627 There are three ways to display predictions in grouplens. You may
20628 choose to have the GroupLens scores contribute to, or override the
20629 regular Gnus scoring mechanism. override is the default; however, some
20630 people prefer to see the Gnus scores plus the grouplens scores. To get
20631 the separate scoring behavior you need to set
20632 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'separate}. To have the
20633 GroupLens predictions combined with the grouplens scores set it to
20634 @code{'override} and to combine the scores set
20635 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'combine}. When you use
20636 the combine option you will also want to set the values for
20637 @code{grouplens-prediction-offset} and
20638 @code{grouplens-score-scale-factor}.
20639
20640 @vindex grouplens-prediction-display
20641 In either case, GroupLens gives you a few choices for how you would like
20642 to see your predictions displayed. The display of predictions is
20643 controlled by the @code{grouplens-prediction-display} variable.
20644
20645 The following are valid values for that variable.
20646
20647 @table @code
20648 @item prediction-spot
20649 The higher the prediction, the further to the right an @samp{*} is
20650 displayed.
20651
20652 @item confidence-interval
20653 A numeric confidence interval.
20654
20655 @item prediction-bar
20656 The higher the prediction, the longer the bar.
20657
20658 @item confidence-bar
20659 Numerical confidence.
20660
20661 @item confidence-spot
20662 The spot gets bigger with more confidence.
20663
20664 @item prediction-num
20665 Plain-old numeric value.
20666
20667 @item confidence-plus-minus
20668 Prediction +/- confidence.
20669
20670 @end table
20671
20672
20673 @node GroupLens Variables
20674 @subsection GroupLens Variables
20675
20676 @table @code
20677
20678 @item gnus-summary-grouplens-line-format
20679 The summary line format used in GroupLens-enhanced summary buffers. It
20680 accepts the same specs as the normal summary line format (@pxref{Summary
20681 Buffer Lines}). The default is @samp{%U%R%z%l%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23n%]%)
20682 %s\n}.
20683
20684 @item grouplens-bbb-host
20685 Host running the bbbd server. @samp{grouplens.cs.umn.edu} is the
20686 default.
20687
20688 @item grouplens-bbb-port
20689 Port of the host running the bbbd server. The default is 9000.
20690
20691 @item grouplens-score-offset
20692 Offset the prediction by this value. In other words, subtract the
20693 prediction value by this number to arrive at the effective score. The
20694 default is 0.
20695
20696 @item grouplens-score-scale-factor
20697 This variable allows the user to magnify the effect of GroupLens scores.
20698 The scale factor is applied after the offset. The default is 1.
20699
20700 @end table
20701
20702
20703 @node Advanced Scoring
20704 @section Advanced Scoring
20705
20706 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
20707 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
20708 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
20709 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
20710 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
20711
20712 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
20713 scoring patterns.
20714
20715 @menu
20716 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
20717 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
20718 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
20719 @end menu
20720
20721
20722 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
20723 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
20724
20725 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
20726 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
20727 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
20728 non-@code{nil} value.
20729
20730 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
20731 operator, and various match operators.
20732
20733 Logical operators:
20734
20735 @table @code
20736 @item &
20737 @itemx and
20738 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20739 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
20740 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
20741 @code{true}.
20742
20743 @item |
20744 @itemx or
20745 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20746 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
20747 then this operator will return @code{false}.
20748
20749 @item !
20750 @itemx not
20751 @itemx ¬
20752 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
20753 logical negation of the value of its argument.
20754
20755 @end table
20756
20757 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
20758 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
20759 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
20760 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
20761 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
20762 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
20763 the ancestry you want to go.
20764
20765 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
20766 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
20767 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
20768 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
20769 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
20770
20771
20772 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
20773 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
20774
20775 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
20776 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
20777 of parentheses.
20778
20779 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
20780 when he's talking about Gnus:
20781
20782 @example
20783 @group
20784 ((&
20785 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20786 ("subject" "Gnus"))
20787 1000)
20788 @end group
20789 @end example
20790
20791 Quite simple, huh?
20792
20793 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
20794
20795 @example
20796 ((&
20797 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20798 (|
20799 ("subject" "Gnus")
20800 ("lines" 100 >)))
20801 1000)
20802 @end example
20803
20804 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
20805 really don't want to read what he's written:
20806
20807 @example
20808 ((&
20809 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20810 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigil Logge")))
20811 -100000)
20812 @end example
20813
20814 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
20815 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
20816 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
20817 very interesting:
20818
20819 @example
20820 ((&
20821 (1-
20822 (&
20823 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
20824 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
20825 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
20826 ("body" "white.*socks"))
20827 1000)
20828 @end example
20829
20830 Suppose you're reading a high volume group and you're only interested
20831 in replies. The plan is to score down all articles that don't have
20832 subject that begin with "Re:", "Fw:" or "Fwd:" and then score up all
20833 parents of articles that have subjects that begin with reply marks.
20834
20835 @example
20836 ((! ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20837 -200)
20838 ((1- ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20839 200)
20840 @end example
20841
20842 The possibilities are endless.
20843
20844 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
20845 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
20846
20847 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
20848 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
20849 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
20850 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
20851 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
20852 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
20853 @samp{subject}) first.
20854
20855 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
20856 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
20857 something like:
20858
20859 @example
20860 ...
20861 (1-
20862 (1-
20863 ("from" "lars")))
20864 ...
20865 @end example
20866
20867 Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
20868 current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
20869
20870 @example
20871 (1-
20872 (&
20873 ("from" "Lars")
20874 ("subject" "Gnus")))
20875 @end example
20876
20877 than it is to say:
20878
20879 @example
20880 (&
20881 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
20882 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
20883 @end example
20884
20885
20886 @node Score Decays
20887 @section Score Decays
20888 @cindex score decays
20889 @cindex decays
20890
20891 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
20892 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
20893 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
20894 use them in any sensible way.
20895
20896 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
20897 @findex gnus-decay-score
20898 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
20899 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
20900 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
20901 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
20902 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
20903 The decay itself if performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function}
20904 function, which is @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the
20905 definition of that function:
20906
20907 @lisp
20908 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
20909 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
20910 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
20911 (let ((n (- score
20912 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
20913 (min (abs score)
20914 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
20915 (* (abs score)
20916 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
20917 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
20918 ;; XEmacs' floor can handle only the floating point
20919 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
20920 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
20921 (string-to-number
20922 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
20923 (floor n))))
20924 @end lisp
20925
20926 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
20927 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
20928 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
20929 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
20930
20931 @enumerate
20932 @item
20933 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
20934
20935 @item
20936 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
20937
20938 @item
20939 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
20940 score.
20941 @end enumerate
20942
20943 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
20944 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
20945 the new score, which should be an integer.
20946
20947 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
20948 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
20949
20950 @iftex
20951 @iflatex
20952 @chapter Message
20953 @include message.texi
20954 @chapter Emacs MIME
20955 @include emacs-mime.texi
20956 @chapter Sieve
20957 @include sieve.texi
20958 @chapter PGG
20959 @include pgg.texi
20960 @end iflatex
20961 @end iftex
20962
20963 @node Various
20964 @chapter Various
20965
20966 @menu
20967 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
20968 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
20969 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
20970 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
20971 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
20972 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
20973 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
20974 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
20975 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
20976 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
20977 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
20978 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
20979 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
20980 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
20981 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
20982 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
20983 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
20984 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
20985 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
20986 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
20987 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
20988 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
20989 @end menu
20990
20991
20992 @node Process/Prefix
20993 @section Process/Prefix
20994 @cindex process/prefix convention
20995
20996 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
20997 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
20998
20999 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
21000 command to be performed on.
21001
21002 It goes like this:
21003
21004 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
21005 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
21006 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
21007 with the current one.
21008
21009 @vindex transient-mark-mode
21010 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
21011 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
21012
21013 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
21014 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
21015 the process mark.
21016
21017 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
21018 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
21019
21020 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
21021 are avoided.
21022
21023 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
21024 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
21025 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
21026 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
21027
21028 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
21029 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
21030 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
21031 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
21032 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
21033 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
21034 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
21035 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
21036
21037 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
21038 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
21039 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
21040 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
21041 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
21042
21043
21044 @node Interactive
21045 @section Interactive
21046 @cindex interaction
21047
21048 @table @code
21049
21050 @item gnus-novice-user
21051 @vindex gnus-novice-user
21052 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
21053 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
21054 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
21055 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
21056 default.
21057
21058 @item gnus-expert-user
21059 @vindex gnus-expert-user
21060 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
21061 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing, no
21062 matter how strange.
21063
21064 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
21065 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
21066 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
21067 is @code{t} by default.
21068
21069 @item gnus-interactive-exit
21070 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
21071 Require confirmation before exiting Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
21072 default.
21073 @end table
21074
21075
21076 @node Symbolic Prefixes
21077 @section Symbolic Prefixes
21078 @cindex symbolic prefixes
21079
21080 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
21081 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
21082 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
21083 rule of 900 to the current article.
21084
21085 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
21086 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
21087 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
21088 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
21089 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
21090 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
21091 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
21092
21093 @kindex M-i (Summary)
21094 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
21095 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
21096 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
21097 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
21098 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
21099 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
21100 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
21101 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
21102
21103 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
21104 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
21105 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
21106
21107 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
21108 Interactive}.
21109
21110
21111 @node Formatting Variables
21112 @section Formatting Variables
21113 @cindex formatting variables
21114
21115 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
21116 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
21117 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
21118 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
21119 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
21120 be annoyed by.
21121
21122 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
21123 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
21124 lots of percentages everywhere.
21125
21126 @menu
21127 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
21128 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
21129 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
21130 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
21131 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
21132 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
21133 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
21134 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
21135 @end menu
21136
21137 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
21138 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
21139 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
21140 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
21141 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
21142 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
21143 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
21144 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
21145
21146 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
21147 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
21148
21149 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
21150 @findex gnus-update-format
21151 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
21152 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
21153 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
21154 examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
21155
21156
21157
21158 @node Formatting Basics
21159 @subsection Formatting Basics
21160
21161 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
21162 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
21163 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
21164
21165 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
21166 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
21167 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
21168 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
21169 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
21170 the right instead.
21171
21172 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
21173 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
21174 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
21175 less than 4 characters wide.
21176
21177 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
21178 @samp{%&user-date;}.
21179
21180
21181 @node Mode Line Formatting
21182 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
21183
21184 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
21185 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
21186 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
21187 with the following two differences:
21188
21189 @enumerate
21190
21191 @item
21192 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
21193
21194 @item
21195 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
21196 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
21197 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
21198 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
21199 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
21200 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
21201 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
21202
21203 @end enumerate
21204
21205
21206 @node Advanced Formatting
21207 @subsection Advanced Formatting
21208
21209 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
21210 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
21211 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
21212 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
21213
21214 These are the valid modifiers:
21215
21216 @table @code
21217 @item pad
21218 @itemx pad-left
21219 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
21220 length.
21221
21222 @item pad-right
21223 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
21224 length.
21225
21226 @item max
21227 @itemx max-left
21228 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
21229
21230 @item max-right
21231 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
21232 length.
21233
21234 @item cut
21235 @itemx cut-left
21236 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
21237
21238 @item cut-right
21239 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
21240
21241 @item ignore
21242 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
21243
21244 @item form
21245 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
21246 used.
21247
21248 Here's an example:
21249
21250 @lisp
21251 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
21252 @end lisp
21253
21254 @end table
21255
21256 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
21257 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
21258 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
21259 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
21260 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
21261 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
21262 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
21263
21264 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
21265 last operation, padding.
21266
21267 If you use lots of these advanced thingies, you'll find that Gnus gets
21268 quite slow. This can be helped enormously by running @kbd{M-x
21269 gnus-compile} when you are satisfied with the look of your lines.
21270 @xref{Compilation}.
21271
21272
21273 @node User-Defined Specs
21274 @subsection User-Defined Specs
21275
21276 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
21277 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
21278 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
21279 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
21280 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
21281 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
21282 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
21283 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
21284 should protect against that.
21285
21286 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
21287 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
21288
21289 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
21290 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
21291 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
21292 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
21293 inserted.
21294
21295
21296 @node Formatting Fonts
21297 @subsection Formatting Fonts
21298
21299 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
21300 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
21301 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
21302 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
21303 over it.
21304
21305 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
21306 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
21307 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
21308 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
21309 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
21310 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
21311
21312 Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
21313 special @code{balloon-help} property set to
21314 @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
21315 @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
21316 variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
21317 return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
21318 set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
21319 refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
21320 (in GNU Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
21321 XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
21322 guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
21323 paragraph.)
21324
21325 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
21326
21327 @lisp
21328 ;; @r{Create three face types.}
21329 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
21330 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
21331
21332 ;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
21333 ;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
21334 ;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
21335 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
21336 ;; @r{Set the color.}
21337 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
21338 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
21339
21340 ;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
21341 (setq gnus-group-line-format
21342 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
21343 @end lisp
21344
21345 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
21346 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
21347
21348 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
21349 mode-line variables.
21350
21351 @node Positioning Point
21352 @subsection Positioning Point
21353
21354 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
21355 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
21356 line. You can customize this behavior in three different ways.
21357
21358 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
21359
21360 @findex gnus-goto-colon
21361 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
21362 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
21363
21364 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
21365 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
21366 put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
21367 place point there.
21368
21369
21370 @node Tabulation
21371 @subsection Tabulation
21372
21373 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
21374 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
21375 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
21376 about lining up the following text afterwards.
21377
21378 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
21379 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
21380
21381 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21382 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
21383 This is the soft tabulator.
21384
21385 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21386 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
21387 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
21388
21389
21390 @node Wide Characters
21391 @subsection Wide Characters
21392
21393 Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
21394 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
21395 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
21396
21397 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
21398 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
21399 these countries, that's not true.
21400
21401 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
21402 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
21403 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
21404 prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
21405 for Emacs.
21406
21407
21408 @node Window Layout
21409 @section Window Layout
21410 @cindex window layout
21411
21412 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
21413
21414 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
21415 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
21416 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
21417 @code{t} by default.
21418
21419 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
21420 glitches. Use at your own peril.
21421
21422 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
21423 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
21424 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
21425
21426 @lisp
21427 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)
21428 (if gnus-carpal (group-carpal 4))))
21429 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21430 (article 1.0))))
21431 @end lisp
21432
21433 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
21434 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
21435 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
21436 possible names is listed below.
21437
21438 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
21439 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example -
21440
21441 @lisp
21442 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21443 (article 1.0)))
21444 @end lisp
21445
21446 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
21447 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
21448 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
21449 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
21450 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
21451 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
21452 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
21453 size spec per split.
21454
21455 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
21456 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
21457 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e. is the third or
21458 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
21459 present) gets focus.
21460
21461 Here's a more complicated example:
21462
21463 @lisp
21464 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
21465 (summary 0.25 point)
21466 (if gnus-carpal (summary-carpal 4))
21467 (article 1.0)))
21468 @end lisp
21469
21470 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
21471 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
21472 occupy, not a percentage.
21473
21474 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
21475 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
21476 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
21477 be used as a split. This means that there will be three buffers if
21478 @code{gnus-carpal} is @code{nil}, and four buffers if @code{gnus-carpal}
21479 is non-@code{nil}.
21480
21481 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
21482
21483 @lisp
21484 (article (horizontal 1.0
21485 (vertical 0.5
21486 (group 1.0)
21487 (gnus-carpal 4))
21488 (vertical 1.0
21489 (summary 0.25 point)
21490 (summary-carpal 4)
21491 (article 1.0))))
21492 @end lisp
21493
21494 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
21495 @code{horizontal} thingie?
21496
21497 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
21498 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
21499 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
21500 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
21501 the screen is to be given to this strip.
21502
21503 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
21504 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
21505 lines from the splits.
21506
21507 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
21508 may look like:
21509
21510 @example
21511 @group
21512 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
21513 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
21514 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
21515 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
21516 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
21517 size = number | frame-params
21518 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
21519 @end group
21520 @end example
21521
21522 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
21523 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
21524 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
21525 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
21526
21527 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
21528 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
21529 @cindex window height
21530 @cindex window width
21531 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
21532 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
21533 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
21534 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
21535 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
21536 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
21537
21538 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
21539 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
21540 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
21541 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
21542
21543 @findex gnus-configure-frame
21544 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
21545 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
21546 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
21547 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
21548 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
21549 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
21550 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
21551 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
21552 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
21553 configuration list.
21554
21555 @lisp
21556 (gnus-configure-frame
21557 '(horizontal 1.0
21558 (vertical 10
21559 (group 1.0)
21560 (article 0.3 point))
21561 (vertical 1.0
21562 (article 1.0)
21563 (horizontal 4
21564 (group 1.0)
21565 (article 10)))))
21566 @end lisp
21567
21568 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
21569 @code{frame} split:
21570
21571 @lisp
21572 (gnus-configure-frame
21573 '(frame 1.0
21574 (vertical 1.0
21575 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
21576 (article 1.0))
21577 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
21578 (user-position . t)
21579 (left . -1) (top . 1))
21580 (picon 1.0))))
21581
21582 @end lisp
21583
21584 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
21585 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
21586 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
21587 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
21588 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
21589 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
21590 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
21591 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
21592 is such a plist.
21593 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
21594 be found in its default value.
21595
21596 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
21597 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
21598 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
21599 might be used:
21600
21601 @lisp
21602 (message (horizontal 1.0
21603 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
21604 (vertical 0.24
21605 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
21606 '(summary 0.5))
21607 (group 1.0))))
21608 @end lisp
21609
21610 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
21611 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
21612 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
21613
21614 @lisp
21615 (message
21616 (frame 1.0
21617 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
21618 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
21619 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
21620 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
21621 (name . "Message"))
21622 (message 1.0 point))))
21623 @end lisp
21624
21625 @findex gnus-add-configuration
21626 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
21627 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
21628 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
21629 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
21630
21631 @lisp
21632 (gnus-add-configuration
21633 '(article (vertical 1.0
21634 (group 4)
21635 (summary .25 point)
21636 (article 1.0))))
21637 @end lisp
21638
21639 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
21640 @file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
21641 Gnus has been loaded.
21642
21643 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
21644 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
21645 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
21646 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
21647 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
21648
21649 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
21650 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
21651 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
21652 windows resized.
21653
21654 @subsection Example Window Configurations
21655
21656 @itemize @bullet
21657 @item
21658 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
21659 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
21660
21661 @ifinfo
21662 @example
21663 +---+---------+
21664 | G | Summary |
21665 | r +---------+
21666 | o | |
21667 | u | Article |
21668 | p | |
21669 +---+---------+
21670 @end example
21671 @end ifinfo
21672
21673 @lisp
21674 (gnus-add-configuration
21675 '(article
21676 (horizontal 1.0
21677 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
21678 (vertical 1.0
21679 (summary 0.16 point)
21680 (article 1.0)))))
21681
21682 (gnus-add-configuration
21683 '(summary
21684 (horizontal 1.0
21685 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
21686 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
21687 @end lisp
21688
21689 @end itemize
21690
21691
21692 @node Faces and Fonts
21693 @section Faces and Fonts
21694 @cindex faces
21695 @cindex fonts
21696 @cindex colors
21697
21698 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
21699 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
21700 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
21701 interface.
21702
21703
21704 @node Compilation
21705 @section Compilation
21706 @cindex compilation
21707 @cindex byte-compilation
21708
21709 @findex gnus-compile
21710
21711 Remember all those line format specification variables?
21712 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}, @code{gnus-group-line-format}, and so
21713 on. Now, Gnus will of course heed whatever these variables are, but,
21714 unfortunately, changing them will mean a quite significant slow-down.
21715 (The default values of these variables have byte-compiled functions
21716 associated with them, while the user-generated versions do not, of
21717 course.)
21718
21719 To help with this, you can run @kbd{M-x gnus-compile} after you've
21720 fiddled around with the variables and feel that you're (kind of)
21721 satisfied. This will result in the new specs being byte-compiled, and
21722 you'll get top speed again. Gnus will save these compiled specs in the
21723 @file{.newsrc.eld} file. (User-defined functions aren't compiled by
21724 this function, though---you should compile them yourself by sticking
21725 them into the @file{~/.gnus.el} file and byte-compiling that file.)
21726
21727
21728 @node Mode Lines
21729 @section Mode Lines
21730 @cindex mode lines
21731
21732 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
21733 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
21734 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
21735 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
21736 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
21737 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
21738 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
21739 quicker.
21740
21741 @cindex display-time
21742
21743 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
21744 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
21745 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
21746 to display (e.g. the subject of the article) is often longer than the
21747 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
21748 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
21749 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
21750 additional elements on the mode line (e.g. a clock), you should modify
21751 this variable:
21752
21753 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
21754 @lisp
21755 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
21756 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
21757 (+ 21
21758 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
21759 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
21760 (length display-time-string)))))
21761 @end lisp
21762
21763 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
21764 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
21765 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
21766 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
21767 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
21768
21769
21770 @node Highlighting and Menus
21771 @section Highlighting and Menus
21772 @cindex visual
21773 @cindex highlighting
21774 @cindex menus
21775
21776 @vindex gnus-visual
21777 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
21778 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
21779 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
21780 file.
21781
21782 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
21783 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
21784
21785 @table @code
21786 @item group-highlight
21787 Do highlights in the group buffer.
21788 @item summary-highlight
21789 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
21790 @item article-highlight
21791 Do highlights in the article buffer.
21792 @item highlight
21793 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
21794 @item group-menu
21795 Create menus in the group buffer.
21796 @item summary-menu
21797 Create menus in the summary buffers.
21798 @item article-menu
21799 Create menus in the article buffer.
21800 @item browse-menu
21801 Create menus in the browse buffer.
21802 @item server-menu
21803 Create menus in the server buffer.
21804 @item score-menu
21805 Create menus in the score buffers.
21806 @item menu
21807 Create menus in all buffers.
21808 @end table
21809
21810 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
21811 buffers, you could say something like:
21812
21813 @lisp
21814 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
21815 @end lisp
21816
21817 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
21818
21819 @lisp
21820 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
21821 @end lisp
21822
21823 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
21824 in all Gnus buffers.
21825
21826 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
21827
21828 @table @code
21829 @item gnus-mouse-face
21830 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
21831 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
21832 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
21833
21834 @end table
21835
21836 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
21837
21838 @table @code
21839
21840 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
21841 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
21842 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
21843
21844 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
21845 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
21846 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
21847
21848 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
21849 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
21850 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
21851
21852 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
21853 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
21854 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
21855
21856 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
21857 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
21858 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
21859
21860 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
21861 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
21862 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
21863
21864 @end table
21865
21866
21867 @node Buttons
21868 @section Buttons
21869 @cindex buttons
21870 @cindex mouse
21871 @cindex click
21872
21873 Those new-fangled @dfn{mouse} contraptions is very popular with the
21874 young, hep kids who don't want to learn the proper way to do things
21875 these days. Why, I remember way back in the summer of '89, when I was
21876 using Emacs on a Tops 20 system. Three hundred users on one single
21877 machine, and every user was running Simula compilers. Bah!
21878
21879 Right.
21880
21881 @vindex gnus-carpal
21882 Well, you can make Gnus display bufferfuls of buttons you can click to
21883 do anything by setting @code{gnus-carpal} to @code{t}. Pretty simple,
21884 really. Tell the chiropractor I sent you.
21885
21886
21887 @table @code
21888
21889 @item gnus-carpal-mode-hook
21890 @vindex gnus-carpal-mode-hook
21891 Hook run in all carpal mode buffers.
21892
21893 @item gnus-carpal-button-face
21894 @vindex gnus-carpal-button-face
21895 Face used on buttons.
21896
21897 @item gnus-carpal-header-face
21898 @vindex gnus-carpal-header-face
21899 Face used on carpal buffer headers.
21900
21901 @item gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
21902 @vindex gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
21903 Buttons in the group buffer.
21904
21905 @item gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
21906 @vindex gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
21907 Buttons in the summary buffer.
21908
21909 @item gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
21910 @vindex gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
21911 Buttons in the server buffer.
21912
21913 @item gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
21914 @vindex gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
21915 Buttons in the browse buffer.
21916 @end table
21917
21918 All the @code{buttons} variables are lists. The elements in these list
21919 are either cons cells where the @code{car} contains a text to be displayed and
21920 the @code{cdr} contains a function symbol, or a simple string.
21921
21922
21923 @node Daemons
21924 @section Daemons
21925 @cindex demons
21926 @cindex daemons
21927
21928 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
21929 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
21930 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
21931 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
21932 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
21933
21934 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
21935 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
21936 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
21937
21938 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
21939 been idle for thirty minutes:
21940
21941 @lisp
21942 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
21943 @end lisp
21944
21945 Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
21946 Emacs is idle:
21947
21948 @lisp
21949 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
21950 @end lisp
21951
21952 This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
21953 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
21954 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
21955
21956 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
21957 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
21958 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
21959 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
21960
21961 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
21962 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
21963 @var{idle} minutes.
21964
21965 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
21966 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
21967 minutes.
21968
21969 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
21970 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
21971 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
21972
21973 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
21974 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
21975 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
21976 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
21977
21978 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
21979 your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
21980
21981 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
21982 @lisp
21983 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
21984 @end lisp
21985
21986 @findex gnus-demon-add-nocem
21987 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
21988 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
21989 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
21990 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
21991 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
21992 @code{gnus-demon-add-nocem}, @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
21993 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
21994 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
21995 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
21996 @file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
21997
21998 @findex gnus-demon-init
21999 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
22000 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
22001 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
22002 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
22003 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
22004
22005 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
22006 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
22007 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
22008 behave.
22009
22010
22011 @node NoCeM
22012 @section NoCeM
22013 @cindex nocem
22014 @cindex spam
22015
22016 @dfn{Spamming} is posting the same article lots and lots of times.
22017 Spamming is bad. Spamming is evil.
22018
22019 Spamming is usually canceled within a day or so by various anti-spamming
22020 agencies. These agencies usually also send out @dfn{NoCeM} messages.
22021 NoCeM is pronounced ``no see-'em'', and means what the name
22022 implies---these are messages that make the offending articles, like, go
22023 away.
22024
22025 What use are these NoCeM messages if the articles are canceled anyway?
22026 Some sites do not honor cancel messages and some sites just honor cancels
22027 from a select few people. Then you may wish to make use of the NoCeM
22028 messages, which are distributed in the @samp{alt.nocem.misc} newsgroup.
22029
22030 Gnus can read and parse the messages in this group automatically, and
22031 this will make spam disappear.
22032
22033 There are some variables to customize, of course:
22034
22035 @table @code
22036 @item gnus-use-nocem
22037 @vindex gnus-use-nocem
22038 Set this variable to @code{t} to set the ball rolling. It is @code{nil}
22039 by default.
22040
22041 You can also set this variable to a positive number as a group level.
22042 In that case, Gnus scans NoCeM messages when checking new news if this
22043 value is not exceeding a group level that you specify as the prefix
22044 argument to some commands, e.g. @code{gnus},
22045 @code{gnus-group-get-new-news}, etc. Otherwise, Gnus does not scan
22046 NoCeM messages if you specify a group level to those commands. For
22047 example, if you use 1 or 2 on the mail groups and the levels on the news
22048 groups remain the default, 3 is the best choice.
22049
22050 @item gnus-nocem-groups
22051 @vindex gnus-nocem-groups
22052 Gnus will look for NoCeM messages in the groups in this list. The
22053 default is
22054 @lisp
22055 ("news.lists.filters" "news.admin.net-abuse.bulletins"
22056 "alt.nocem.misc" "news.admin.net-abuse.announce")
22057 @end lisp
22058
22059 @item gnus-nocem-issuers
22060 @vindex gnus-nocem-issuers
22061 There are many people issuing NoCeM messages. This list says what
22062 people you want to listen to. The default is
22063 @lisp
22064 ("Automoose-1" "clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca"
22065 "cosmo.roadkill" "SpamHippo" "hweede@@snafu.de")
22066 @end lisp
22067 fine, upstanding citizens all of them.
22068
22069 Known despammers that you can put in this list are listed at@*
22070 @uref{http://www.xs4all.nl/~rosalind/nocemreg/nocemreg.html}.
22071
22072 You do not have to heed NoCeM messages from all these people---just the
22073 ones you want to listen to. You also don't have to accept all NoCeM
22074 messages from the people you like. Each NoCeM message has a @dfn{type}
22075 header that gives the message a (more or less, usually less) rigorous
22076 definition. Common types are @samp{spam}, @samp{spew}, @samp{mmf},
22077 @samp{binary}, and @samp{troll}. To specify this, you have to use
22078 @code{(@var{issuer} @var{conditions} @dots{})} elements in the list.
22079 Each condition is either a string (which is a regexp that matches types
22080 you want to use) or a list on the form @code{(not @var{string})}, where
22081 @var{string} is a regexp that matches types you don't want to use.
22082
22083 For instance, if you want all NoCeM messages from Chris Lewis except his
22084 @samp{troll} messages, you'd say:
22085
22086 @lisp
22087 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" ".*" (not "troll"))
22088 @end lisp
22089
22090 On the other hand, if you just want nothing but his @samp{spam} and
22091 @samp{spew} messages, you'd say:
22092
22093 @lisp
22094 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" (not ".*") "spew" "spam")
22095 @end lisp
22096
22097 The specs are applied left-to-right.
22098
22099
22100 @item gnus-nocem-verifyer
22101 @vindex gnus-nocem-verifyer
22102 @findex pgg-verify
22103 This should be a function for verifying that the NoCeM issuer is who she
22104 says she is. The default is @code{pgg-verify}, which returns
22105 non-@code{nil} if the verification is successful, otherwise (including
22106 the case the NoCeM message was not signed) returns @code{nil}. If this
22107 is too slow and you don't care for verification (which may be dangerous),
22108 you can set this variable to @code{nil}.
22109
22110 Formerly the default was @code{mc-verify}, which is a Mailcrypt
22111 function. While you can still use it, you can change it into
22112 @code{pgg-verify} running with GnuPG if you are willing to add the
22113 @acronym{PGP} public keys to GnuPG's keyring.
22114
22115 @item gnus-nocem-directory
22116 @vindex gnus-nocem-directory
22117 This is where Gnus will store its NoCeM cache files. The default is@*
22118 @file{~/News/NoCeM/}.
22119
22120 @item gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
22121 @vindex gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
22122 The number of days before removing old NoCeM entries from the cache.
22123 The default is 15. If you make it shorter Gnus will be faster, but you
22124 might then see old spam.
22125
22126 @item gnus-nocem-check-from
22127 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-from
22128 Non-@code{nil} means check for valid issuers in message bodies.
22129 Otherwise don't bother fetching articles unless their author matches a
22130 valid issuer; that is much faster if you are selective about the
22131 issuers.
22132
22133 @item gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
22134 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
22135 If non-@code{nil}, the maximum number of articles to check in any NoCeM
22136 group. NoCeM groups can be huge and very slow to process.
22137
22138 @end table
22139
22140 Using NoCeM could potentially be a memory hog. If you have many living
22141 (i. e., subscribed or unsubscribed groups), your Emacs process will grow
22142 big. If this is a problem, you should kill off all (or most) of your
22143 unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Subscription Commands}).
22144
22145
22146 @node Undo
22147 @section Undo
22148 @cindex undo
22149
22150 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
22151 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
22152 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
22153
22154 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
22155 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
22156 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
22157 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
22158 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
22159 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
22160 @code{undo} function.
22161
22162 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
22163 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
22164 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
22165 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
22166 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
22167 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
22168 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
22169 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
22170 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
22171 never be totally undoable.
22172
22173 @findex gnus-undo-mode
22174 @vindex gnus-use-undo
22175 @findex gnus-undo
22176 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
22177 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
22178 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
22179 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
22180 command.
22181
22182
22183 @node Predicate Specifiers
22184 @section Predicate Specifiers
22185 @cindex predicate specifiers
22186
22187 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
22188 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
22189 to type all that much.
22190
22191 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
22192
22193 Here's an example:
22194
22195 @lisp
22196 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
22197 gnus-article-unread-p)
22198 @end lisp
22199
22200 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
22201 functions all take one parameter.
22202
22203 @findex gnus-make-predicate
22204 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
22205 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
22206 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
22207 specifier.
22208
22209
22210 @node Moderation
22211 @section Moderation
22212 @cindex moderation
22213
22214 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
22215 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
22216 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
22217 get a copy.
22218
22219 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
22220 buffers. Put
22221
22222 @lisp
22223 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
22224 @end lisp
22225
22226 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
22227
22228 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
22229 supposed to work:
22230
22231 @enumerate
22232 @item
22233 You split your incoming mail by matching on
22234 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
22235 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
22236
22237 @item
22238 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
22239 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
22240
22241 @item
22242 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
22243 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
22244 @kbd{c} command.
22245 @end enumerate
22246
22247 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
22248
22249 @lisp
22250 (setq gnus-moderated-list
22251 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
22252 @end lisp
22253
22254
22255 @node Fetching a Group
22256 @section Fetching a Group
22257 @cindex fetching a group
22258
22259 @findex gnus-fetch-group
22260 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
22261 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
22262 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
22263 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
22264 It takes the group name as a parameter.
22265
22266
22267 @node Image Enhancements
22268 @section Image Enhancements
22269
22270 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
22271 support images, Emacs 22 does.} and up, are able to display pictures and
22272 stuff, so Gnus has taken advantage of that.
22273
22274 @menu
22275 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
22276 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
22277 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
22278 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
22279 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
22280 @end menu
22281
22282
22283 @node X-Face
22284 @subsection X-Face
22285 @cindex x-face
22286
22287 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
22288 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
22289 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
22290 readers.
22291
22292 @cindex x-face
22293 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
22294 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
22295 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
22296 @iftex
22297 @iflatex
22298 \include{xface}
22299 @end iflatex
22300 @end iftex
22301 @c @anchor{X-Face}
22302
22303 Viewing an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
22304 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions has), or that you
22305 have suitable conversion or display programs installed. If your Emacs
22306 has image support the default action is to display the face before the
22307 @code{From} header. If there's no native @code{X-Face} support, Gnus
22308 will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using external programs
22309 from the @code{pbmplus} package and friends, see below. For XEmacs it's
22310 faster if XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support. The
22311 default action under Emacs without image support is to fork off the
22312 @code{display} program.
22313
22314 On a GNU/Linux system, the @code{display} program is included in the
22315 ImageMagick package. For external conversion programs look for packages
22316 with names like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.
22317 On Windows, you may use the packages @code{netpbm} and @code{compface}
22318 from @url{http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net}. You need to add the
22319 @code{bin} directory to your @code{PATH} environment variable.
22320 @c In fact only the following DLLs and binaries seem to be required:
22321 @c compface1.dll uncompface.exe libnetpbm10.dll icontopbm.exe
22322
22323 The variable @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} controls which programs
22324 are used to display the @code{X-Face} header. If this variable is a
22325 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
22326 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
22327 If @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches the
22328 @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
22329
22330 (Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
22331 @code{xface}).
22332
22333 @noindent
22334 Face and variable:
22335
22336 @table @code
22337 @item gnus-x-face
22338 @vindex gnus-x-face
22339 Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
22340 foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
22341 default colors are black and white.
22342 @end table
22343
22344 If you use posting styles, you can use an @code{x-face-file} entry in
22345 @code{gnus-posting-styles}, @xref{Posting Styles}. If you don't, Gnus
22346 provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow easier
22347 insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages. You also need the
22348 above mentioned ImageMagick, netpbm or other image conversion packages
22349 (depending the values of the variables below) for these functions.
22350
22351 @findex gnus-random-x-face
22352 @vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
22353 @vindex gnus-x-face-directory
22354 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
22355 @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
22356 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
22357 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
22358 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
22359 header data as a string.
22360
22361 @findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
22362 @code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
22363 @code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
22364 randomly generated data.
22365
22366 @findex gnus-x-face-from-file
22367 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
22368 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
22369 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
22370 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
22371
22372 Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
22373 like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22374
22375 @lisp
22376 (setq message-required-news-headers
22377 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22378 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
22379 @end lisp
22380
22381 Using the last function would be something like this:
22382
22383 @lisp
22384 (setq message-required-news-headers
22385 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22386 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
22387 (gnus-x-face-from-file
22388 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
22389 @end lisp
22390
22391
22392 @node Face
22393 @subsection Face
22394 @cindex face
22395
22396 @c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces' implementations should really be harmonized.
22397
22398 @code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
22399 ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
22400 represent the author of the message.
22401
22402 @cindex face
22403 @findex gnus-article-display-face
22404 The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
22405 See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
22406 specifications.
22407
22408 Viewing an @code{Face} header requires an Emacs that is able to display
22409 PNG images.
22410 @c Maybe add this:
22411 @c (if (featurep 'xemacs)
22412 @c (featurep 'png)
22413 @c (image-type-available-p 'png))
22414
22415 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
22416 easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
22417
22418 @findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
22419 @code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
22420 726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
22421
22422 @findex gnus-face-from-file
22423 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
22424 @code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
22425 converts the file to Face format by using the
22426 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
22427
22428 Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
22429 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22430
22431 @lisp
22432 (setq message-required-news-headers
22433 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22434 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
22435 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
22436 @end lisp
22437
22438
22439 @node Smileys
22440 @subsection Smileys
22441 @cindex smileys
22442
22443 @iftex
22444 @iflatex
22445 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
22446 \input{smiley}
22447 @end iflatex
22448 @end iftex
22449
22450 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
22451 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
22452
22453 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
22454 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22455
22456 @lisp
22457 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
22458 @end lisp
22459
22460 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
22461 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
22462 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
22463 text and maps that to file names.
22464
22465 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
22466 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
22467 variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
22468 the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
22469 the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
22470 displayed.
22471
22472 The following variables customize where Smiley will look for these
22473 files:
22474
22475 @table @code
22476
22477 @item smiley-data-directory
22478 @vindex smiley-data-directory
22479 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files.
22480
22481 @item gnus-smiley-file-types
22482 @vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
22483 List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
22484
22485 @end table
22486
22487
22488 @node Picons
22489 @subsection Picons
22490
22491 @iftex
22492 @iflatex
22493 \include{picons}
22494 @end iflatex
22495 @end iftex
22496
22497 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
22498 good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
22499 over your shoulder as you read news.
22500
22501 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
22502
22503 @iftex
22504 @iflatex
22505 \margindex{}
22506 @end iflatex
22507 @end iftex
22508
22509 @quotation
22510 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
22511 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
22512 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
22513 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
22514 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
22515 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
22516 @code{GIF} formats.
22517 @end quotation
22518
22519 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
22520 For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
22521 point your Web browser at
22522 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
22523
22524 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
22525 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
22526
22527 To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
22528 @code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
22529 Picons databases.
22530
22531 The following variables offer control over where things are located.
22532
22533 @table @code
22534
22535 @item gnus-picon-databases
22536 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
22537 The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
22538 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
22539 subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
22540 "/usr/local/faces")}.
22541
22542 @item gnus-picon-news-directories
22543 @vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
22544 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
22545 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
22546
22547 @item gnus-picon-user-directories
22548 @vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
22549 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
22550 faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
22551
22552 @item gnus-picon-domain-directories
22553 @vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
22554 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
22555 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
22556 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
22557
22558 @item gnus-picon-file-types
22559 @vindex gnus-picon-file-types
22560 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
22561 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
22562
22563 @end table
22564
22565
22566 @node XVarious
22567 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
22568
22569 @table @code
22570 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
22571 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
22572 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
22573 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
22574 unusual directory structure.
22575
22576 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
22577 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
22578 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
22579 default.
22580
22581 @end table
22582
22583 @subsubsection Toolbar
22584
22585 @table @code
22586
22587 @item gnus-use-toolbar
22588 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
22589 This variable specifies the position to display the toolbar. If
22590 @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If it is non-@code{nil}, it should
22591 be one of the symbols @code{default}, @code{top}, @code{bottom},
22592 @code{right}, and @code{left}. @code{default} means to use the default
22593 toolbar, the rest mean to display the toolbar on the place which those
22594 names show. The default is @code{default}.
22595
22596 @item gnus-toolbar-thickness
22597 @vindex gnus-toolbar-thickness
22598 Cons of the height and the width specifying the thickness of a toolbar.
22599 The height is used for the toolbar displayed on the top or the bottom,
22600 the width is used for the toolbar displayed on the right or the left.
22601 The default is that of the default toolbar.
22602
22603 @item gnus-group-toolbar
22604 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
22605 The toolbar in the group buffer.
22606
22607 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
22608 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
22609 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
22610
22611 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
22612 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
22613 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
22614
22615 @end table
22616
22617 @iftex
22618 @iflatex
22619 \margindex{}
22620 @end iflatex
22621 @end iftex
22622
22623
22624 @node Fuzzy Matching
22625 @section Fuzzy Matching
22626 @cindex fuzzy matching
22627
22628 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
22629 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
22630
22631 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
22632 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
22633 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
22634
22635 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
22636 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
22637 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
22638 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
22639 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
22640
22641
22642 @node Thwarting Email Spam
22643 @section Thwarting Email Spam
22644 @cindex email spam
22645 @cindex spam
22646 @cindex UCE
22647 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22648
22649 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
22650 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
22651 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
22652 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
22653 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
22654 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
22655 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
22656 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
22657 in the end.
22658
22659 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
22660 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
22661 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
22662 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
22663 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
22664 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
22665
22666 This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
22667
22668 @menu
22669 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
22670 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
22671 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
22672 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
22673 @end menu
22674
22675 @node The problem of spam
22676 @subsection The problem of spam
22677 @cindex email spam
22678 @cindex spam filtering approaches
22679 @cindex filtering approaches, spam
22680 @cindex UCE
22681 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22682
22683 First, some background on spam.
22684
22685 If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
22686 termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
22687 exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
22688 so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
22689 make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
22690 common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
22691 further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
22692 but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
22693 @emph{morons} are in common use as well.
22694
22695 Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
22696 dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
22697 example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
22698 unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
22699 their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
22700 of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
22701 be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
22702 through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
22703 requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
22704 and processing.
22705
22706 The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
22707 server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
22708 messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
22709 @samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
22710 discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
22711 lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
22712 from Bulgarian IPs.
22713
22714 This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
22715 risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
22716 etc.) or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.) from contacting
22717 you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
22718
22719 In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
22720 been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
22721 words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
22722 cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
22723
22724 Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
22725 processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
22726 @var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
22727 Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
22728 @var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
22729 database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
22730 of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
22731 of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
22732 spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
22733
22734 Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
22735 a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
22736 fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
22737 spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
22738 well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
22739 sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
22740 down for some time because of the incident.
22741
22742 The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
22743 based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
22744 the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
22745 words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
22746 analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
22747 classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
22748 run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
22749 to store the database of spam analysis. Statistical analysis on the
22750 server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
22751 user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
22752 the server that it has misclassified mail.
22753
22754 Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
22755 magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
22756 Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
22757 because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
22758 are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
22759 idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
22760 a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
22761 spam plague.
22762
22763 @node Anti-Spam Basics
22764 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
22765 @cindex email spam
22766 @cindex spam
22767 @cindex UCE
22768 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22769
22770 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
22771 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
22772
22773 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
22774 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
22775 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
22776 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
22777 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
22778 part of the mail address.)
22779
22780 @lisp
22781 (setq message-default-news-headers
22782 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
22783 @end lisp
22784
22785 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
22786 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
22787
22788 @lisp
22789 (...
22790 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
22791 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
22792 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
22793 "spam"))
22794 ...)
22795 @end lisp
22796
22797 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
22798 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
22799 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
22800 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
22801
22802 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
22803 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
22804 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
22805 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
22806 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
22807 your fancy split rule in this way:
22808
22809 @lisp
22810 (
22811 ...
22812 (to "larsi" "misc")
22813 "spam")
22814 @end lisp
22815
22816 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
22817 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
22818 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
22819 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
22820 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
22821
22822 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
22823 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
22824 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
22825 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
22826
22827 Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
22828
22829
22830 @node SpamAssassin
22831 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
22832 @cindex SpamAssassin
22833 @cindex Vipul's Razor
22834 @cindex DCC
22835
22836 The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
22837 avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
22838 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
22839 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
22840 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
22841 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
22842 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
22843
22844 Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
22845 which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
22846 the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
22847 recipes.
22848
22849 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
22850 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
22851 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
22852 Specifiers}) follow.
22853
22854 @lisp
22855 (setq mail-sources
22856 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
22857 (pop :user "jrl"
22858 :server "pophost"
22859 :postscript
22860 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
22861 @end lisp
22862
22863 Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
22864 the mail contain e.g.@: a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
22865 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
22866
22867 @lisp
22868 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
22869 ...))
22870 @end lisp
22871
22872 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
22873
22874 @lisp
22875 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
22876 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
22877 ...))
22878 @end lisp
22879
22880 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
22881 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
22882 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
22883 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
22884
22885 @lisp
22886 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
22887 ...))
22888 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
22889 (save-excursion
22890 (save-restriction
22891 (widen)
22892 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
22893 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
22894 "spam"))))
22895 @end lisp
22896
22897 Note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will not be
22898 downloaded by default. You need to set
22899 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
22900 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
22901
22902 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
22903 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
22904 spam. And here is the nifty function:
22905
22906 @lisp
22907 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
22908 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
22909 (interactive)
22910 (gnus-summary-show-raw-article)
22911 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d")
22912 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
22913 @end lisp
22914
22915 @node Hashcash
22916 @subsection Hashcash
22917 @cindex hashcash
22918
22919 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
22920 costly for each message they send. This has the obvious drawback that
22921 you cannot rely on everyone in the world using this technique,
22922 since it is not part of the Internet standards, but it may be useful
22923 in smaller communities.
22924
22925 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
22926 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
22927 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
22928 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
22929 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
22930 instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
22931 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
22932 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
22933 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
22934 one of them separately.
22935
22936 @cindex X-Hashcash
22937 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
22938 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
22939 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:}
22940 header. For more details, and for the external application
22941 @code{hashcash} you need to install to use this feature, see
22942 @uref{http://www.cypherspace.org/~adam/hashcash/}. Even more
22943 information can be found at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
22944
22945 If you wish to call hashcash for each message you send, say something
22946 like:
22947
22948 @lisp
22949 (require 'hashcash)
22950 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'mail-add-payment)
22951 @end lisp
22952
22953 The @file{hashcash.el} library can be found in the Gnus development
22954 contrib directory or at
22955 @uref{http://users.actrix.gen.nz/mycroft/hashcash.el}.
22956
22957 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
22958
22959 @table @code
22960
22961 @item hashcash-default-payment
22962 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
22963 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
22964 should consist of. By default this is 0, meaning nothing will be
22965 done. Suggested useful values include 17 to 29.
22966
22967 @item hashcash-payment-alist
22968 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
22969 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
22970 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
22971 @var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
22972 or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
22973 that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
22974 @var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
22975 (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
22976
22977 @item hashcash
22978 @vindex hashcash
22979 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed.
22980
22981 @end table
22982
22983 Currently there is no built in functionality in Gnus to verify
22984 hashcash cookies, it is expected that this is performed by your hand
22985 customized mail filtering scripts. Improvements in this area would be
22986 a useful contribution, however.
22987
22988 @node Spam Package
22989 @section Spam Package
22990 @cindex spam filtering
22991 @cindex spam
22992
22993 The Spam package provides Gnus with a centralized mechanism for
22994 detecting and filtering spam. It filters new mail, and processes
22995 messages according to whether they are spam or ham. (@dfn{Ham} is the
22996 name used throughout this manual to indicate non-spam messages.)
22997
22998 @menu
22999 * Spam Package Introduction::
23000 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
23001 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
23002 * Spam and Ham Processors::
23003 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
23004 * Spam Back Ends::
23005 * Extending the Spam package::
23006 * Spam Statistics Package::
23007 @end menu
23008
23009 @node Spam Package Introduction
23010 @subsection Spam Package Introduction
23011 @cindex spam filtering
23012 @cindex spam filtering sequence of events
23013 @cindex spam
23014
23015 You must read this section to understand how the Spam package works.
23016 Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
23017
23018 @cindex spam-initialize
23019 @vindex spam-use-stat
23020 To use the Spam package, you @strong{must} first run the function
23021 @code{spam-initialize}:
23022
23023 @example
23024 (spam-initialize)
23025 @end example
23026
23027 This autoloads @code{spam.el} and installs the various hooks necessary
23028 to let the Spam package do its job. In order to make use of the Spam
23029 package, you have to set up certain group parameters and variables,
23030 which we will describe below. All of the variables controlling the
23031 Spam package can be found in the @samp{spam} customization group.
23032
23033 There are two ``contact points'' between the Spam package and the rest
23034 of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and leaving a group.
23035
23036 Checking new mail for spam is done in one of two ways: while splitting
23037 incoming mail, or when you enter a group.
23038
23039 The first way, checking for spam while splitting incoming mail, is
23040 suited to mail back ends such as @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap}, where
23041 new mail appears in a single spool file. The Spam package processes
23042 incoming mail, and sends mail considered to be spam to a designated
23043 ``spam'' group. @xref{Filtering Incoming Mail}.
23044
23045 The second way is suited to back ends such as @code{nntp}, which have
23046 no incoming mail spool, or back ends where the server is in charge of
23047 splitting incoming mail. In this case, when you enter a Gnus group,
23048 the unseen or unread messages in that group are checked for spam.
23049 Detected spam messages are marked as spam. @xref{Detecting Spam in
23050 Groups}.
23051
23052 @cindex spam back ends
23053 In either case, you have to tell the Spam package what method to use
23054 to detect spam messages. There are several methods, or @dfn{spam back
23055 ends} (not to be confused with Gnus back ends!) to choose from: spam
23056 ``blacklists'' and ``whitelists'', dictionary-based filters, and so
23057 forth. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
23058
23059 In the Gnus summary buffer, messages that have been identified as spam
23060 always appear with a @samp{$} symbol.
23061
23062 The Spam package divides Gnus groups into three categories: ham
23063 groups, spam groups, and unclassified groups. You should mark each of
23064 the groups you subscribe to as either a ham group or a spam group,
23065 using the @code{spam-contents} group parameter (@pxref{Group
23066 Parameters}). Spam groups have a special property: when you enter a
23067 spam group, all unseen articles are marked as spam. Thus, mail split
23068 into a spam group is automatically marked as spam.
23069
23070 Identifying spam messages is only half of the Spam package's job. The
23071 second half comes into play whenever you exit a group buffer. At this
23072 point, the Spam package does several things:
23073
23074 First, it calls @dfn{spam and ham processors} to process the articles
23075 according to whether they are spam or ham. There is a pair of spam
23076 and ham processors associated with each spam back end, and what the
23077 processors do depends on the back end. At present, the main role of
23078 spam and ham processors is for dictionary-based spam filters: they add
23079 the contents of the messages in the group to the filter's dictionary,
23080 to improve its ability to detect future spam. The @code{spam-process}
23081 group parameter specifies what spam processors to use. @xref{Spam and
23082 Ham Processors}.
23083
23084 If the spam filter failed to mark a spam message, you can mark it
23085 yourself, so that the message is processed as spam when you exit the
23086 group:
23087
23088 @table @kbd
23089 @item M-d
23090 @itemx M s x
23091 @itemx S x
23092 @kindex M-d
23093 @kindex S x
23094 @kindex M s x
23095 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
23096 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
23097 Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark
23098 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}).
23099 @end table
23100
23101 @noindent
23102 Similarly, you can unmark an article if it has been erroneously marked
23103 as spam. @xref{Setting Marks}.
23104
23105 Normally, a ham message found in a non-ham group is not processed as
23106 ham---the rationale is that it should be moved into a ham group for
23107 further processing (see below). However, you can force these articles
23108 to be processed as ham by setting
23109 @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
23110 @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups}.
23111
23112 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
23113 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
23114 The second thing that the Spam package does when you exit a group is
23115 to move ham articles out of spam groups, and spam articles out of ham
23116 groups. Ham in a spam group is moved to the group specified by the
23117 variable @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}, or the group parameter
23118 @code{ham-process-destination}. Spam in a ham group is moved to the
23119 group specified by the variable @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations},
23120 or the group parameter @code{spam-process-destination}. If these
23121 variables are not set, the articles are left in their current group.
23122 If an article cannot be moved (e.g., with a read-only backend such
23123 as @acronym{NNTP}), it is copied.
23124
23125 If an article is moved to another group, it is processed again when
23126 you visit the new group. Normally, this is not a problem, but if you
23127 want each article to be processed only once, load the
23128 @code{gnus-registry.el} package and set the variable
23129 @code{spam-log-to-registry} to @code{t}. @xref{Spam Package
23130 Configuration Examples}.
23131
23132 Normally, spam groups ignore @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations}.
23133 However, if you set @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only} to
23134 @code{nil}, spam will also be moved out of spam groups, depending on
23135 the @code{spam-process-destination} parameter.
23136
23137 The final thing the Spam package does is to mark spam articles as
23138 expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
23139
23140 If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
23141 as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
23142 50 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
23143
23144 @node Filtering Incoming Mail
23145 @subsection Filtering Incoming Mail
23146 @cindex spam filtering
23147 @cindex spam filtering incoming mail
23148 @cindex spam
23149
23150 To use the Spam package to filter incoming mail, you must first set up
23151 fancy mail splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}. The Spam package
23152 defines a special splitting function that you can add to your fancy
23153 split variable (either @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
23154 @code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on your mail back end):
23155
23156 @example
23157 (: spam-split)
23158 @end example
23159
23160 @vindex spam-split-group
23161 @noindent
23162 The @code{spam-split} function scans incoming mail according to your
23163 chosen spam back end(s), and sends messages identified as spam to a
23164 spam group. By default, the spam group is a group named @samp{spam},
23165 but you can change this by customizing @code{spam-split-group}. Make
23166 sure the contents of @code{spam-split-group} are an unqualified group
23167 name. For instance, in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server},
23168 the value @samp{spam} means @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The value
23169 @samp{nnimap+server:spam} is therefore wrong---it gives the group
23170 @samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam}.
23171
23172 @code{spam-split} does not modify the contents of messages in any way.
23173
23174 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
23175 Note for IMAP users: if you use the @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
23176 @code{spam-check-ifile}, and @code{spam-check-stat} spam back ends,
23177 you should also set set the variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body}
23178 to @code{t}. These spam back ends are most useful when they can
23179 ``scan'' the full message body. By default, the nnimap back end only
23180 retrieves the message headers; @code{nnimap-split-download-body} tells
23181 it to retrieve the message bodies as well. We don't set this by
23182 default because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and that is not an
23183 appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user. @xref{Splitting
23184 in IMAP}.
23185
23186 You have to specify one or more spam back ends for @code{spam-split}
23187 to use, by setting the @code{spam-use-*} variables. @xref{Spam Back
23188 Ends}. Normally, @code{spam-split} simply uses all the spam back ends
23189 you enabled in this way. However, you can tell @code{spam-split} to
23190 use only some of them. Why this is useful? Suppose you are using the
23191 @code{spam-use-regex-headers} and @code{spam-use-blackholes} spam back
23192 ends, and the following split rule:
23193
23194 @example
23195 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
23196 (any "ding" "ding")
23197 (: spam-split)
23198 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23199 "mail")
23200 @end example
23201
23202 @noindent
23203 The problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the ding
23204 folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam detected by
23205 SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through, when it's
23206 sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to the ding
23207 list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the invocation
23208 of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
23209
23210 The solution is to let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, and
23211 perform the other @code{spam-split} rules (including a second
23212 invocation of the regex-headers check) after the ding rule. This is
23213 done by passing a parameter to @code{spam-split}:
23214
23215 @example
23216 nnimap-split-fancy
23217 '(|
23218 ;; @r{spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
23219 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
23220 (any "ding" "ding")
23221 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
23222 (: spam-split)
23223 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23224 "mail")
23225 @end example
23226
23227 @noindent
23228 This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
23229 your particular needs, and target the results of those checks to a
23230 particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
23231 spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
23232 mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
23233 blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
23234 spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
23235
23236 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
23237 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
23238 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
23239 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
23240
23241 @c @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
23242 @c statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
23243 @c don't.}
23244
23245 @node Detecting Spam in Groups
23246 @subsection Detecting Spam in Groups
23247
23248 To detect spam when visiting a group, set the group's
23249 @code{spam-autodetect} and @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group
23250 parameters. These are accessible with @kbd{G c} or @kbd{G p}, as
23251 usual (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
23252
23253 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
23254 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
23255 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
23256 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set.
23257
23258 By default, only unseen articles are processed for spam. You can
23259 force Gnus to recheck all messages in the group by setting the
23260 variable @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages} to @code{t}.
23261
23262 If you use the @code{spam-autodetect} method of checking for spam, you
23263 can specify different spam detection methods for different groups.
23264 For instance, the @samp{ding} group may have @code{spam-use-BBDB} as
23265 the autodetection method, while the @samp{suspect} group may have the
23266 @code{spam-use-blacklist} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods
23267 enabled. Unlike with @code{spam-split}, you don't have any control
23268 over the @emph{sequence} of checks, but this is probably unimportant.
23269
23270 @node Spam and Ham Processors
23271 @subsection Spam and Ham Processors
23272 @cindex spam filtering
23273 @cindex spam filtering variables
23274 @cindex spam variables
23275 @cindex spam
23276
23277 @vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
23278 Spam and ham processors specify special actions to take when you exit
23279 a group buffer. Spam processors act on spam messages, and ham
23280 processors on ham messages. At present, the main role of these
23281 processors is to update the dictionaries of dictionary-based spam back
23282 ends such as Bogofilter (@pxref{Bogofilter}) and the Spam Statistics
23283 package (@pxref{Spam Statistics Filtering}).
23284
23285 The spam and ham processors that apply to each group are determined by
23286 the group's@code{spam-process} group parameter. If this group
23287 parameter is not defined, they are determined by the variable
23288 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups}.
23289
23290 @vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
23291 Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
23292 one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
23293 @code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
23294 groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
23295 @code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
23296 by customizing the corresponding variable
23297 @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
23298 parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
23299 also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
23300 classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
23301 groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
23302 @code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
23303 considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
23304 default.
23305
23306 @vindex gnus-spam-mark
23307 @cindex $
23308 In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
23309 they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
23310 group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
23311 unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
23312 thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
23313 will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
23314 @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
23315 should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
23316 buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
23317 @samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
23318 @kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
23319 group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
23320 processor which will study them as spam samples.
23321
23322 Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
23323 @code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
23324 and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
23325 @samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
23326 low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
23327 are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
23328 use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
23329 should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
23330
23331 @defvar ham-marks
23332 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
23333 marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
23334 deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
23335 that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
23336 useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
23337 recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
23338 indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
23339 happy for you.
23340 @end defvar
23341
23342 @defvar spam-marks
23343 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
23344 marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
23345 the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
23346 you really want to.
23347 @end defvar
23348
23349 When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
23350 @code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
23351 to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
23352 explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
23353 @samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
23354 spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
23355 and nothing else.
23356
23357 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
23358 When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
23359 marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
23360 not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
23361 @strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
23362 determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
23363 parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
23364 variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
23365 names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
23366 customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
23367 group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
23368 the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
23369 parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
23370 @code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
23371 set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
23372
23373 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
23374 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
23375
23376 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
23377 expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
23378 group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
23379
23380 When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
23381 a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
23382
23383 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
23384 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
23385 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
23386 to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
23387 to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
23388
23389 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
23390 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
23391 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
23392 or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
23393 you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
23394 it there.
23395
23396 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
23397 When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
23398 @strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
23399 the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
23400 @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
23401 regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
23402 customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
23403 gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
23404 Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
23405 @code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
23406 articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
23407 that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
23408 group buffer then you need it here as well.
23409
23410 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
23411 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
23412
23413 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
23414 expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
23415 training} groups.
23416
23417 @vindex spam-log-to-registry
23418 The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
23419 this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
23420 variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
23421 what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
23422 multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
23423 entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
23424
23425 @vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
23426 Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
23427 be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
23428 @code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
23429
23430 @vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
23431 Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
23432 out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
23433 like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
23434 in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
23435 from the mail server.
23436
23437 @vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
23438 When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
23439 only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
23440 spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
23441
23442 @node Spam Package Configuration Examples
23443 @subsection Spam Package Configuration Examples
23444 @cindex spam filtering
23445 @cindex spam filtering configuration examples
23446 @cindex spam configuration examples
23447 @cindex spam
23448
23449 @subsubheading Ted's setup
23450
23451 From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
23452 @example
23453 ;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
23454 ;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
23455 (gnus-registry-initialize)
23456 (spam-initialize)
23457
23458 (setq
23459 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
23460 spam-use-BBDB t
23461 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
23462 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
23463 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
23464 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23465 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
23466 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
23467 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
23468 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
23469 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
23470 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
23471 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
23472 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
23473 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
23474 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
23475 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
23476 (any "ding" "ding")
23477 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
23478 (: spam-split)
23479 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23480 "mail"))
23481
23482 ;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
23483
23484 ;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
23485 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
23486 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
23487 ;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
23488
23489 ((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23490
23491 ;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
23492 ;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
23493 ((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
23494 ;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
23495 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23496
23497 ;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
23498 ((spam-autodetect . t))
23499
23500 ;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
23501
23502 ;; @r{this is a spam group}
23503 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
23504
23505 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
23506 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
23507 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
23508
23509 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
23510
23511 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
23512 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
23513
23514 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
23515 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
23516 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
23517 (ham-marks
23518 (gnus-ticked-mark))
23519 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
23520 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
23521 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
23522
23523 ;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
23524 ;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
23525 ;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
23526
23527 @end example
23528
23529 @subsubheading Using @file{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
23530 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
23531
23532 My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
23533 the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
23534 @samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
23535 i.e. to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
23536 positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
23537 @samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
23538 the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
23539 options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
23540 @samp{training.spam} folders.
23541
23542 With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
23543 does most of the job for me:
23544
23545 @lisp
23546 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
23547 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
23548 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
23549 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23550 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
23551 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
23552 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
23553 @end lisp
23554
23555 @itemize
23556
23557 @item @b{The Spam folder:}
23558
23559 In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
23560 (i.e. legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
23561 bogofilter or DCC).
23562
23563 Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
23564 messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
23565 positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark
23566 (@code{ham-marks}, @ref{Spam and Ham Processors}). On group exit,
23567 those messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want
23568 to have the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter)
23569 and deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
23570
23571 The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
23572 false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
23573 have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e. chars) makes finding
23574 other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
23575 (@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
23576 an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
23577
23578 @item @b{Ham folders:}
23579
23580 In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
23581 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
23582 mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
23583 @samp{training.ham}.
23584 @end itemize
23585
23586 @subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
23587
23588 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
23589
23590 With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
23591 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
23592 groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
23593
23594 @lisp
23595 ("^gmane\\."
23596 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
23597 @end lisp
23598
23599 Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
23600 because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
23601 through my local news server (leafnode). I.e. the article numbers are
23602 not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
23603 the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
23604
23605 @node Spam Back Ends
23606 @subsection Spam Back Ends
23607 @cindex spam back ends
23608
23609 The spam package offers a variety of back ends for detecting spam.
23610 Each back end defines a set of methods for detecting spam
23611 (@pxref{Filtering Incoming Mail}, @pxref{Detecting Spam in Groups}),
23612 and a pair of spam and ham processors (@pxref{Spam and Ham
23613 Processors}).
23614
23615 @menu
23616 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
23617 * BBDB Whitelists::
23618 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
23619 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
23620 * Blackholes::
23621 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
23622 * Bogofilter::
23623 * ifile spam filtering::
23624 * Spam Statistics Filtering::
23625 * SpamOracle::
23626 @end menu
23627
23628 @node Blacklists and Whitelists
23629 @subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
23630 @cindex spam filtering
23631 @cindex whitelists, spam filtering
23632 @cindex blacklists, spam filtering
23633 @cindex spam
23634
23635 @defvar spam-use-blacklist
23636
23637 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
23638 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
23639 will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
23640 filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
23641 be spammers.
23642
23643 @end defvar
23644
23645 @defvar spam-use-whitelist
23646
23647 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
23648 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
23649 whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
23650 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
23651 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
23652
23653 @end defvar
23654
23655 @defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
23656
23657 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
23658 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
23659 unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
23660
23661 @end defvar
23662
23663 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
23664
23665 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23666 customizing the group parameters or the
23667 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23668 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23669 spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
23670
23671 @emph{WARNING}
23672
23673 Instead of the obsolete
23674 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
23675 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
23676 the same way, we promise.
23677
23678 @end defvar
23679
23680 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
23681
23682 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23683 customizing the group parameters or the
23684 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23685 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23686 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
23687 whitelist. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
23688 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23689
23690 @emph{WARNING}
23691
23692 Instead of the obsolete
23693 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
23694 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
23695 the same way, we promise.
23696
23697 @end defvar
23698
23699 Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
23700 consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
23701 sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
23702 blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
23703 use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
23704
23705 Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
23706 legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
23707 non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
23708 Emacs regular expression syntax.
23709
23710 The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
23711 @code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
23712 the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
23713 directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
23714 @code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
23715 @file{blacklist} respectively.
23716
23717 @node BBDB Whitelists
23718 @subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
23719 @cindex spam filtering
23720 @cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
23721 @cindex BBDB, spam filtering
23722 @cindex spam
23723
23724 @defvar spam-use-BBDB
23725
23726 Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
23727 Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
23728 addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
23729 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
23730 not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
23731 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
23732 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
23733
23734 @end defvar
23735
23736 @defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
23737
23738 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
23739 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
23740 unless the sender is in the BBDB. Use with care. Only sender
23741 addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
23742 classified as spammers.
23743
23744 @end defvar
23745
23746 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
23747
23748 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23749 customizing the group parameters or the
23750 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23751 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23752 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
23753 BBDB. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
23754 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23755
23756 @emph{WARNING}
23757
23758 Instead of the obsolete
23759 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
23760 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
23761 the same way, we promise.
23762
23763 @end defvar
23764
23765 @node Gmane Spam Reporting
23766 @subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
23767 @cindex spam reporting
23768 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
23769 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
23770 @cindex spam
23771
23772 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
23773
23774 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23775 customizing the group parameters or the
23776 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23777 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
23778 articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
23779 HTTP request.
23780
23781 Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
23782
23783 @emph{WARNING}
23784
23785 Instead of the obsolete
23786 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
23787 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
23788 same way, we promise.
23789
23790 @end defvar
23791
23792 @defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
23793
23794 This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
23795 running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
23796 numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
23797 @code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
23798 @code{spam-report.el} will use the @code{X-Report-Spam} header that
23799 Gmane provides.
23800
23801 @end defvar
23802
23803 @node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
23804 @subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
23805 @cindex spam filtering
23806 @cindex hashcash, spam filtering
23807 @cindex spam
23808
23809 @defvar spam-use-hashcash
23810
23811 Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
23812 Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
23813 instead of the sender address. You must have the @code{hashcash.el}
23814 package loaded for @code{spam-use-hashcash} to work properly.
23815 Messages without a hashcash payment token will be sent to the next
23816 spam-split rule. This is an explicit filter, meaning that unless a
23817 hashcash token is found, the messages are not assumed to be spam or
23818 ham.
23819
23820 @end defvar
23821
23822 @node Blackholes
23823 @subsubsection Blackholes
23824 @cindex spam filtering
23825 @cindex blackholes, spam filtering
23826 @cindex spam
23827
23828 @defvar spam-use-blackholes
23829
23830 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
23831 blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
23832 when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
23833 holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
23834 list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
23835 contains outdated servers.
23836
23837 The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
23838 @file{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
23839 you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
23840 this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
23841 possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
23842 use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
23843
23844 @end defvar
23845
23846 @defvar spam-blackhole-servers
23847
23848 The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
23849
23850 @end defvar
23851
23852 @defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
23853
23854 A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
23855 blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
23856
23857 @end defvar
23858
23859 @defvar spam-use-dig
23860
23861 Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
23862 The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
23863
23864 @end defvar
23865
23866 Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
23867 ham processor for blackholes.
23868
23869 @node Regular Expressions Header Matching
23870 @subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
23871 @cindex spam filtering
23872 @cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
23873 @cindex spam
23874
23875 @defvar spam-use-regex-headers
23876
23877 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
23878 message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
23879 option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
23880 @code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
23881 Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
23882 message is spam or ham, respectively.
23883
23884 @end defvar
23885
23886 @defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
23887
23888 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
23889 the message, positively identify it as spam.
23890
23891 @end defvar
23892
23893 @defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
23894
23895 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
23896 the message, positively identify it as ham.
23897
23898 @end defvar
23899
23900 Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
23901 There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
23902
23903 @node Bogofilter
23904 @subsubsection Bogofilter
23905 @cindex spam filtering
23906 @cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
23907 @cindex spam
23908
23909 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter
23910
23911 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
23912 speedy Bogofilter.
23913
23914 With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
23915 articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
23916 should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
23917 category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
23918 for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
23919 the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
23920
23921 Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
23922 threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
23923 documentation.
23924
23925 If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
23926 processing will be turned off.
23927
23928 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
23929
23930 @end defvar
23931
23932 @table @kbd
23933 @item M s t
23934 @itemx S t
23935 @kindex M s t
23936 @kindex S t
23937 @findex spam-bogofilter-score
23938 Get the Bogofilter spamicity score (@code{spam-bogofilter-score}).
23939 @end table
23940
23941 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
23942
23943 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
23944 speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
23945 similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
23946 must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
23947 procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
23948 installation documents for details.
23949
23950 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
23951
23952 @end defvar
23953
23954 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
23955 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23956 customizing the group parameters or the
23957 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23958 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
23959 will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
23960
23961 @emph{WARNING}
23962
23963 Instead of the obsolete
23964 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
23965 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
23966 the same way, we promise.
23967 @end defvar
23968
23969 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
23970 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23971 customizing the group parameters or the
23972 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23973 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
23974 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
23975 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
23976 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23977
23978 @emph{WARNING}
23979
23980 Instead of the obsolete
23981 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
23982 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
23983 the same way, we promise.
23984 @end defvar
23985
23986 @defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
23987
23988 This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
23989 is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
23990 database directory.
23991
23992 @end defvar
23993
23994 The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
23995 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
23996 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
23997 variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
23998 used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
23999 Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
24000
24001 @node ifile spam filtering
24002 @subsubsection ifile spam filtering
24003 @cindex spam filtering
24004 @cindex ifile, spam filtering
24005 @cindex spam
24006
24007 @defvar spam-use-ifile
24008
24009 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
24010 statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
24011
24012 @end defvar
24013
24014 @defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
24015
24016 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
24017 the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
24018 sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
24019
24020 @end defvar
24021
24022 @defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
24023
24024 This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
24025 The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
24026 the default value of @samp{spam}.
24027 @end defvar
24028
24029 @defvar spam-ifile-database
24030
24031 This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
24032 default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
24033
24034 @end defvar
24035
24036 The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
24037 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
24038 @code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
24039 should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
24040 functionality.
24041
24042 @node Spam Statistics Filtering
24043 @subsubsection Spam Statistics Filtering
24044 @cindex spam filtering
24045 @cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
24046 @cindex spam-stat
24047 @cindex spam
24048
24049 This back end uses the Spam Statistics Emacs Lisp package to perform
24050 statistics-based filtering (@pxref{Spam Statistics Package}). Before
24051 using this, you may want to perform some additional steps to
24052 initialize your Spam Statistics dictionary. @xref{Creating a
24053 spam-stat dictionary}.
24054
24055 @defvar spam-use-stat
24056
24057 @end defvar
24058
24059 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
24060 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24061 customizing the group parameters or the
24062 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24063 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
24064 articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
24065
24066 @emph{WARNING}
24067
24068 Instead of the obsolete
24069 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
24070 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
24071 the same way, we promise.
24072 @end defvar
24073
24074 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
24075 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24076 customizing the group parameters or the
24077 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24078 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
24079 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
24080 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
24081 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
24082
24083 @emph{WARNING}
24084
24085 Instead of the obsolete
24086 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
24087 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
24088 the same way, we promise.
24089 @end defvar
24090
24091 This enables @file{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
24092 @file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
24093 which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
24094 A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
24095 @code{spam-split} are provided.
24096
24097 @node SpamOracle
24098 @subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
24099 @cindex spam filtering
24100 @cindex SpamOracle
24101 @cindex spam
24102
24103 An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
24104 statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
24105 installed separately.
24106
24107 There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
24108 mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
24109 then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
24110 mail as a spam mail or not.
24111
24112 One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
24113 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
24114 the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
24115
24116 The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Spam Package})
24117 call SpamOracle.
24118
24119 @vindex spam-use-spamoracle
24120 To enable SpamOracle usage by @file{spam.el}, set the variable
24121 @code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
24122 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}. @xref{Spam
24123 Package}. In this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is
24124 filtered using SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be
24125 moved to @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham
24126 messages stay in @samp{INBOX}:
24127
24128 @example
24129 (setq spam-use-spamoracle t
24130 spam-split-group "Junk"
24131 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
24132 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
24133 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
24134 @end example
24135
24136 @defvar spam-use-spamoracle
24137 Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
24138 SpamOracle.
24139 @end defvar
24140
24141 @defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
24142 Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
24143 user's PATH. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
24144 can be customized.
24145 @end defvar
24146
24147 @defvar spam-spamoracle-database
24148 By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
24149 store its analysis. This is controlled by the variable
24150 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
24151 the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
24152 database to live somewhere special, set
24153 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
24154 @end defvar
24155
24156 SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
24157 message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
24158 false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns
24159 the characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
24160 (training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
24161 SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary
24162 buffer and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using
24163 @file{spam.el}'s spam- and ham-processors, which is much more
24164 convenient. For a detailed description of spam- and ham-processors,
24165 @xref{Spam Package}.
24166
24167 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
24168 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24169 customizing the group parameter or the
24170 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
24171 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
24172 sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
24173
24174 @emph{WARNING}
24175
24176 Instead of the obsolete
24177 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
24178 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
24179 the same way, we promise.
24180 @end defvar
24181
24182 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
24183 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24184 customizing the group parameter or the
24185 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
24186 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
24187 @emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
24188 messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam} or
24189 @emph{unclassified} groups.
24190
24191 @emph{WARNING}
24192
24193 Instead of the obsolete
24194 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
24195 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
24196 the same way, we promise.
24197 @end defvar
24198
24199 @emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
24200 classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
24201 messages.
24202 @example
24203 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
24204 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
24205 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
24206 @end example
24207 For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
24208 ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
24209 (e.g. because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
24210 the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
24211 processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
24212 SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
24213
24214 @node Extending the Spam package
24215 @subsection Extending the Spam package
24216 @cindex spam filtering
24217 @cindex spam elisp package, extending
24218 @cindex extending the spam elisp package
24219
24220 Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
24221 incoming mail, provide the following:
24222
24223 @enumerate
24224
24225 @item
24226 Code
24227
24228 @lisp
24229 (defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
24230 "True if blackbox should be used.")
24231 @end lisp
24232
24233 Add
24234 @lisp
24235 (spam-use-blackbox . spam-check-blackbox)
24236 @end lisp
24237 to @code{spam-list-of-checks}.
24238
24239 Add
24240 @lisp
24241 (gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox ham spam-use-blackbox)
24242 (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox spam spam-use-blackbox)
24243 @end lisp
24244
24245 to @code{spam-list-of-processors}.
24246
24247 Add
24248 @lisp
24249 (spam-use-blackbox spam-blackbox-register-routine
24250 nil
24251 spam-blackbox-unregister-routine
24252 nil)
24253 @end lisp
24254
24255 to @code{spam-registration-functions}. Write the register/unregister
24256 routines using the bogofilter register/unregister routines as a
24257 start, or other register/unregister routines more appropriate to
24258 Blackbox.
24259
24260 @item
24261 Functionality
24262
24263 Write the @code{spam-check-blackbox} function. It should return
24264 @samp{nil} or @code{spam-split-group}, observing the other
24265 conventions. See the existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for
24266 examples of what you can do, and stick to the template unless you
24267 fully understand the reasons why you aren't.
24268
24269 Make sure to add @code{spam-use-blackbox} to
24270 @code{spam-list-of-statistical-checks} if Blackbox is a statistical
24271 mail analyzer that needs the full message body to operate.
24272
24273 @end enumerate
24274
24275 For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
24276
24277 @enumerate
24278
24279 @item
24280 Code
24281
24282 Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
24283 provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
24284
24285 Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
24286 variables. Instead the form @code{'(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
24287 @code{'(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
24288 processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
24289
24290 @lisp
24291 (defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
24292 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
24293 Only applicable to spam groups.")
24294
24295 (defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
24296 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
24297 Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
24298
24299 @end lisp
24300
24301 @item
24302 Gnus parameters
24303
24304 Add
24305 @lisp
24306 (const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
24307 (const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
24308 @end lisp
24309 to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
24310 sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
24311 variable customization.
24312
24313 Add
24314 @lisp
24315 (variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
24316 @end lisp
24317 to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
24318 @code{gnus.el}.
24319
24320 @end enumerate
24321
24322 @node Spam Statistics Package
24323 @subsection Spam Statistics Package
24324 @cindex Paul Graham
24325 @cindex Graham, Paul
24326 @cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
24327 @cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
24328 @cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
24329
24330 Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
24331 statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
24332 Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
24333 filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
24334 the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
24335 always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
24336 on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
24337 this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
24338 that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
24339 or not.
24340
24341 The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
24342 with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
24343 either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
24344 collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
24345 word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
24346 non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
24347 probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
24348 than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
24349
24350 The Spam Statistics package adds support to Gnus for this kind of
24351 filtering. It can be used as one of the back ends of the Spam package
24352 (@pxref{Spam Package}), or by itself.
24353
24354 Before using the Spam Statistics package, you need to set it up.
24355 First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
24356 non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
24357 collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
24358 this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
24359
24360 @menu
24361 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
24362 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
24363 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
24364 @end menu
24365
24366 @node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
24367 @subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
24368
24369 Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
24370 create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
24371 one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
24372 for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
24373 need several hundred emails in both collections.
24374
24375 Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
24376 creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
24377 per mail. Use the following:
24378
24379 @defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
24380 Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
24381 is treated as one spam mail.
24382 @end defun
24383
24384 @defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
24385 Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
24386 file is treated as one non-spam mail.
24387 @end defun
24388
24389 Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
24390 directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds to
24391 the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
24392 @code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
24393 @file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds to the group
24394 @samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
24395
24396 When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
24397 locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
24398 to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
24399 @file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
24400 @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
24401
24402 @defvar spam-stat
24403 This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
24404 dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
24405 collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
24406 word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
24407 @end defvar
24408
24409 If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
24410 reset the dictionary.
24411
24412 @defun spam-stat-reset
24413 Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
24414 @end defun
24415
24416 When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
24417 be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
24418 (instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
24419 can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
24420 not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
24421 only non-spam mails.
24422
24423 @defun spam-stat-reduce-size
24424 Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
24425 to update the dictionary incrementally.
24426 @end defun
24427
24428 @defun spam-stat-save
24429 Save the dictionary.
24430 @end defun
24431
24432 @defvar spam-stat-file
24433 The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
24434 @file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
24435 @end defvar
24436
24437 @node Splitting mail using spam-stat
24438 @subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
24439
24440 This section describes how to use the Spam statistics
24441 @emph{independently} of the @xref{Spam Package}.
24442
24443 First, add the following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24444
24445 @lisp
24446 (require 'spam-stat)
24447 (spam-stat-load)
24448 @end lisp
24449
24450 This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
24451 created.
24452
24453 Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
24454 determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
24455 the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
24456 use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
24457
24458 In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
24459 @samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
24460 spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
24461 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
24462
24463 @lisp
24464 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24465 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24466 "mail.misc"))
24467 @end lisp
24468
24469 @defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
24470 The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
24471 @end defvar
24472
24473 If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
24474 the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
24475 expression are considered potential spam.
24476
24477 @lisp
24478 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24479 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24480 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24481 "mail.misc"))
24482 @end lisp
24483
24484 If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
24485 creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
24486 consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
24487 non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
24488 mails, when creating the dictionary!
24489
24490 @lisp
24491 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24492 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24493 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24494 "mail.misc"))
24495 @end lisp
24496
24497 You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
24498 HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
24499 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
24500 @samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
24501 nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
24502 dictionary!
24503
24504 @lisp
24505 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24506 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
24507 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24508 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24509 "mail.misc"))
24510 @end lisp
24511
24512
24513 @node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24514 @subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24515
24516 The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
24517
24518 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
24519 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
24520 Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24521 @end defun
24522
24523 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
24524 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
24525 mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24526 @end defun
24527
24528 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
24529 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
24530 mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
24531 already been processed as non-spam.
24532 @end defun
24533
24534 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
24535 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
24536 normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
24537 been processed as spam.
24538 @end defun
24539
24540 @defun spam-stat-save
24541 Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
24542 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
24543 @end defun
24544
24545 @defun spam-stat-load
24546 Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
24547 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
24548 @end defun
24549
24550 @defun spam-stat-score-word
24551 Return the spam score for a word.
24552 @end defun
24553
24554 @defun spam-stat-score-buffer
24555 Return the spam score for a buffer.
24556 @end defun
24557
24558 @defun spam-stat-split-fancy
24559 Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
24560 spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
24561 @end defun
24562
24563 Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
24564 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24565
24566 @lisp
24567 (require 'spam-stat)
24568 (spam-stat-load)
24569 @end lisp
24570
24571 Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
24572
24573 @smallexample
24574 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
24575 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24576 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24577 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24578 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
24579 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
24580 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24581 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24582 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
24583 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24584 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
24585 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
24586 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24587 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24588 @end smallexample
24589
24590 Here is how you would create your dictionary:
24591
24592 @smallexample
24593 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
24594 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24595 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24596 Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
24597 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
24598 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24599 @end smallexample
24600
24601 @node Other modes
24602 @section Interaction with other modes
24603
24604 @subsection Dired
24605 @cindex dired
24606
24607 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provides some useful functions for dired
24608 buffers. It is enabled with
24609 @lisp
24610 (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
24611 @end lisp
24612
24613 @table @kbd
24614 @item C-c C-m C-a
24615 @findex gnus-dired-attach
24616 @cindex attachments, selection via dired
24617 Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
24618 You will be prompted for a message buffer.
24619
24620 @item C-c C-m C-l
24621 @findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
24622 Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
24623 (@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
24624 buffer.
24625
24626 @item C-c C-m C-p
24627 @findex gnus-dired-print
24628 Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
24629 there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
24630 @end table
24631
24632 @node Various Various
24633 @section Various Various
24634 @cindex mode lines
24635 @cindex highlights
24636
24637 @table @code
24638
24639 @item gnus-home-directory
24640 @vindex gnus-home-directory
24641 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
24642 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
24643
24644 @item gnus-directory
24645 @vindex gnus-directory
24646 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
24647 this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
24648 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
24649
24650 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
24651 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
24652 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
24653 @file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
24654
24655 @item gnus-default-directory
24656 @vindex gnus-default-directory
24657 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
24658 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
24659 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
24660 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
24661 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
24662 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
24663
24664 @item gnus-verbose
24665 @vindex gnus-verbose
24666 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
24667 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
24668 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
24669 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
24670 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
24671
24672 @item gnus-verbose-backends
24673 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
24674 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
24675 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
24676
24677 @item nnheader-max-head-length
24678 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
24679 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
24680 as little as possible. This variable (default 8192) specifies
24681 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
24682 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
24683 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
24684 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
24685 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
24686 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
24687
24688 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
24689 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
24690 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
24691 read when doing the operation described above.
24692
24693 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24694 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24695 @cindex file names
24696 @cindex invalid characters in file names
24697 @cindex characters in file names
24698 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
24699 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
24700 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
24701
24702 @lisp
24703 @group
24704 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24705 '((?: . ?_)))
24706 @end group
24707 @end lisp
24708
24709 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
24710 Windows (phooey) systems.
24711
24712 @item gnus-hidden-properties
24713 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
24714 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
24715 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
24716 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
24717
24718 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
24719 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
24720 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
24721 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
24722 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
24723
24724 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
24725 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
24726 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
24727
24728 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
24729 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
24730
24731 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
24732 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
24733 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
24734 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
24735 group).
24736
24737 @acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
24738
24739
24740 @end table
24741
24742 @node The End
24743 @chapter The End
24744
24745 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
24746 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
24747
24748 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
24749
24750 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
24751
24752 @quotation
24753 @strong{Te Deum}
24754
24755 @sp 1
24756 Not because of victories @*
24757 I sing,@*
24758 having none,@*
24759 but for the common sunshine,@*
24760 the breeze,@*
24761 the largess of the spring.
24762
24763 @sp 1
24764 Not for victory@*
24765 but for the day's work done@*
24766 as well as I was able;@*
24767 not for a seat upon the dais@*
24768 but at the common table.@*
24769 @end quotation
24770
24771
24772 @node Appendices
24773 @chapter Appendices
24774
24775 @menu
24776 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
24777 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
24778 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
24779 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
24780 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
24781 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
24782 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
24783 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
24784 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
24785 @end menu
24786
24787
24788 @node XEmacs
24789 @section XEmacs
24790 @cindex XEmacs
24791 @cindex installing under XEmacs
24792
24793 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
24794 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
24795 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
24796 @samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
24797 @samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print}, @samp{W3},
24798 @samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
24799
24800
24801 @node History
24802 @section History
24803
24804 @cindex history
24805 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
24806 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
24807
24808 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
24809 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
24810 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
24811 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
24812 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
24813
24814 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
24815 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
24816 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
24817 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
24818 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
24819 appropriate name, don't you think?)
24820
24821 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
24822 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
24823 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
24824 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
24825
24826 @menu
24827 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
24828 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
24829 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
24830 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
24831 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
24832 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
24833 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
24834 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
24835 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
24836 @end menu
24837
24838
24839 @node Gnus Versions
24840 @subsection Gnus Versions
24841 @cindex ding Gnus
24842 @cindex September Gnus
24843 @cindex Red Gnus
24844 @cindex Quassia Gnus
24845 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
24846 @cindex Oort Gnus
24847 @cindex No Gnus
24848 @cindex Gnus versions
24849
24850 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
24851 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
24852 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
24853
24854 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
24855 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
24856
24857 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
24858 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
24859
24860 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
24861 It was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
24862
24863 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
24864 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
24865 1999.
24866
24867 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun and was released as
24868 Gnus 5.10 on May 1st 2003 (24 releases).
24869
24870 On the January 4th 2004, No Gnus was begun.
24871
24872 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name --
24873 ``(ding) Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
24874 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'', ``No Gnus'' -- don't panic.
24875 Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly. Whatever
24876 you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of its reach.
24877 Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up to that instead.
24878
24879
24880 @node Other Gnus Versions
24881 @subsection Other Gnus Versions
24882 @cindex Semi-gnus
24883
24884 In addition to the versions of Gnus which have had their releases
24885 coordinated by Lars, one major development has been Semi-gnus from
24886 Japan. It's based on a library called @acronym{SEMI}, which provides
24887 @acronym{MIME} capabilities.
24888
24889 These Gnusae are based mainly on Gnus 5.6 and Pterodactyl Gnus.
24890 Collectively, they are called ``Semi-gnus'', and different strains are
24891 called T-gnus, ET-gnus, Nana-gnus and Chaos. These provide powerful
24892 @acronym{MIME} and multilingualization things, especially important for
24893 Japanese users.
24894
24895
24896 @node Why?
24897 @subsection Why?
24898
24899 What's the point of Gnus?
24900
24901 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
24902 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
24903 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
24904 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
24905 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
24906 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
24907 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
24908 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
24909 keep track of millions of people who post?
24910
24911 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
24912 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
24913 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
24914 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
24915 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
24916 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
24917 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
24918 every one of you to explore and invent.
24919
24920 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
24921 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
24922
24923
24924 @node Compatibility
24925 @subsection Compatibility
24926
24927 @cindex compatibility
24928 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
24929 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
24930 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
24931
24932 Our motto is:
24933 @quotation
24934 @cartouche
24935 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
24936 @end cartouche
24937 @end quotation
24938
24939 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
24940 their names.
24941
24942 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
24943 Articles}.
24944
24945 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
24946 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
24947 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
24948 important variables have their values copied into their global
24949 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
24950 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
24951
24952 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
24953 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
24954 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
24955 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
24956 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
24957 peculiar results.
24958
24959 @cindex hilit19
24960 @cindex highlighting
24961 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
24962 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
24963 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
24964 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
24965 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
24966 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
24967 Away!
24968
24969 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
24970 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
24971 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
24972 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
24973
24974 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
24975 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
24976 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
24977 to stop doing it the old way.
24978
24979 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
24980
24981 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
24982 @findex gnus-bug
24983 @cindex reporting bugs
24984 @cindex bugs
24985 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
24986 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
24987 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
24988
24989 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
24990 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
24991 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
24992 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
24993 up at you.
24994
24995
24996 @node Conformity
24997 @subsection Conformity
24998
24999 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
25000 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
25001 with, of course.
25002
25003 @table @strong
25004
25005 @item RFC (2)822
25006 @cindex RFC 822
25007 @cindex RFC 2822
25008 There are no known breaches of this standard.
25009
25010 @item RFC 1036
25011 @cindex RFC 1036
25012 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
25013
25014 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
25015 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
25016 We do have some breaches to this one.
25017
25018 @table @emph
25019
25020 @item X-Newsreader
25021 @itemx User-Agent
25022 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
25023 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
25024 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
25025 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
25026 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
25027 @end table
25028
25029 @item USEFOR
25030 @cindex USEFOR
25031 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
25032 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
25033 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
25034 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
25035
25036 @item MIME - RFC 2045-2049 etc
25037 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
25038 All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
25039
25040 @item Disposition Notifications - RFC 2298
25041 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
25042
25043 @item PGP - RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
25044 @cindex RFC 1991
25045 @cindex RFC 2440
25046 RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
25047 published as an informational RFC. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
25048 called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
25049 non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
25050 encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
25051 decryption).
25052
25053 @item PGP/MIME - RFC 2015/3156
25054 RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
25055 1991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RFC 1991/2440 format.
25056 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
25057
25058 @item S/MIME - RFC 2633
25059 RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
25060
25061 @item IMAP - RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
25062 RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
25063 (@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
25064 authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
25065 lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
25066 protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
25067 integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
25068 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
25069
25070 @end table
25071
25072 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
25073 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
25074 know.
25075
25076
25077 @node Emacsen
25078 @subsection Emacsen
25079 @cindex Emacsen
25080 @cindex XEmacs
25081 @cindex Mule
25082 @cindex Emacs
25083
25084 Gnus should work on:
25085
25086 @itemize @bullet
25087
25088 @item
25089 Emacs 21.1 and up.
25090
25091 @item
25092 XEmacs 21.4 and up.
25093
25094 @end itemize
25095
25096 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
25097 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
25098 Emacs versions. Particularly, Gnus 5.10.8 should also work on Emacs
25099 20.7 and XEmacs 21.1.
25100
25101 There are some vague differences between Gnus on the various
25102 platforms---XEmacs features more graphics (a logo and a toolbar)---but
25103 other than that, things should look pretty much the same under all
25104 Emacsen.
25105
25106
25107 @node Gnus Development
25108 @subsection Gnus Development
25109
25110 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
25111 discussion on the @samp{ding@@gnus.org} mailing list, where people
25112 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
25113 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
25114 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
25115 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
25116 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
25117 have names like ``Red Gnus'' and ``Quassia Gnus''.
25118
25119 After futzing around for 50-100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
25120 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
25121 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.6.32'' instead. Normal people are
25122 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
25123 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup.
25124
25125 @cindex Incoming*
25126 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
25127 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae.
25128 In particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{nil} in
25129 alpha Gnusae and @code{t} in released Gnusae. This is to prevent
25130 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
25131
25132 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
25133 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
25134 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
25135 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
25136 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
25137 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
25138 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
25139 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
25140 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
25141 can't be assumed to do so.
25142
25143
25144
25145 @node Contributors
25146 @subsection Contributors
25147 @cindex contributors
25148
25149 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
25150 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
25151 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
25152 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
25153 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
25154 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
25155 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
25156 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
25157 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
25158 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
25159
25160 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
25161 wrong show.
25162
25163 @itemize @bullet
25164
25165 @item
25166 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
25167
25168 @item
25169 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el, webmail.el,
25170 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
25171 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
25172 functionality and stuff.
25173
25174 @item
25175 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
25176 well as numerous other things).
25177
25178 @item
25179 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
25180
25181 @item
25182 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
25183
25184 @item
25185 Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
25186
25187 @item
25188 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
25189
25190 @item
25191 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
25192 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
25193
25194 @item
25195 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
25196
25197 @item
25198 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section
25199 (@pxref{GroupLens}).
25200
25201 @item
25202 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
25203
25204 @item
25205 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
25206
25207 @item
25208 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bugs detections and fixes.
25209
25210 @item
25211 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
25212
25213 @item
25214 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
25215 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
25216
25217 @item
25218 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
25219
25220 @item
25221 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
25222
25223 @item
25224 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
25225
25226 @item
25227 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
25228 .newsrc files.
25229
25230 @item
25231 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
25232
25233 @item
25234 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
25235
25236 @item
25237 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
25238
25239 @item
25240 François Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
25241 well as autoconf support.
25242
25243 @end itemize
25244
25245 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
25246 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
25247
25248 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
25249
25250 Christopher Davis,
25251 Andrew Eskilsson,
25252 Kai Grossjohann,
25253 Kevin Greiner,
25254 Jesper Harder,
25255 Paul Jarc,
25256 Simon Josefsson,
25257 David KÃ¥gedal,
25258 Richard Pieri,
25259 Fabrice Popineau,
25260 Daniel Quinlan,
25261 Michael Shields,
25262 Reiner Steib,
25263 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
25264 Jack Vinson,
25265 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
25266 and
25267 Teodor Zlatanov.
25268
25269 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
25270
25271 Jari Aalto,
25272 Adrian Aichner,
25273 Vladimir Alexiev,
25274 Russ Allbery,
25275 Peter Arius,
25276 Matt Armstrong,
25277 Marc Auslander,
25278 Miles Bader,
25279 Alexei V. Barantsev,
25280 Frank Bennett,
25281 Robert Bihlmeyer,
25282 Chris Bone,
25283 Mark Borges,
25284 Mark Boyns,
25285 Lance A. Brown,
25286 Rob Browning,
25287 Kees de Bruin,
25288 Martin Buchholz,
25289 Joe Buehler,
25290 Kevin Buhr,
25291 Alastair Burt,
25292 Joao Cachopo,
25293 Zlatko Calusic,
25294 Massimo Campostrini,
25295 Castor,
25296 David Charlap,
25297 Dan Christensen,
25298 Kevin Christian,
25299 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
25300 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
25301 Laura Conrad,
25302 Michael R. Cook,
25303 Glenn Coombs,
25304 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
25305 Neil Crellin,
25306 Frank D. Cringle,
25307 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
25308 Andre Deparade,
25309 Ulrik Dickow,
25310 Dave Disser,
25311 Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
25312 Joev Dubach,
25313 Michael Welsh Duggan,
25314 Dave Edmondson,
25315 Paul Eggert,
25316 Mark W. Eichin,
25317 Karl Eichwalder,
25318 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
25319 Michael Ernst,
25320 Luc Van Eycken,
25321 Sam Falkner,
25322 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
25323 Sigbjorn Finne,
25324 Sven Fischer,
25325 Paul Fisher,
25326 Decklin Foster,
25327 Gary D. Foster,
25328 Paul Franklin,
25329 Guy Geens,
25330 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
25331 David S. Goldberg,
25332 Michelangelo Grigni,
25333 Dale Hagglund,
25334 D. Hall,
25335 Magnus Hammerin,
25336 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
25337 Raja R. Harinath,
25338 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
25339 P. E. Jareth Hein,
25340 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
25341 Scott Hofmann,
25342 Marc Horowitz,
25343 Gunnar Horrigmo,
25344 Richard Hoskins,
25345 Brad Howes,
25346 Miguel de Icaza,
25347 François Felix Ingrand,
25348 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
25349 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
25350 Lee Iverson,
25351 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
25352 Rajappa Iyer,
25353 Andreas Jaeger,
25354 Adam P. Jenkins,
25355 Randell Jesup,
25356 Fred Johansen,
25357 Gareth Jones,
25358 Greg Klanderman,
25359 Karl Kleinpaste,
25360 Michael Klingbeil,
25361 Peter Skov Knudsen,
25362 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
25363 Petr Konecny,
25364 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
25365 Thor Kristoffersen,
25366 Jens Lautenbacher,
25367 Martin Larose,
25368 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
25369 Joerg Lenneis,
25370 Carsten Leonhardt,
25371 James LewisMoss,
25372 Christian Limpach,
25373 Markus Linnala,
25374 Dave Love,
25375 Mike McEwan,
25376 Tonny Madsen,
25377 Shlomo Mahlab,
25378 Nat Makarevitch,
25379 Istvan Marko,
25380 David Martin,
25381 Jason R. Mastaler,
25382 Gordon Matzigkeit,
25383 Timo Metzemakers,
25384 Richard Mlynarik,
25385 Lantz Moore,
25386 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
25387 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
25388 Hrvoje Niksic,
25389 Andy Norman,
25390 Fred Oberhauser,
25391 C. R. Oldham,
25392 Alexandre Oliva,
25393 Ken Olstad,
25394 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
25395 Hideki Ono, @c Ono
25396 Ettore Perazzoli,
25397 William Perry,
25398 Stephen Peters,
25399 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
25400 Ulrich Pfeifer,
25401 Matt Pharr,
25402 Andy Piper,
25403 John McClary Prevost,
25404 Bill Pringlemeir,
25405 Mike Pullen,
25406 Jim Radford,
25407 Colin Rafferty,
25408 Lasse Rasinen,
25409 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
25410 Joe Reiss,
25411 Renaud Rioboo,
25412 Roland B. Roberts,
25413 Bart Robinson,
25414 Christian von Roques,
25415 Markus Rost,
25416 Jason Rumney,
25417 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
25418 Jay Sachs,
25419 Dewey M. Sasser,
25420 Conrad Sauerwald,
25421 Loren Schall,
25422 Dan Schmidt,
25423 Ralph Schleicher,
25424 Philippe Schnoebelen,
25425 Andreas Schwab,
25426 Randal L. Schwartz,
25427 Danny Siu,
25428 Matt Simmons,
25429 Paul D. Smith,
25430 Jeff Sparkes,
25431 Toby Speight,
25432 Michael Sperber,
25433 Darren Stalder,
25434 Richard Stallman,
25435 Greg Stark,
25436 Sam Steingold,
25437 Paul Stevenson,
25438 Jonas Steverud,
25439 Paul Stodghill,
25440 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
25441 Kurt Swanson,
25442 Samuel Tardieu,
25443 Teddy,
25444 Chuck Thompson,
25445 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
25446 Philippe Troin,
25447 James Troup,
25448 Trung Tran-Duc,
25449 Jack Twilley,
25450 Aaron M. Ucko,
25451 Aki Vehtari,
25452 Didier Verna,
25453 Vladimir Volovich,
25454 Jan Vroonhof,
25455 Stefan Waldherr,
25456 Pete Ware,
25457 Barry A. Warsaw,
25458 Christoph Wedler,
25459 Joe Wells,
25460 Lee Willis,
25461 and
25462 Lloyd Zusman.
25463
25464
25465 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
25466 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
25467 (550kB and counting).
25468
25469 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
25470 sure.
25471
25472 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
25473 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
25474
25475
25476 @node New Features
25477 @subsection New Features
25478 @cindex new features
25479
25480 @menu
25481 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
25482 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
25483 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
25484 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
25485 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
25486 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
25487 @end menu
25488
25489 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
25490 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
25491 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
25492
25493 @node ding Gnus
25494 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
25495
25496 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
25497
25498 @itemize @bullet
25499
25500 @item
25501 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
25502 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
25503
25504 @item
25505 Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
25506 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
25507
25508 @item
25509 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
25510
25511 @item
25512 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
25513 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
25514 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
25515
25516 @item
25517 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
25518 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
25519 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
25520 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
25521
25522 @item
25523 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
25524 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25525
25526 @item
25527 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
25528 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
25529 (@pxref{The Active File}).
25530
25531 @item
25532 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
25533 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
25534
25535 @item
25536 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
25537 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
25538 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
25539
25540 @item
25541 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
25542 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
25543 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
25544
25545 @item
25546 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
25547 cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
25548
25549 @item
25550 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
25551 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
25552
25553 @item
25554 You can grep through a subset of groups and create a group from the
25555 results (@pxref{Kibozed Groups}).
25556
25557 @item
25558 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
25559 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25560
25561 @item
25562 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
25563 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
25564
25565 @item
25566 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
25567 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
25568
25569 @item
25570 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
25571
25572 @item
25573 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
25574 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
25575
25576 @item
25577 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
25578 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
25579
25580 @item
25581 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
25582 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
25583
25584 @item
25585 Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
25586
25587 @item
25588 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
25589 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
25590
25591 @item
25592 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
25593 Articles}).
25594
25595 @item
25596 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
25597 Buttons}).
25598
25599 @item
25600 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
25601 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
25602
25603 @item
25604 You can click on buttons instead of using the keyboard
25605 (@pxref{Buttons}).
25606
25607 @end itemize
25608
25609
25610 @node September Gnus
25611 @subsubsection September Gnus
25612
25613 @iftex
25614 @iflatex
25615 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
25616 @end iflatex
25617 @end iftex
25618
25619 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
25620
25621 @itemize @bullet
25622
25623 @item
25624 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
25625 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
25626 now obsolete.
25627
25628 @item
25629 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
25630 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
25631 Threading}).
25632
25633 @lisp
25634 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
25635 @end lisp
25636
25637 @item
25638 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
25639 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
25640
25641 @item
25642 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
25643 referred.
25644
25645 @item
25646 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions (@pxref{GroupLens}).
25647
25648 @item
25649 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
25650
25651 @item
25652 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
25653
25654 @lisp
25655 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
25656 @end lisp
25657
25658 @item
25659 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
25660 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
25661
25662 @lisp
25663 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
25664 @end lisp
25665
25666 @item
25667 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
25668 Groups}).
25669
25670 @item
25671 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
25672 Topics}).
25673
25674 @lisp
25675 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
25676 @end lisp
25677
25678 @item
25679 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
25680
25681 @item
25682 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
25683 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
25684
25685 @lisp
25686 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
25687 @end lisp
25688
25689 @item
25690 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
25691 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
25692
25693 @item
25694 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
25695
25696 @item
25697 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
25698 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
25699 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
25700
25701 @item
25702 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets
25703 (@pxref{SOUP}).
25704
25705 @item
25706 The Gnus cache is much faster.
25707
25708 @item
25709 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
25710 Groups}).
25711
25712 @item
25713 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
25714 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
25715
25716 @item
25717 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
25718 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
25719
25720 @item
25721 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
25722 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
25723
25724 @item
25725 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
25726 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
25727 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
25728
25729 @item
25730 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
25731 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
25732
25733 @item
25734 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
25735
25736 @item
25737 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
25738
25739 @item
25740 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
25741
25742 @item
25743 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
25744
25745 @item
25746 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
25747 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
25748
25749 @item
25750 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
25751 Layout}).
25752
25753 @item
25754 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
25755 @iftex
25756 @iflatex
25757 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
25758 @end iflatex
25759 @end iftex
25760
25761 @item
25762 Gnus can make use of NoCeM files to weed out spam (@pxref{NoCeM}).
25763
25764 @lisp
25765 (setq gnus-use-nocem t)
25766 @end lisp
25767
25768 @item
25769 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25770
25771 @lisp
25772 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
25773 @end lisp
25774
25775 @item
25776 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
25777
25778 @item
25779 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
25780
25781 @item
25782 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
25783 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
25784
25785 @lisp
25786 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
25787 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
25788 @end lisp
25789
25790 @item
25791 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
25792 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
25793
25794 @lisp
25795 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
25796 @end lisp
25797
25798 @item
25799 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
25800 buffer to allow easier treatment.
25801
25802 @item
25803 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
25804
25805 @item
25806 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
25807 Articles}).
25808
25809 @lisp
25810 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
25811 @end lisp
25812
25813 @item
25814 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
25815 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
25816
25817 @lisp
25818 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
25819 @end lisp
25820
25821 @item
25822 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
25823 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
25824
25825 @item
25826 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
25827 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
25828
25829 @lisp
25830 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
25831 @end lisp
25832
25833 @item
25834 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
25835
25836 @item
25837 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
25838
25839 @item
25840 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
25841
25842 @end itemize
25843
25844
25845 @node Red Gnus
25846 @subsubsection Red Gnus
25847
25848 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
25849
25850 @iftex
25851 @iflatex
25852 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
25853 @end iflatex
25854 @end iftex
25855
25856 @itemize @bullet
25857
25858 @item
25859 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
25860
25861 @item
25862 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
25863 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
25864
25865 @item
25866 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
25867 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
25868 Scoring}).
25869
25870 @item
25871 Article washing status can be displayed in the
25872 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
25873
25874 @item
25875 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
25876
25877 @item
25878 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
25879 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
25880
25881 @lisp
25882 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
25883 @end lisp
25884
25885 @item
25886 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
25887 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
25888 been added.
25889
25890 @item
25891 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extendable (@pxref{Document
25892 Server Internals}).
25893
25894 @item
25895 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
25896 Parameters}).
25897
25898 @item
25899 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
25900
25901 @item
25902 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
25903 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
25904
25905 @item
25906 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
25907 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
25908 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
25909
25910 @item
25911 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
25912 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
25913
25914 @item
25915 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
25916 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
25917
25918 @item
25919 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
25920 (@pxref{Undo}).
25921
25922 @item
25923 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
25924 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
25925
25926 @item
25927 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
25928 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
25929
25930 @lisp
25931 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
25932 @end lisp
25933
25934 @item
25935 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
25936
25937 @lisp
25938 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
25939 @end lisp
25940
25941 @item
25942 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
25943 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
25944
25945 @item
25946 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
25947 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
25948
25949 @item
25950 A new command for reading collections of documents
25951 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
25952 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
25953
25954 @item
25955 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
25956 Marks}).
25957
25958 @item
25959 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
25960 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
25961
25962 @item
25963 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
25964 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
25965 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
25966
25967 @item
25968 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
25969 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
25970 Sorting}).
25971
25972 @item
25973 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
25974 Groups}).
25975
25976 @item
25977 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
25978 Commands}).
25979 @iftex
25980 @iflatex
25981 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
25982 @end iflatex
25983 @end iftex
25984
25985 @item
25986 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
25987 Variables}).
25988
25989 @item
25990 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
25991 Mail}).
25992
25993 @item
25994 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
25995 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
25996
25997 @item
25998 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
25999
26000 @end itemize
26001
26002
26003 @node Quassia Gnus
26004 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
26005
26006 New features in Gnus 5.6:
26007
26008 @itemize @bullet
26009
26010 @item
26011 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
26012 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
26013 @xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
26014
26015 @item
26016 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
26017 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
26018 group, which is created automatically.
26019
26020 @item
26021 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
26022 values.
26023
26024 @item
26025 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-ID's.
26026
26027 @item
26028 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
26029 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
26030
26031 @item
26032 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
26033 @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
26034
26035 @item
26036 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
26037
26038 @item
26039 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
26040 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
26041
26042 @item
26043 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
26044
26045 @item
26046 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
26047 details.
26048
26049 @item
26050 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
26051 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
26052
26053 @item
26054 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
26055 control over simplification.
26056
26057 @item
26058 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
26059
26060 @item
26061 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
26062 limit.
26063
26064 @item
26065 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
26066
26067 @item
26068 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
26069
26070 @item
26071 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
26072 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
26073 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
26074
26075 @item
26076 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
26077 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
26078
26079 @item
26080 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
26081 text---@kbd{W d}.
26082
26083 @item
26084 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
26085 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
26086
26087 @item
26088 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
26089 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
26090
26091 @item
26092 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
26093 has been added.
26094
26095 @item
26096 A history of where mails have been split is available.
26097
26098 @item
26099 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
26100
26101 @item
26102 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
26103 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
26104
26105 @item
26106 A new function for citing in Message has been
26107 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
26108
26109 @item
26110 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
26111
26112 @item
26113 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
26114 been added.
26115
26116 @item
26117 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
26118 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
26119
26120 @item
26121 The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
26122 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
26123
26124 @item
26125 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
26126
26127 @item
26128 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
26129
26130 @end itemize
26131
26132 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
26133 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
26134
26135 New features in Gnus 5.8:
26136
26137 @itemize @bullet
26138
26139 @item
26140 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
26141 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
26142
26143 If you used procmail like in
26144
26145 @lisp
26146 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
26147 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
26148 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
26149 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
26150 @end lisp
26151
26152 this now has changed to
26153
26154 @lisp
26155 (setq mail-sources
26156 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
26157 :suffix ".in")))
26158 @end lisp
26159
26160 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
26161
26162 @item
26163 Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
26164 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
26165
26166 @item
26167 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
26168 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
26169
26170 @item
26171 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
26172 called to position point.
26173
26174 @item
26175 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
26176 summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
26177
26178 @item
26179 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
26180 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
26181
26182 @item
26183 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
26184 subtly different manner.
26185
26186 @item
26187 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
26188 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
26189 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
26190
26191 @item
26192 Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
26193
26194 @end itemize
26195
26196 @node Oort Gnus
26197 @subsubsection Oort Gnus
26198 @cindex Oort Gnus
26199
26200 New features in Gnus 5.10:
26201
26202 @itemize @bullet
26203
26204 @item Installation changes
26205 @c ***********************
26206
26207 @itemize @bullet
26208 @item
26209 Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
26210
26211 If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
26212 release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
26213 this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
26214 @file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
26215 read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
26216 @file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
26217 later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
26218 isn't save in general.
26219
26220 @item
26221 Lisp files are now installed in @file{.../site-lisp/gnus/} by default.
26222 It defaulted to @file{.../site-lisp/} formerly. In addition to this,
26223 the new installer issues a warning if other Gnus installations which
26224 will shadow the latest one are detected. You can then remove those
26225 shadows manually or remove them using @code{make
26226 remove-installed-shadows}.
26227
26228 @item
26229 New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
26230
26231 Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
26232 first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
26233 @file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, iff you want
26234 to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
26235 the second parameter.
26236
26237 @file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
26238 automatic recognition of XEmacs and GNU Emacs, generates
26239 @file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
26240 generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
26241 process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
26242 back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
26243 install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
26244 complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
26245 cycle used under Unix systems.
26246
26247 The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} and @file{xemacs.mak}
26248 superfluous, so they have been removed.
26249
26250 @item
26251 @file{~/News/overview/} not used.
26252
26253 As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
26254 directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
26255 hierarchy.
26256
26257 @c FIXME: `gnus-load' is mentioned in README, which is not included in
26258 @c CVS. We should find a better place for this item.
26259 @item
26260 @code{(require 'gnus-load)}
26261
26262 If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
26263 @code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
26264 lisp directory into load-path.
26265
26266 File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
26267 some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
26268
26269 @end itemize
26270
26271 @item New packages and libraries within Gnus
26272 @c *****************************************
26273
26274 @itemize @bullet
26275
26276 @item
26277 The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
26278 @xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
26279
26280 @item
26281 @acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
26282
26283 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
26284 @acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GNUTLS. The old
26285 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} support via (external third party)
26286 @file{ssl.el} and OpenSSL still works.
26287
26288 @item
26289 Improved anti-spam features.
26290
26291 Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
26292 using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
26293 methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
26294 for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
26295 are also new. @xref{Thwarting Email Spam}.
26296 @c FIXME: @xref{Spam Package}?. Should this be under Misc?
26297
26298 @item
26299 Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
26300
26301 Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
26302 complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
26303 buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
26304 generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
26305 manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
26306
26307 @end itemize
26308
26309 @item Changes in group mode
26310 @c ************************
26311
26312 @itemize @bullet
26313
26314 @item
26315 @code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
26316 using @kbd{G M}.
26317
26318 @item
26319 Retrieval of charters and control messages
26320
26321 There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
26322 control messages (@kbd{H C}).
26323
26324 @item
26325 The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
26326
26327 Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
26328 the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
26329 enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
26330 variable in @file{~/.gnus.el} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
26331 variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
26332 parameters, a'la:
26333 @lisp
26334 (setq gnus-parameters
26335 '(("mail\\..*"
26336 (gnus-show-threads nil)
26337 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
26338 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
26339 (to-group . "\\1"))))
26340 @end lisp
26341
26342 @item
26343 Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
26344
26345 The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
26346 be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
26347 @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
26348 @code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
26349 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook}. (called after getting new
26350 mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
26351 want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
26352 you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
26353 when getting new mail, remove the function.
26354
26355 @item
26356 Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
26357
26358 This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
26359 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
26360 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
26361
26362 @item
26363 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
26364 @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
26365
26366 The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
26367 instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
26368 variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
26369 @lisp
26370 ("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
26371 @end lisp
26372
26373 @end itemize
26374
26375 @item Changes in summary and article mode
26376 @c **************************************
26377
26378 @itemize @bullet
26379
26380 @item
26381 @kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
26382 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
26383 region if the region is active.
26384
26385 @item
26386 In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
26387 Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
26388
26389 @item
26390 Article Buttons
26391
26392 More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
26393 pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
26394 variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
26395 appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
26396
26397 @item
26398 Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
26399
26400 @item
26401 Picons
26402
26403 The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
26404 the previous options have been removed or renamed.
26405
26406 Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
26407 newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
26408 @xref{Picons}.
26409
26410 @item
26411 If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
26412 boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
26413
26414 @item
26415 Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
26416
26417 @item
26418 The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
26419 article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
26420
26421 @item
26422 Warn about email replies to news
26423
26424 Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
26425 the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
26426 you.
26427
26428 @item
26429 If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
26430 non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
26431 built.
26432
26433 @item
26434 The new @code{recent} mark @samp{.} indicates newly arrived messages (as
26435 opposed to old but unread messages).
26436
26437 @item
26438 Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
26439 related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
26440
26441 @item
26442 The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
26443 in English. @xref{Article Date}.
26444
26445 @item
26446 diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
26447 @code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
26448
26449 @item
26450 Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
26451
26452 Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
26453 mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
26454 though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
26455 @code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
26456 citations.
26457
26458 The new command @kbd{W Y f}
26459 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}) allows deuglifying broken
26460 Outlook (Express) articles.
26461
26462 @item
26463 @code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
26464
26465 If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
26466 not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
26467 which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
26468 what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
26469
26470 This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
26471 consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
26472 message cited below.
26473
26474 @item
26475 Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc) are now displayed graphically in
26476 Emacs too.
26477
26478 Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.gnus.el} to
26479 disable it.
26480
26481 @item
26482 Face headers handling. @xref{Face}.
26483
26484 @item
26485 In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
26486 and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
26487
26488 @item
26489 Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
26490
26491 @item
26492 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}
26493
26494 The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
26495 %s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
26496 @code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
26497 changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
26498 recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
26499 groups.
26500
26501 @item
26502 Deleting of attachments.
26503
26504 The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
26505 on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
26506 external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
26507 @acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
26508 that support editing.
26509
26510 @item
26511 @code{gnus-default-charset}
26512
26513 The default value is determined from the
26514 @code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
26515 @code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
26516 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
26517
26518 @item
26519 Printing capabilities are enhanced.
26520
26521 Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
26522 Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
26523 printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
26524
26525 @item
26526 Extended format specs.
26527
26528 Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
26529 @code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
26530 format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
26531 @samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
26532 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
26533 escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
26534
26535 @item
26536 @kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
26537 @c FIXME: Was this a user-visible change?
26538
26539 It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
26540 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
26541 out other articles.
26542
26543 @item
26544 Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
26545
26546 If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
26547 s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
26548 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
26549 result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
26550
26551 @item
26552 Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
26553
26554 @end itemize
26555
26556 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
26557 @c ****************************************************
26558
26559 @itemize @bullet
26560
26561 @item
26562 Delayed articles
26563
26564 You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
26565 buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
26566 for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
26567
26568 @item
26569 If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
26570 the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
26571
26572 @item
26573 The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
26574 Gcc articles as read.
26575
26576 @item
26577 Externalizing of attachments
26578
26579 If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
26580 @code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
26581 local files as external parts.
26582
26583 @item
26584 The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
26585 @xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
26586
26587 @item
26588 Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
26589
26590 Earlier it was generated iff the user configurable email address was
26591 different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
26592 algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
26593 only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
26594 cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
26595 see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
26596 default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
26597 @code{message-required-news-headers}, and
26598 @code{message-required-mail-headers}.
26599
26600 @item
26601 Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
26602
26603 Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
26604 subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
26605 M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
26606 @kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
26607 appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
26608 followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
26609
26610 @item
26611 References and X-Draft-From headers are no longer generated when you
26612 start composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
26613 @code{nil}.
26614
26615 @item
26616 Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers. @xref{X-Face}.
26617
26618 @item
26619 Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
26620
26621 To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
26622 are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
26623 variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
26624 contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
26625 you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
26626 into two groups) you must change it to return the list
26627 @code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
26628 incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
26629 was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
26630 was inserted directly.
26631
26632 @item
26633 @code{message-insinuate-rmail}
26634
26635 Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
26636 mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
26637 compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
26638 enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
26639
26640 @item
26641 @code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
26642
26643 The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
26644 @lisp
26645 (define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
26646 'bbdb-complete-name)
26647 @end lisp
26648
26649 @item
26650 @code{gnus-posting-styles}
26651
26652 Add a new format of match like
26653 @lisp
26654 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
26655 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
26656 @end lisp
26657 The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
26658 @lisp
26659 (header "to" "larsi.*org"
26660 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
26661 @end lisp
26662
26663 @item
26664 @code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
26665
26666 @samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
26667 added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
26668 need add those two headers too.
26669
26670 @item
26671 Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
26672 composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
26673 Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
26674 versions.
26675
26676 @item
26677 The option @code{mm-fill-flowed} can be used to disable treatment of
26678 ``format=flowed'' messages. Also, flowed text is disabled when sending
26679 inline PGP signed messages. @xref{Flowed text, , Flowed text,
26680 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
26681 @c This entry is also present in the node "No Gnus".
26682
26683 @item
26684 Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
26685
26686 This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
26687
26688 @item
26689 Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
26690
26691 In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
26692 the valid values.
26693
26694 @item
26695 Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
26696
26697 This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
26698 used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
26699 superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
26700 you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
26701 system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
26702 security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
26703 will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
26704 The behavior can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
26705
26706 @item
26707 Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
26708 2015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630-2633).
26709
26710 It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
26711 additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
26712 Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
26713 messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
26714
26715 @item
26716 @acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
26717 C-m}.
26718
26719 This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
26720 @code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
26721
26722 @item
26723 The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to the symbol
26724 @code{best}.
26725
26726 The behavior for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
26727 convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
26728 used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
26729 invalidate the digital signature.
26730
26731 @item
26732 If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
26733 decompressed when activated.
26734 @c FIXME: Does this affect article or message mode?
26735
26736 @item
26737 Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
26738
26739 Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
26740 Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
26741 send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
26742 Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
26743 and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
26744 controls this.
26745
26746 @item You can now drag and drop attachments to the Message buffer.
26747 See @code{mml-dnd-protocol-alist} and @code{mml-dnd-attach-options}.
26748 @xref{MIME, ,MIME, message, Message Manual}.
26749 @c New in 5.10.9 / 5.11
26750
26751 @end itemize
26752
26753 @item Changes in back ends
26754 @c ***********************
26755
26756 @itemize @bullet
26757 @item
26758 Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
26759
26760 @item
26761 The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
26762
26763 @item
26764 Gnus supports Maildir groups.
26765
26766 Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
26767
26768 @item
26769 The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
26770
26771 This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
26772 separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
26773 makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
26774 sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within e.g. a department. It
26775 works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
26776 file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
26777 nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
26778 another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
26779 @file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
26780 The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
26781 @code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
26782
26783 @end itemize
26784
26785 @item Appearance
26786 @c *************
26787
26788 @itemize @bullet
26789
26790 @item
26791 The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
26792 been renamed to ``Gnus''.
26793
26794 @item
26795 The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
26796 renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
26797 related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
26798 message, Message Manual}).
26799
26800 @item
26801 The tool bars have been updated to use GNOME icons in Group, Summary and
26802 Message mode. You can also customize the tool bars. This is a new
26803 feature in Gnus 5.10.9. (Only for Emacs, not in XEmacs.)
26804
26805 @item The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly
26806 in the group buffer, see the variable @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}.
26807 Its default value depends on your Emacs version. This is a new feature
26808 in Gnus 5.10.9.
26809 @end itemize
26810
26811
26812 @item Miscellaneous changes
26813 @c ************************
26814
26815 @itemize @bullet
26816
26817 @item
26818 @code{gnus-agent}
26819
26820 The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
26821 and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
26822 @code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
26823 only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
26824 default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
26825 enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
26826 of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
26827 unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
26828 @kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
26829 the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
26830 @kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
26831 behavior of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
26832 nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
26833 is not needed any more.
26834
26835 @item
26836 Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
26837
26838 If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
26839 in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
26840 gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
26841
26842 @item
26843 Dired integration
26844
26845 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
26846 bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
26847 using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
26848 entry.
26849
26850 @item
26851 The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
26852
26853 @item
26854 @code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
26855
26856 A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
26857
26858 @end itemize
26859
26860 @end itemize
26861
26862 @iftex
26863
26864 @page
26865 @node The Manual
26866 @section The Manual
26867 @cindex colophon
26868 @cindex manual
26869
26870 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
26871 either @code{texi2dvi}
26872 @iflatex
26873 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
26874 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
26875 @end iflatex
26876 to get what you hold in your hands now.
26877
26878 The following conventions have been used:
26879
26880 @enumerate
26881
26882 @item
26883 This is a @samp{string}
26884
26885 @item
26886 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
26887
26888 @item
26889 This is a @file{file}
26890
26891 @item
26892 This is a @code{symbol}
26893
26894 @end enumerate
26895
26896 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
26897 mean:
26898
26899 @lisp
26900 (setq flargnoze "yes")
26901 @end lisp
26902
26903 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
26904
26905 @lisp
26906 (setq flumphel 'yes)
26907 @end lisp
26908
26909 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
26910 ever get them confused.
26911
26912 @iflatex
26913 @c @head
26914 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
26915 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
26916 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
26917 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
26918 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
26919 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
26920 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
26921 @end iflatex
26922
26923 @end iftex
26924
26925
26926 @node On Writing Manuals
26927 @section On Writing Manuals
26928
26929 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
26930 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
26931 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
26932 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
26933 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
26934 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code goes
26935 hand in hand.
26936
26937 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
26938 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
26939 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
26940 started with Gnus.
26941
26942 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
26943 reference manual as source material. It would look quite differently.
26944
26945
26946 @page
26947 @node Terminology
26948 @section Terminology
26949
26950 @cindex terminology
26951 @table @dfn
26952
26953 @item news
26954 @cindex news
26955 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
26956 News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
26957 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
26958 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
26959 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
26960
26961 @item mail
26962 @cindex mail
26963 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
26964 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
26965 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
26966 not posting, and replying is not following up.
26967
26968 @item reply
26969 @cindex reply
26970 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
26971
26972 @item follow up
26973 @cindex follow up
26974 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
26975 are reading.
26976
26977 @item back end
26978 @cindex back end
26979 Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
26980 difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
26981 commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
26982 messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
26983 architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
26984 ``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
26985 @key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
26986 Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
26987 ``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
26988 number 4711''.
26989
26990 So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
26991 end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
26992 accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
26993 layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
26994 ``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
26995 file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
26996
26997 Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
26998 done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
26999 access the articles.
27000
27001 However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
27002 would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
27003 method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
27004 confusing.
27005
27006 @item native
27007 @cindex native
27008 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
27009 default, way of getting news.
27010
27011 @item foreign
27012 @cindex foreign
27013 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same time.
27014 These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends for getting
27015 news.
27016
27017 @item secondary
27018 @cindex secondary
27019 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and being
27020 foreign, but they mostly act like they are native.
27021
27022 @item article
27023 @cindex article
27024 A message that has been posted as news.
27025
27026 @item mail message
27027 @cindex mail message
27028 A message that has been mailed.
27029
27030 @item message
27031 @cindex message
27032 A mail message or news article
27033
27034 @item head
27035 @cindex head
27036 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.) is
27037 put.
27038
27039 @item body
27040 @cindex body
27041 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
27042 body.
27043
27044 @item header
27045 @cindex header
27046 A line from the head of an article.
27047
27048 @item headers
27049 @cindex headers
27050 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
27051 collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
27052
27053 @item @acronym{NOV}
27054 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
27055 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
27056 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
27057 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
27058 normal @sc{head} format.
27059
27060 @item level
27061 @cindex levels
27062 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1-9). The ones
27063 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
27064 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1-5 are considered
27065 @dfn{subscribed}; 6-7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
27066 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
27067 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
27068
27069 @item killed groups
27070 @cindex killed groups
27071 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
27072 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
27073
27074 @item zombie groups
27075 @cindex zombie groups
27076 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
27077
27078 @item active file
27079 @cindex active file
27080 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
27081 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
27082 is rather large, as you might surmise.
27083
27084 @item bogus groups
27085 @cindex bogus groups
27086 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
27087 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
27088 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
27089
27090 @item activating
27091 @cindex activating groups
27092 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
27093 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
27094 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
27095
27096 @item spool
27097 @cindex spool
27098 News servers store their articles locally in one fashion or other.
27099 One old-fashioned storage method is to have just one file per
27100 article. That's called a ``traditional spool''.
27101
27102 @item server
27103 @cindex server
27104 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
27105
27106 @item select method
27107 @cindex select method
27108 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
27109 server settings.
27110
27111 @item virtual server
27112 @cindex virtual server
27113 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
27114 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
27115 whole is a virtual server.
27116
27117 @item washing
27118 @cindex washing
27119 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
27120 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
27121 original.
27122
27123 @item ephemeral groups
27124 @cindex ephemeral groups
27125 @cindex temporary groups
27126 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
27127 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
27128 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
27129
27130 @item solid groups
27131 @cindex solid groups
27132 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
27133 group buffer are solid groups.
27134
27135 @item sparse articles
27136 @cindex sparse articles
27137 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
27138 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
27139
27140 @item threading
27141 @cindex threading
27142 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
27143 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
27144
27145 @item root
27146 @cindex root
27147 @cindex thread root
27148 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
27149 articles in the thread.
27150
27151 @item parent
27152 @cindex parent
27153 An article that has responses.
27154
27155 @item child
27156 @cindex child
27157 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
27158
27159 @item digest
27160 @cindex digest
27161 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
27162 specified by RFC 1153.
27163
27164 @item splitting
27165 @cindex splitting, terminology
27166 @cindex mail sorting
27167 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
27168 The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
27169 incorrectly called mail filtering.
27170
27171 @end table
27172
27173
27174 @page
27175 @node Customization
27176 @section Customization
27177 @cindex general customization
27178
27179 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
27180 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
27181 for some quite common situations.
27182
27183 @menu
27184 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
27185 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
27186 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
27187 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
27188 @end menu
27189
27190
27191 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
27192 @subsection Slow/Expensive NNTP Connection
27193
27194 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
27195 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
27196 Gnus has to get from the @acronym{NNTP} server.
27197
27198 @table @code
27199
27200 @item gnus-read-active-file
27201 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
27202 entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
27203 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
27204 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
27205 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
27206
27207 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
27208 This one has to be @code{nil}. If not, grabbing article headers from
27209 the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast. Not all @acronym{NNTP} servers
27210 support @sc{xover}; Gnus will detect this by itself.
27211 @end table
27212
27213
27214 @node Slow Terminal Connection
27215 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
27216
27217 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
27218 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
27219 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
27220
27221 @table @code
27222
27223 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
27224 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
27225 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
27226 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
27227 horizontal and vertical recentering.
27228
27229 @item gnus-visible-headers
27230 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
27231 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
27232 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
27233 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
27234
27235 Use the following to enable all the available hiding features:
27236 @lisp
27237 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
27238 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
27239 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
27240 @end lisp
27241
27242 @item gnus-use-full-window
27243 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
27244 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
27245 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
27246 want to read them anyway.
27247
27248 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
27249 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
27250 hidden initially.
27251
27252
27253 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
27254 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
27255 lines, which might save some time.
27256 @end table
27257
27258
27259 @node Little Disk Space
27260 @subsection Little Disk Space
27261 @cindex disk space
27262
27263 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
27264 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
27265
27266 @table @code
27267
27268 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
27269 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
27270 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
27271 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
27272 default.
27273
27274 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
27275 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
27276 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
27277 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
27278 default.
27279
27280 @item gnus-save-killed-list
27281 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
27282 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
27283 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
27284 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
27285
27286 @end table
27287
27288
27289 @node Slow Machine
27290 @subsection Slow Machine
27291 @cindex slow machine
27292
27293 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
27294 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
27295
27296 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
27297 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
27298
27299 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
27300 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
27301 summary buffer faster.
27302
27303
27304 @page
27305 @node Troubleshooting
27306 @section Troubleshooting
27307 @cindex troubleshooting
27308
27309 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
27310 problems, really.
27311
27312 Ahem.
27313
27314 @enumerate
27315
27316 @item
27317 Make sure your computer is switched on.
27318
27319 @item
27320 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
27321 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
27322 Gnus will work.
27323
27324 @item
27325 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
27326 like @samp{Gnus v5.10.6} you have the right files loaded. Otherwise
27327 you have some old @file{.el} files lying around. Delete these.
27328
27329 @item
27330 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
27331 @acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
27332
27333 @item
27334 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
27335 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
27336 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
27337 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
27338 something like that.
27339 @end enumerate
27340
27341 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
27342
27343 @cindex bugs
27344 @cindex reporting bugs
27345
27346 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
27347 @findex gnus-bug
27348 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
27349 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
27350 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
27351 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
27352
27353 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
27354 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
27355 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
27356 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
27357 time.
27358
27359 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
27360 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
27361 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
27362 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
27363 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
27364 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
27365
27366 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
27367 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
27368 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
27369 the bug report.
27370
27371 @cindex patches
27372 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
27373 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
27374
27375 @cindex edebug
27376 If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
27377 in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
27378 edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
27379 (@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
27380 Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
27381 you discover some weird behavior when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
27382 step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
27383 the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
27384 then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
27385 return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
27386 placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
27387 evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
27388 @kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
27389 @kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
27390
27391 @cindex elp
27392 @cindex profile
27393 @cindex slow
27394 Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
27395 manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
27396 can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
27397 slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
27398 helps isolating the real problem areas).
27399
27400 A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP. The profiler is
27401 (or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
27402 there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
27403 part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g. @kbd{M-x
27404 elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
27405 RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
27406 @kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
27407 time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
27408 longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
27409 output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
27410 profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
27411 elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
27412 complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
27413 work perfectly.
27414
27415 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
27416 @cindex ding mailing list
27417 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
27418 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
27419 @email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
27420 @email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
27421
27422
27423 @page
27424 @node Gnus Reference Guide
27425 @section Gnus Reference Guide
27426
27427 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
27428 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
27429 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
27430 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
27431 it.
27432
27433 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
27434 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
27435 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
27436 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
27437 and general methods of operation.
27438
27439 @menu
27440 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
27441 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
27442 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
27443 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
27444 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
27445 * Group Info:: The group info format.
27446 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
27447 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
27448 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
27449 @end menu
27450
27451
27452 @node Gnus Utility Functions
27453 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
27454 @cindex Gnus utility functions
27455 @cindex utility functions
27456 @cindex functions
27457 @cindex internal variables
27458
27459 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
27460 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
27461 Below is a list of the most common ones.
27462
27463 @table @code
27464
27465 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
27466 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
27467 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
27468
27469 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
27470 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
27471 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
27472
27473 @item gnus-group-real-name
27474 @findex gnus-group-real-name
27475 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
27476 name.
27477
27478 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
27479 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
27480 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
27481 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
27482
27483 @item gnus-get-info
27484 @findex gnus-get-info
27485 Returns the group info list for @var{group}.
27486
27487 @item gnus-group-unread
27488 @findex gnus-group-unread
27489 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
27490 unknown.
27491
27492 @item gnus-active
27493 @findex gnus-active
27494 The active entry for @var{group}.
27495
27496 @item gnus-set-active
27497 @findex gnus-set-active
27498 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
27499
27500 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
27501 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
27502 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
27503 exit.
27504
27505 @item gnus-continuum-version
27506 @findex gnus-continuum-version
27507 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
27508 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
27509 versions.
27510
27511 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
27512 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
27513 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
27514
27515 @item gnus-news-group-p
27516 @findex gnus-news-group-p
27517 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
27518
27519 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
27520 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
27521 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
27522
27523 @item gnus-server-to-method
27524 @findex gnus-server-to-method
27525 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
27526
27527 @item gnus-server-equal
27528 @findex gnus-server-equal
27529 Says whether two virtual servers are equal.
27530
27531 @item gnus-group-native-p
27532 @findex gnus-group-native-p
27533 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
27534
27535 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
27536 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
27537 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
27538
27539 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
27540 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
27541 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
27542
27543 @item gnus-group-find-parameter
27544 @findex gnus-group-find-parameter
27545 Returns the parameter list of @var{group}. If given a second parameter,
27546 returns the value of that parameter for @var{group}.
27547
27548 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
27549 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
27550 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
27551
27552 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
27553 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
27554 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
27555
27556 @item gnus-check-backend-function
27557 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
27558 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
27559 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
27560
27561 @lisp
27562 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
27563 @result{} t
27564 @end lisp
27565
27566 @item gnus-read-method
27567 @findex gnus-read-method
27568 Prompts the user for a select method.
27569
27570 @end table
27571
27572
27573 @node Back End Interface
27574 @subsection Back End Interface
27575
27576 Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
27577 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
27578 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
27579 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
27580 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
27581 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
27582
27583 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
27584 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
27585 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
27586 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
27587 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
27588 been opened, the function should fail.
27589
27590 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
27591 name. Take this example:
27592
27593 @lisp
27594 (nntp "odd-one"
27595 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
27596 (nntp-port-number 4324))
27597 @end lisp
27598
27599 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
27600 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
27601
27602 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
27603 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
27604 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
27605
27606 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
27607 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
27608 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
27609
27610 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
27611 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
27612 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
27613 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
27614 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
27615 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
27616 return value.
27617
27618 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
27619 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
27620 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server''
27621 ---they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
27622 more.
27623
27624 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
27625 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
27626 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
27627 possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
27628 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
27629 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
27630 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
27631 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
27632 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
27633 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
27634
27635 The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
27636 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
27637 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
27638 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
27639 the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
27640 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
27641 of numbers as long as possible.
27642
27643 Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
27644 Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
27645 @file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
27646
27647 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
27648 @code{nnchoke}.
27649
27650 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
27651
27652 @menu
27653 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
27654 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
27655 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
27656 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
27657 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
27658 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
27659 @end menu
27660
27661
27662 @node Required Back End Functions
27663 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
27664
27665 @table @code
27666
27667 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
27668
27669 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
27670 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
27671 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
27672 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
27673
27674 The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
27675 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
27676 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
27677 of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
27678
27679 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
27680 headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
27681 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
27682 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
27683 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
27684 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
27685 number, do maximum fetches.
27686
27687 Here's an example HEAD:
27688
27689 @example
27690 221 1056 Article retrieved.
27691 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
27692 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
27693 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
27694 Subject: Re: Something very droll
27695 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
27696 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
27697 Lines: 26
27698 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
27699 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
27700 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
27701 .
27702 @end example
27703
27704 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
27705 these in the data buffer.
27706
27707 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
27708
27709 @example
27710 headers = *head
27711 head = error / valid-head
27712 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
27713 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
27714 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
27715 header = <text> eol
27716 @end example
27717
27718 @cindex BNF
27719 (The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
27720
27721 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
27722 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
27723 separated by tabs.
27724
27725 @example
27726 nov-buffer = *nov-line
27727 nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
27728 field = <text except TAB>
27729 @end example
27730
27731 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
27732 @pxref{Headers}.
27733
27734
27735 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
27736
27737 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
27738 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
27739
27740 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
27741 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
27742 server. In fact, it should do so.
27743
27744 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
27745 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
27746
27747
27748 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
27749
27750 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
27751 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
27752 reason.
27753
27754 There should be no data returned.
27755
27756
27757 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
27758
27759 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
27760 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
27761 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
27762 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
27763
27764 There should be no data returned.
27765
27766
27767 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
27768
27769 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
27770 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
27771 non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
27772 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
27773
27774 There should be no data returned.
27775
27776
27777 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
27778
27779 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
27780
27781 There should be no data returned.
27782
27783
27784 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
27785
27786 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
27787 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
27788 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
27789 it would be nice if that were possible.
27790
27791 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
27792 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
27793 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
27794 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
27795 into its article buffer.
27796
27797 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
27798 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
27799 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
27800 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
27801 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
27802 on successful article retrieval.
27803
27804
27805 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST)
27806
27807 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
27808 making @var{group} the current group.
27809
27810 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
27811 the current group.
27812
27813 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
27814
27815 @example
27816 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
27817 @end example
27818
27819 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
27820 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
27821 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
27822 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
27823 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
27824 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
27825 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
27826 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
27827 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
27828 highest as 0.
27829
27830 @example
27831 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
27832 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
27833 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
27834 @end example
27835
27836
27837 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
27838
27839 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
27840 a no-op on most back ends.
27841
27842 There should be no data returned.
27843
27844
27845 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
27846
27847 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
27848 @emph{all}.
27849
27850 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
27851
27852 @example
27853 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
27854 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
27855 @end example
27856
27857 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
27858 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
27859 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
27860 and the highest as 0.
27861
27862 @example
27863 active-file = *active-line
27864 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
27865 name = <string>
27866 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
27867 @end example
27868
27869 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
27870 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
27871 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
27872
27873
27874 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
27875
27876 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
27877 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
27878 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
27879 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
27880 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
27881 clear if the posting could not be completed.
27882
27883 There should be no result data from this function.
27884
27885 @end table
27886
27887
27888 @node Optional Back End Functions
27889 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
27890
27891 @table @code
27892
27893 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
27894
27895 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
27896 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
27897 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
27898
27899 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
27900 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
27901 former is in the same format as the data from
27902 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
27903 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
27904
27905 @example
27906 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
27907 @end example
27908
27909
27910 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
27911
27912 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
27913 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
27914 the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
27915 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
27916 should return a non-@code{nil} value.
27917
27918 There should be no result data from this function.
27919
27920
27921 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
27922
27923 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
27924 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
27925 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
27926 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
27927 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
27928 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
27929 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
27930 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
27931
27932 There should be no result data from this function.
27933
27934
27935 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
27936
27937 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
27938 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc) internally, and store them in
27939 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
27940 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
27941 propagate the mark information to the server.
27942
27943 @var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
27944
27945 @example
27946 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
27947 @end example
27948
27949 @var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
27950 @var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
27951 marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
27952 marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
27953 @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
27954 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend},
27955 @code{forward} and @code{recent}, but your back end should, if
27956 possible, not limit itself to these.
27957
27958 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
27959 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
27960 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
27961 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
27962
27963 An example action list:
27964
27965 @example
27966 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
27967 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
27968 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
27969 @end example
27970
27971 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
27972 mark on (currently not used for anything).
27973
27974 There should be no result data from this function.
27975
27976 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
27977
27978 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
27979 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
27980 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
27981 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
27982 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
27983
27984 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
27985 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
27986 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
27987 expirable.
27988
27989 There should be no result data from this function.
27990
27991
27992 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
27993
27994 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
27995 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
27996 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
27997 the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
27998 @var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
27999 it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
28000 total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
28001 local if that's practical.
28002
28003 There should be no result data from this function.
28004
28005
28006 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
28007
28008 The result data from this function should be a description of
28009 @var{group}.
28010
28011 @example
28012 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
28013 name = <string>
28014 description = <text>
28015 @end example
28016
28017 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
28018
28019 The result data from this function should be the description of all
28020 groups available on the server.
28021
28022 @example
28023 description-buffer = *description-line
28024 @end example
28025
28026
28027 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
28028
28029 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
28030 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
28031 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
28032 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
28033 in the active buffer format.
28034
28035 It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
28036 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
28037 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
28038 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
28039 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
28040 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
28041 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
28042
28043
28044 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
28045
28046 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
28047
28048 There should be no return data.
28049
28050
28051 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
28052
28053 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
28054 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
28055 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
28056 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
28057 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
28058 they are.
28059
28060 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
28061 able to delete.
28062
28063 There should be no result data returned.
28064
28065
28066 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
28067
28068 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
28069 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
28070
28071 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
28072 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
28073 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
28074 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
28075 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
28076 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
28077
28078 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
28079 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
28080 optimizations.
28081
28082 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
28083 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
28084
28085 There should be no data returned.
28086
28087
28088 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
28089
28090 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
28091 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
28092 this function in short order.
28093
28094 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
28095 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
28096
28097 The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
28098 article for that group.
28099
28100 There should be no data returned.
28101
28102
28103 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
28104
28105 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
28106 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
28107
28108 There should be no data returned.
28109
28110
28111 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
28112
28113 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
28114 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
28115 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
28116
28117 There should be no data returned.
28118
28119
28120 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
28121
28122 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
28123 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
28124
28125 There should be no data returned.
28126
28127 @end table
28128
28129
28130 @node Error Messaging
28131 @subsubsection Error Messaging
28132
28133 @findex nnheader-report
28134 @findex nnheader-get-report
28135 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
28136 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
28137 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
28138 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
28139 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
28140 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
28141
28142 @lisp
28143 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
28144
28145 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
28146 @end lisp
28147
28148 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
28149 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
28150 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
28151 takes one argument---the server symbol.
28152
28153 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
28154 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
28155 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
28156
28157
28158 @node Writing New Back Ends
28159 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
28160
28161 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
28162 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
28163 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
28164 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
28165 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
28166 editing articles.
28167
28168 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
28169 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
28170 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
28171
28172 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
28173 package called @code{nnoo}.
28174
28175 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
28176 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
28177 following macros:
28178
28179 @table @code
28180
28181 @item nnoo-declare
28182 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
28183 parameters. For instance:
28184
28185 @lisp
28186 (nnoo-declare nndir
28187 nnml nnmh)
28188 @end lisp
28189
28190 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
28191 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
28192
28193 @item defvoo
28194 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
28195 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
28196 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
28197
28198 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
28199 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
28200 a function in those back ends.
28201
28202 @lisp
28203 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
28204 "Where nndir will look for groups."
28205 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
28206 @end lisp
28207
28208 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
28209 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
28210 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
28211
28212 @item nnoo-define-basics
28213 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
28214 have.
28215
28216 @lisp
28217 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
28218 @end lisp
28219
28220 @item deffoo
28221 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
28222 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
28223 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
28224
28225 @item nnoo-map-functions
28226 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
28227 functions from the parent back ends.
28228
28229 @lisp
28230 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
28231 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
28232 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
28233 @end lisp
28234
28235 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
28236 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
28237 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
28238 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
28239
28240 @item nnoo-import
28241 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
28242 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
28243 haven't already been defined.
28244
28245 @lisp
28246 (nnoo-import nndir
28247 (nnmh
28248 nnmh-request-list
28249 nnmh-request-newgroups)
28250 (nnml))
28251 @end lisp
28252
28253 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
28254 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
28255 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
28256 defined now.
28257
28258 @end table
28259
28260 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
28261
28262 @lisp
28263 ;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
28264 ;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,96 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
28265
28266 ;;; @r{Code:}
28267
28268 (require 'nnheader)
28269 (require 'nnmh)
28270 (require 'nnml)
28271 (require 'nnoo)
28272 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
28273
28274 (nnoo-declare nndir
28275 nnml nnmh)
28276
28277 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
28278 "Where nndir will look for groups."
28279 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
28280
28281 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
28282 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
28283 nnml-nov-is-evil)
28284
28285 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
28286 nil
28287 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
28288 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
28289 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
28290
28291 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
28292 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
28293
28294 ;;; @r{Interface functions.}
28295
28296 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
28297
28298 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
28299 (setq nndir-directory
28300 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
28301 server))
28302 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
28303 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
28304 (push `(nndir-current-group
28305 ,(file-name-nondirectory
28306 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
28307 defs)
28308 (push `(nndir-top-directory
28309 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
28310 defs)
28311 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
28312
28313 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
28314 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
28315 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
28316 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
28317 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
28318
28319 (nnoo-import nndir
28320 (nnmh
28321 nnmh-status-message
28322 nnmh-request-list
28323 nnmh-request-newgroups))
28324
28325 (provide 'nndir)
28326 @end lisp
28327
28328
28329 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
28330 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
28331
28332 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
28333 @findex gnus-declare-backend
28334 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
28335 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
28336 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
28337
28338 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
28339 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
28340
28341 Here's an example:
28342
28343 @lisp
28344 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
28345 @end lisp
28346
28347 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
28348
28349 The abilities can be:
28350
28351 @table @code
28352 @item mail
28353 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
28354 @item post
28355 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
28356 @item post-mail
28357 This back end supports both mail and news.
28358 @item none
28359 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
28360 different.
28361 @item respool
28362 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
28363 articles and groups.
28364 @item address
28365 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
28366 true for almost all back ends.
28367 @item prompt-address
28368 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
28369 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
28370 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
28371 @end table
28372
28373
28374 @node Mail-like Back Ends
28375 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
28376
28377 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
28378 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
28379 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
28380 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
28381
28382 @lisp
28383 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
28384 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
28385 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
28386 @end lisp
28387
28388 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
28389 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
28390 mail.
28391
28392 This function takes four parameters.
28393
28394 @table @var
28395 @item method
28396 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
28397 the call.
28398
28399 @item exit-function
28400 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
28401
28402 @item temp-directory
28403 Where the temporary files should be stored.
28404
28405 @item group
28406 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
28407 performed for one group only.
28408 @end table
28409
28410 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
28411 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
28412 find the article number assigned to this article.
28413
28414 The function also uses the following variables:
28415 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
28416 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
28417 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
28418 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
28419 this:
28420
28421 @example
28422 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
28423 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
28424 @end example
28425
28426
28427 @node Score File Syntax
28428 @subsection Score File Syntax
28429
28430 Score files are meant to be easily parseable, but yet extremely
28431 mallable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
28432 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
28433
28434 Here's a typical score file:
28435
28436 @lisp
28437 (("summary"
28438 ("win95" -10000 nil s)
28439 ("Gnus"))
28440 ("from"
28441 ("Lars" -1000))
28442 (mark -100))
28443 @end lisp
28444
28445 BNF definition of a score file:
28446
28447 @example
28448 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
28449 element = rule / atom
28450 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
28451 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
28452 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
28453 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
28454 quote = <ascii 34>
28455 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
28456 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
28457 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
28458 date-header = "date"
28459 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28460 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28461 score = "nil" / <integer>
28462 date = "nil" / <natural number>
28463 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
28464 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
28465 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
28466 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
28467 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28468 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28469 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
28470 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28471 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
28472 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
28473 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
28474 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
28475 exclude-files / read-only / touched
28476 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
28477 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
28478 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
28479 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
28480 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
28481 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
28482 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
28483 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
28484 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
28485 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
28486 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
28487 eval = "eval" space <form>
28488 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
28489 @end example
28490
28491 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
28492 discarded.
28493
28494 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
28495 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
28496 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
28497 one looong line, then that's ok.
28498
28499 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
28500 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
28501
28502
28503 @node Headers
28504 @subsection Headers
28505
28506 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
28507 corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
28508 almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
28509 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
28510
28511 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
28512 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
28513 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
28514 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
28515 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
28516 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
28517 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
28518
28519 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
28520 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
28521 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
28522 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
28523 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
28524
28525 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
28526 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
28527
28528
28529 @node Ranges
28530 @subsection Ranges
28531
28532 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
28533 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
28534
28535 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
28536 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
28537 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
28538 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
28539
28540 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
28541 sequence.
28542
28543 @example
28544 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
28545 @end example
28546
28547 is transformed into
28548
28549 @example
28550 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
28551 @end example
28552
28553 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
28554 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
28555
28556 @example
28557 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
28558 @end example
28559
28560 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
28561 is slightly tricky:
28562
28563 @example
28564 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
28565 @end example
28566
28567 and
28568
28569 @example
28570 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
28571 @end example
28572
28573 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
28574
28575 @example
28576 (1 2 3 4 5)
28577 @end example
28578
28579 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
28580 also valid:
28581
28582 @example
28583 (1 . 5)
28584 @end example
28585
28586 and is equal to the previous range.
28587
28588 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
28589 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
28590 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
28591 range handling.)
28592
28593 @example
28594 range = simple-range / normal-range
28595 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
28596 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
28597 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
28598 number *[ " " contents ]
28599 @end example
28600
28601 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
28602 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
28603 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
28604 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
28605 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
28606 sequences.)
28607
28608
28609 @node Group Info
28610 @subsection Group Info
28611
28612 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
28613 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
28614 describes the group.
28615
28616 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
28617 second is a more complex one:
28618
28619 @example
28620 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
28621
28622 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
28623 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
28624 (nnml "")
28625 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
28626 @end example
28627
28628 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
28629 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
28630 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
28631 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
28632 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
28633 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
28634 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
28635 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
28636 this section is about.
28637
28638 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
28639 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
28640 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
28641
28642 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
28643
28644 @example
28645 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
28646 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
28647 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28648 group = quote <string> quote
28649 ralevel = rank / level
28650 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
28651 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
28652 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
28653 read = range
28654 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
28655 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
28656 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
28657 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
28658 @end example
28659
28660 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
28661 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
28662 in pseudo-BNF.
28663
28664 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
28665 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
28666
28667 @table @code
28668 @item gnus-info-group
28669 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
28670 @findex gnus-info-group
28671 @findex gnus-info-set-group
28672 Get/set the group name.
28673
28674 @item gnus-info-rank
28675 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
28676 @findex gnus-info-rank
28677 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
28678 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
28679
28680 @item gnus-info-level
28681 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
28682 @findex gnus-info-level
28683 @findex gnus-info-set-level
28684 Get/set the group level.
28685
28686 @item gnus-info-score
28687 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
28688 @findex gnus-info-score
28689 @findex gnus-info-set-score
28690 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
28691
28692 @item gnus-info-read
28693 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
28694 @findex gnus-info-read
28695 @findex gnus-info-set-read
28696 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
28697
28698 @item gnus-info-marks
28699 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
28700 @findex gnus-info-marks
28701 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
28702 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
28703
28704 @item gnus-info-method
28705 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
28706 @findex gnus-info-method
28707 @findex gnus-info-set-method
28708 Get/set the group select method.
28709
28710 @item gnus-info-params
28711 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
28712 @findex gnus-info-params
28713 @findex gnus-info-set-params
28714 Get/set the group parameters.
28715 @end table
28716
28717 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
28718 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
28719
28720 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
28721 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
28722 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
28723 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
28724
28725
28726 @node Extended Interactive
28727 @subsection Extended Interactive
28728 @cindex interactive
28729 @findex gnus-interactive
28730
28731 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
28732 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
28733 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
28734
28735 @lisp
28736 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
28737 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
28738 ...
28739 )
28740 @end lisp
28741
28742 The best thing to do would have been to implement
28743 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
28744 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
28745 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
28746 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
28747 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
28748 @code{interactive}.
28749
28750 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
28751 adds a few more.
28752
28753 @table @samp
28754 @item y
28755 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
28756 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
28757 variable.
28758
28759 @item Y
28760 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
28761 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
28762 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
28763
28764 @item A
28765 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
28766 function.
28767
28768 @item H
28769 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
28770 function.
28771
28772 @item g
28773 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
28774 function.
28775
28776 @end table
28777
28778
28779 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
28780 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
28781 @cindex XEmacs
28782 @cindex Emacsen
28783
28784 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
28785 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
28786 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
28787
28788 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
28789 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
28790 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
28791 Gnus, that's very useful.
28792
28793 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
28794 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
28795 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
28796 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
28797 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
28798 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
28799 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
28800 following function:
28801
28802 @lisp
28803 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
28804 (start-itimer
28805 "gnus-run-at-time"
28806 `(lambda ()
28807 (,function ,@@args))
28808 time repeat))
28809 @end lisp
28810
28811 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
28812 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
28813 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
28814 all over.
28815
28816 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
28817 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
28818 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
28819
28820 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
28821 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
28822 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
28823
28824
28825 @node Various File Formats
28826 @subsection Various File Formats
28827
28828 @menu
28829 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
28830 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
28831 @end menu
28832
28833
28834 @node Active File Format
28835 @subsubsection Active File Format
28836
28837 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
28838 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
28839 in each group.
28840
28841 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
28842
28843 @example
28844 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
28845 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
28846 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
28847 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
28848 no.general 1000 900 y
28849 @end example
28850
28851 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
28852
28853 @example
28854 active = *group-line
28855 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
28856 group = <non-white-space string>
28857 spc = " "
28858 high-number = <non-negative integer>
28859 low-number = <positive integer>
28860 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
28861 @end example
28862
28863 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
28864 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
28865
28866
28867 @node Newsgroups File Format
28868 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
28869
28870 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
28871 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
28872 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
28873 the user.
28874
28875 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
28876 Here's the definition:
28877
28878 @example
28879 newsgroups = *line
28880 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
28881 group = <non-white-space string>
28882 tab = <TAB>
28883 description = <string>
28884 @end example
28885
28886
28887 @page
28888 @node Emacs for Heathens
28889 @section Emacs for Heathens
28890
28891 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
28892 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
28893 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
28894 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
28895 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
28896 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
28897 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
28898 cat instead.
28899
28900 @menu
28901 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
28902 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
28903 @end menu
28904
28905
28906 @node Keystrokes
28907 @subsection Keystrokes
28908
28909 @itemize @bullet
28910 @item
28911 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
28912
28913 @item
28914 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
28915 @end itemize
28916
28917 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
28918 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
28919 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
28920 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
28921 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
28922 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
28923
28924 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
28925 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
28926 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
28927 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
28928 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
28929 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
28930 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
28931
28932 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
28933 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
28934 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
28935 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
28936 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
28937 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
28938 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
28939
28940 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
28941 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
28942 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
28943 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
28944 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
28945 it.
28946
28947
28948
28949 @node Emacs Lisp
28950 @subsection Emacs Lisp
28951
28952 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
28953 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
28954 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
28955 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
28956
28957 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
28958 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
28959 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
28960 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
28961 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
28962 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
28963 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{~/.gnus.el}
28964 file to customize Gnus. (You can also use the @file{~/.emacs} file, but
28965 in order to set things of Gnus up, it is much better to use the
28966 @file{~/.gnus.el} file, @xref{Startup Files}.)
28967
28968 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
28969 write the following:
28970
28971 @lisp
28972 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
28973 @end lisp
28974
28975 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
28976 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
28977 you can go and fill your @file{~/.gnus.el} file with lots of these to
28978 change how Gnus works.
28979
28980 If you have put that thing in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, it will be
28981 read and @code{eval}ed (which is Lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
28982 start Gnus. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
28983 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
28984 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
28985
28986 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
28987 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
28988 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
28989
28990 Some pitfalls:
28991
28992 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
28993 that means:
28994
28995 @lisp
28996 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
28997 @end lisp
28998
28999 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server} to
29000 @samp{nntp.ifi.uio.no}'', that means:
29001
29002 @lisp
29003 (setq gnus-nntp-server "nntp.ifi.uio.no")
29004 @end lisp
29005
29006 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
29007 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
29008
29009 @page
29010 @include gnus-faq.texi
29011
29012 @node Index
29013 @chapter Index
29014 @printindex cp
29015
29016 @node Key Index
29017 @chapter Key Index
29018 @printindex ky
29019
29020 @summarycontents
29021 @contents
29022 @bye
29023
29024 @iftex
29025 @iflatex
29026 \end{document}
29027 @end iflatex
29028 @end iftex
29029
29030 @c Local Variables:
29031 @c mode: texinfo
29032 @c coding: iso-8859-1
29033 @c End:
29034
29035 @ignore
29036 arch-tag: c9fa47e7-78ca-4681-bda9-9fef45d1c819
29037 @end ignore